67 0 13MB
BC-6000 Series Auto Hematology Analyzer
Service Manual Models: BC-6000/BC-6000Plus/ BC-6100/BC-6100Plus/BC-6200
© 2016-2019 Shenzhen Mindray Bio-medical Electronics Co., Ltd. All rights Reserved. For this Operator’s Manual, the issued Date is 2019-11.
Intellectual Property Statement SHENZHEN MINDRAY BIO-MEDICAL ELECTRONICS CO., LTD. (hereinafter called Mindray) owns the intellectual property rights to this Mindray product and this manual. This manual may refer to information protected by copyright or patents and does not convey any license under the patent rights or copyright of Mindray, or of others. Mindray intends to maintain the contents of this manual as confidential information. Disclosure of the information in this manual in any manner whatsoever without the written permission of Mindray is strictly forbidden. Release, amendment, reproduction, distribution, rental, adaptation, translation or any other derivative work of this manual in any manner whatsoever without the written permission of Mindray is strictly forbidden. , China and other countries.
are the trademarks, registered or otherwise, of Mindray in All other trademarks that appear in this manual are used only for
informational or editorial purposes. They are the property of their respective owners.
Responsibility on the Manufacturer Party Contents of this manual are subject to changes without prior notice. All information contained in this manual is believed to be correct. Mindray shall not be liable for errors contained herein nor for incidental or consequential damages in connection with the furnishing, performance, or use of this manual. Mindray is responsible for the effects on safety, reliability and performance of this product, only if:
all installation operations, expansions, changes, modifications and repairs of this product are conducted by Mindray authorized personnel.
the electrical installation of the relevant room complies with the applicable national and local requirements.
the product is used in accordance with the instructions for use.
I
WARNING
It is important for the hospital or organization that employs this equipment to carry out a reasonable service/maintenance plan. Neglect of this may result in machine breakdown or injury of human health.
Be sure to operate the system under the situation specified in this manual; otherwise, the system will not work normally and the analysis results will be unreliable, which would damage the system components and cause personal injury.
NOTE
This equipment must be operated by skilled/trained clinical professionals.
Repair Service Free Service: Free service is provided for any product within the scope specified by Mindray warranty rules. Paid Service: Mindray offers paid service for any product beyond the scope specified by Mindray warranty rules; Even during the warranty period, only paid service is available if the need for service is caused by the following reasons: artificial damage; improper use; grid voltage beyond the specified range of the device; irresistible natural disasters; replacement with parts and consumables not authorized by Mindray or service work by personnel not authorized by Mindray.
Return Procedure In the event that it becomes necessary to return this product or part of this product to Mindray, the following procedure should be followed: Obtain return authorization: Contact the Mindray Service Department and obtain a Customer Service Authorization (Mindray) number. The Mindray number must appear on the outside of the shipping container. Returned shipments will not be accepted if the Mindray number is not clearly visible. Please provide the model number, serial number, and a brief description of the reason for return. Freight policy: The customer is responsible for freight charges when shipping the product to Mindray for service (including customs charges).
II
Customer Service Department Manufacturer:
Shenzhen Mindray Bio-Medical Electronics Co., Ltd.
Address:
Mindray Building, Keji 12th Road South, High-tech industrial park, Nanshan, Shenzhen 518057,P.R.China
Website:
www.mindray.com
E-mail Address:
[email protected]
Tel:
+86 755 81888998
Fax:
+86 755 26582680 EC-Representative:
Shanghai International Holding Corp. GmbH(Europe)
Address:
Eiffestraβe 80, Hamburg 20537, Germany
Tel:
0049-40-2513175
Fax:
0049-40-255726
III
Table of Contents Chapter 1 Using This Manual .................................................................................. 1-1 1.1
Who is to Using this Manual ............................................................................. 1-2
1.2
Using This Manual ........................................................................................... 1-3
1.3
Labels and Symbols on the Analyzer ................................................................ 1-4
1.4
Safety Information .......................................................................................... 1-12
1.5
Term Definition ............................................................................................... 1-15
Chapter 2 System Introduction ............................................................................... 2-1 2.1
Intended Use ................................................................................................... 2-1
2.2
Parameters ...................................................................................................... 2-2
2.3
Product Description .......................................................................................... 2-7 2.3.1 Product Structure and Components............................................................ 2-7 2.3.2 Modules and Components ......................................................................... 2-7 2.3.3 Accessories List of the Analyzer ............................................................... 2-15 2.3.4 Tubes and Tube Racks............................................................................. 2-16
2.4 2.5
Overview of Software Interfaces ..................................................................... 2-18 Reagents, Controls and Calibrators ................................................................ 2-22 2.5.1 Reagents ................................................................................................. 2-22 2.5.2 Controls and Calibrators........................................................................... 2-24
Chapter 3 System Principles ................................................................................... 3-1 3.1
Overview.......................................................................................................... 3-1
3.2
WBC Measurement .......................................................................................... 3-2 3.2.1 SF CUBE Cell Analysis Technology ............................................................ 3-2 3.2.2 WBC-Related Parameters .......................................................................... 3-3
3.3
Derivation of NRBC-Related Parameters .......................................................... 3-6
3.4
Hemoglobin Concentration Measurement ......................................................... 3-7 3.4.1 A Test Model Using the Colorimetric Method ............................................... 3-7 3.4.2 HGB Measurement .................................................................................... 3-7
3.5
RBC/PLT Measurement.................................................................................... 3-8 3.5.1 Impedance Method .................................................................................... 3-8 3.5.2 SF CUBE Cell Analysis Technology ............................................................ 3-9 3.5.3 RBC-Related Parameters........................................................................... 3-9 3.5.4 PLT-Related Parameters ............................................................................ 3-9 3.5.5 Reticulocyte Parameters .......................................................................... 3-10
3.6
Body Fluid Parameters ................................................................................... 3-12
3.7
Flush.............................................................................................................. 3-13
Chapter 4 Software System ..................................................................................... 4-1 4.1
Login Password ............................................................................................... 4-1 4.1.1 System Self-test When Logging in at Service Access Level ........................ 4-1
4.2
Calibration........................................................................................................ 4-2 4.2.1 Manual Calibration ..................................................................................... 4-2 4.2.2 Calibration with Calibrators......................................................................... 4-3 1
Table of Contents
4.3
Optical Gain Calibration ................................................................................... 4-6
4.4
Review ............................................................................................................. 4-7 4.4.1 Export ........................................................................................................ 4-7 4.4.2 Special information .................................................................................... 4-8
4.5
Setup screen .................................................................................................... 4-9 4.5.1 Maintenance .............................................................................................. 4-9 4.5.2 Reagent Setup ........................................................................................... 4-9 4.5.3 Communication ........................................................................................ 4-12 4.5.4 Gain Setup............................................................................................... 4-13 4.5.5 Auxiliary Setup ......................................................................................... 4-13
4.6
Debug & Self-Test .......................................................................................... 4-15 4.6.1 Adjust. Sample Probe Positions................................................................ 4-15 4.6.2 Adjust Autoloader Position........................................................................ 4-16 4.6.3 Auto-loading Debug.................................................................................. 4-17 4.6.4 Sensor Debug .......................................................................................... 4-18 4.6.5 Optical Debug .......................................................................................... 4-19
4.7
Status ............................................................................................................ 4-20
4.8
Indicators ....................................................................................................... 4-20
4.9
Advanced Toolbox .......................................................................................... 4-22 4.9.1 Language Setup....................................................................................... 4-22 4.9.2 Debug Data Export .................................................................................. 4-22 4.9.3 Enable “Low Speed Scan” for Low Quality Sample Barcode ..................... 4-24
4.10
Software Update ............................................................................................ 4-26 4.10.1 Prepare the USB for update ................................................................... 4-26 4.10.2 Update ................................................................................................... 4-26 4.10.3 When Update Fails................................................................................. 4-27
4.11
Communication Troubleshooting .................................................................... 4-28
Chapter 5 Mechanical System ................................................................................. 5-1 5.1
Introduction to Mechanical Structure................................................................. 5-1 5.1.1 Front Side of the Analyzer .......................................................................... 5-2 5.1.2 Rear Side of the Analyzer........................................................................... 5-3 5.1.3 Left Side of the Analyzer ............................................................................ 5-4 5.1.4 Right Side of the Analyzer .......................................................................... 5-4
5.2
Mechanics Subsystem Introduction .................................................................. 5-6 5.2.1 Autoloader ................................................................................................. 5-6 5.2.2 Rotary Scanning Assembly (With Built-in Scanner) ................................... 5-25 5.2.3 Test Tube Stabilizing Mechanism.............................................................. 5-31 5.2.4 Mixing Assembly ...................................................................................... 5-35 5.2.5 Sampling assembly .................................................................................. 5-41 5.2.6 Syringe Assembly .................................................................................... 5-50 5.2.7 Temperature Control Module .................................................................... 5-51
Chapter 6 Optical System ........................................................................................ 6-1 6.1
Fundamentals of Optical System ...................................................................... 6-1
6.2
Composition of the Optical System ................................................................... 6-3 2
Table of Contents
6.3
Troubleshooting Optical Faults ......................................................................... 6-5 6.3.1 Scattergram Abnormal ............................................................................... 6-5 6.3.2 Laser Diode Current Abnormal ................................................................... 6-7 6.3.3 When the Optical Gain Cannot be Calibrated ............................................. 6-8 6.3.4 Maintenance and Replacement of Optical System ...................................... 6-9 6.3.5 Replacing Optical Assembly after Analyzer Upgrading with the New Optical Assembly and New Optical Signal Board (After EIV013) ................................... 6-12
Chapter 7 Fluidics System ...................................................................................... 7-1 7.1
Fluidics System Overview ................................................................................ 7-1
7.2
Measurement Flow........................................................................................... 7-3
7.3
Sample Dilution Flow Chart .............................................................................. 7-4 7.3.1 Whole blood mode ..................................................................................... 7-4 7.3.2 Prediluted mode ......................................................................................... 7-5
7.4
Sample Volume ................................................................................................ 7-6
7.5
Time of Preparation and Measurement ............................................................. 7-7
7.6
Temperature Control for Fluidics System .......................................................... 7-8
7.7
Reagent Consumption Volume ......................................................................... 7-9
7.8
Fluidic Parts and Functions ............................................................................ 7-12 7.8.1 Sample probe .......................................................................................... 7-12 7.8.2 Probe Wipe .............................................................................................. 7-12 7.8.3 Pumps ..................................................................................................... 7-12 7.8.4 Syringe .................................................................................................... 7-13 7.8.5 Valves ...................................................................................................... 7-13 7.8.6 Baths ....................................................................................................... 7-16 7.8.7 Filters....................................................................................................... 7-17 7.8.8 Liquid Pressure Detection Components.................................................... 7-18
7.9
Pneumatic System ......................................................................................... 7-19 7.9.1 Pneumatic System Introduction ................................................................ 7-19 7.9.2 Introduction of Pneumatic Parts and Functions ......................................... 7-19
7.10
Fluidic Channels and Fluidic Structure ............................................................ 7-20 7.10.1 WNB Channel ........................................................................................ 7-20 7.10.2 DIFF Channel ........................................................................................ 7-21 7.10.3 RET Channel ......................................................................................... 7-22 7.10.4 RBC/PLT Channel .................................................................................. 7-23 7.10.5 HGB Channel ......................................................................................... 7-24
7.11
Introduction to Sequences .............................................................................. 7-25 7.11.1 CT-WB Analysis Sequences ................................................................... 7-25 7.11.2 CT-micro-WB Analysis Sequences ......................................................... 7-29 7.11.3 CT-PD Analysis Sequences .................................................................... 7-30 7.11.4 Autoloading Whole-Blood Analysis Sequences ....................................... 7-30
7.12
Fluidics Diagram ............................................................................................. 7-31
7.13
Check the Particle Flow Stability..................................................................... 7-33
Chapter 8 Hardware System .................................................................................... 8-1 8.1
Hardware System Overview ............................................................................. 8-1 3
Table of Contents
8.1.1 Functional block diagrams .......................................................................... 8-1 8.1.2 Electrical Connection Block Diagram and the Positions in Analyzer ............ 8-2 8.2
Main control board and COME substrate assembly (115-042843-00) ................ 8-8 8.2.1 Overview.................................................................................................... 8-8 8.2.2 Function..................................................................................................... 8-8 8.2.3 Structure and Test .................................................................................... 8-10 8.2.4 Troubleshooting ....................................................................................... 8-13
8.3
Drive board (051-002835-00) ......................................................................... 8-15 8.3.1 Function................................................................................................... 8-15 8.3.2 Structure and Test .................................................................................... 8-16 8.3.3 Troubleshooting ....................................................................................... 8-19
8.4
Analog board (051-002815-00) ....................................................................... 8-20 8.4.1 Function................................................................................................... 8-20 8.4.2 Structure and Test .................................................................................... 8-20 8.4.3 Troubleshooting ....................................................................................... 8-22
8.5
Autoloader Board (051-002829-00) ................................................................ 8-23 8.5.1 Function................................................................................................... 8-23 8.5.2 Structure and Test .................................................................................... 8-23 8.5.3 Troubleshooting ....................................................................................... 8-25
8.6
Valve Drive Board (051-002805-00)................................................................ 8-26 8.6.1 Function................................................................................................... 8-26 8.6.2 Structure .................................................................................................. 8-26 8.6.3 Troubleshooting ....................................................................................... 8-27
8.7
Power Supply Module .................................................................................... 8-28 8.7.1 Overview.................................................................................................. 8-28 8.7.2 Structure and Test .................................................................................... 8-29 8.7.3 Power Indication ...................................................................................... 8-34 8.7.4 Troubleshooting ....................................................................................... 8-37
8.8
Boards in the Optical System ......................................................................... 8-38 8.8.1 Function................................................................................................... 8-38
8.9
Indicator Board (051-001240-00) .................................................................... 8-39 8.9.1 Function................................................................................................... 8-39 8.9.2 Troubleshooting ....................................................................................... 8-39
8.10
Keyboard (051-001568-00) ............................................................................ 8-40 8.10.1 Function ................................................................................................. 8-40 8.10.2 Troubleshooting ..................................................................................... 8-40
8.11
Mini Network Board (051-001122-00) ............................................................. 8-41 8.11.1 Function ................................................................................................. 8-41 8.11.2 Troubleshooting...................................................................................... 8-41
8.12
Liquid Position Detecting Board (051-000565-00) ........................................... 8-42 8.12.1 Function ................................................................................................. 8-42 8.12.2 Structure and Test .................................................................................. 8-42 8.12.3 Troubleshooting ..................................................................................... 8-43
8.13
Air Pressure Detection Board (051-000507-00) .............................................. 8-44 4
Table of Contents
8.13.1 Function ................................................................................................. 8-44 8.13.2 Structure ................................................................................................ 8-44 8.13.3 Troubleshooting ..................................................................................... 8-45 Chapter 9 FRU Replacement and Debugging ......................................................... 9-1 9.1
Overview.......................................................................................................... 9-1
9.2
Removal and Installation of the Panels ............................................................. 9-2 9.2.1 Opening the Front Cover Assembly ............................................................ 9-2 9.2.2 Opening the Left Panel, Right Panel and Top Cover ................................... 9-3
9.3
Replacing the Autoloader FRU ......................................................................... 9-5 9.3.1 Removing and Replacing the Loading Motor and Belt................................. 9-6 9.3.2 Removing and Replacing the Loading Sensor ............................................ 9-7 9.3.3 Removing and Replacing the Feeding Motor and Belt ................................ 9-8 9.3.4 Removing and Replacing the Feeding sensor........................................... 9-10 9.3.5 Removing and Replacing the Unloading Motor and Belt ........................... 9-10 9.3.6 Removing and Replacing the Unloading Sensor ....................................... 9-12 9.3.7 Removing and Replacing the Back Supporting Board ............................... 9-13
9.4
Replacing the Tube Stabilizing Assembly FRU ............................................... 9-14 9.4.1 Removing and Replacing the Compressing Spring Piece and Spring........ 9-14
9.5
Introduction to Rotatory Scanning Component ................................................ 9-16 9.5.1 Removing and Replacing the Motor and Roller Sleeve ............................. 9-17
9.6
Introduction to Pincher Roller Assembly.......................................................... 9-19 9.6.1 Removing and Replacing the Motor, Sensors and Pinch Roller Spring ...... 9-20
9.7
Introduction to Sampling Assembly and Replacement Procedure .................... 9-22 9.7.1 Removing and Replacing Detection Sensor .............................................. 9-22 9.7.2 Removing and Replacing Probe Wipe (Closed-Sampling) and Sampling Probe ......................................................................................................................... 9-23 9.7.3 Removing and Replacing Y Direction Motor and Z Direction Motor ........... 9-25
9.8
Introduction to mix assembly .......................................................................... 9-28 9.8.1 Removing and Replacing Detection Sensor .............................................. 9-29 9.8.2 Removing and Replacing Motor ............................................................... 9-30
9.9
Gain Adjustment............................................................................................. 9-33
9.10
Installing and Adjusting Rotary Scanning Device ............................................ 9-35
Chapter 10 Maintenance .......................................................................................... 10-1 10.1
Recommended Maintenance .......................................................................... 10-1
10.2
Active Maintenance ........................................................................................ 10-2 10.2.1 Pre-maintenance Preparations ............................................................... 10-2 10.2.2 Maintenance Plan and Content .............................................................. 10-2 10.2.3 Check the Instrument Status ................................................................ 10-23 10.2.4 Confirm the General Performance of the Instrument ............................. 10-24 10.2.5 Data Backup and Export ...................................................................... 10-25
10.3
Standard Operation Procedures of QC and Calibration ................................. 10-29 10.3.1 Quality Control ..................................................................................... 10-29 10.3.2 Calibration ........................................................................................... 10-29 10.3.3 Mixing Methods of Mindray Self-made Quality Controls and Calibrator . 10-29 5
Table of Contents
Chapter 11 Troubleshooting Information................................................................ 11-1 11.1
Introduction .................................................................................................... 11-1
11.2
Message Area Codes ..................................................................................... 11-3 11.2.1 Reagent Type ......................................................................................... 11-3 11.2.2 Waste-Related Errors ............................................................................. 11-6 11.2.3 Floater-Related Errors ............................................................................ 11-8 11.2.4 Syringe Type .......................................................................................... 11-9 11.2.5 Sampling Assembly-related Errors ........................................................ 11-14 11.2.6 Mix Assembly-Related Type.................................................................. 11-17 11.2.7 Autoloader-Related Errors .................................................................... 11-21 11.2.8 Sample Compartment Assembly Errors ................................................ 11-28 11.2.9 Temperature Type Errors ...................................................................... 11-30 11.2.10 Pressure Errors .................................................................................. 11-34 11.2.11 Voltage/Current Errors ........................................................................ 11-36 11.2.12 Fan Type ............................................................................................ 11-37 11.2.13 Signal type ......................................................................................... 11-38 11.2.14 Communication Type .......................................................................... 11-39 11.2.15 System Errors .................................................................................... 11-40 11.2.16 Additional Warning Messages in the “Message” Area (Since EIV012).. 11-41
A
List of Wearing Parts ............................................................................. A-1
B
New/Changed Functions Lists with each ECR ..................................... B-1
6
Chapter 1 Using This Manual This chapter describes how to use the service manual. In this manual, the repair methods of the BC-6000 series analyzers are described in detail. Before servicing the BC-6000 series analyzers, please carefully read and understand the content in order to properly carry out maintenance procedures and ensure the safety of service personnel. This manual must be used in conjunction with the BC-6000 series Operator’s manual. It does not contain information and procedures already covered in the Operator’s manual of the BC6000 series analyzers.
NOTE
Be sure to operate and service the analyzer strictly as instructed in this manual and the operator's manual.
1-1
Using This Manual
1.1 Who is to Using this Manual This manual is intended to be read by service professionals who:
Have comprehensive knowledge of circuitry and fluidics;
Have comprehensive knowledge of reagents;
Have comprehensive knowledge of quality control;
Have comprehensive knowledge of troubleshooting;
Are familiar with the operations of the system;
Are able to use basic mechanical tools and understand the terminology;
Are skilled users of the digital voltmeter and oscillograph;
Are able to analyze the circuit diagrams and fluidic charts.
1-2
Using This Manual
1.2 Using This Manual This manual comprises 11 chapters and 1 appendix. Refer to the table below to find the information you need. When you need to...
See...
learn about the analyzer's system composition and
Chapter
software structure
Introduction
learn about the analyzer's installation requirements and
Chapter
software upgrade methods
Principles
learn about the basic functions of the Analyzer software
Chapter 4 Software System
learn about the composition of the Analyzer's mechanical
Chapter
system components
System
learn about the analyzer's optical system and optical
Chapter 6 Optical System
2
System
3
System
5
Mechanical
system main fault repair methods learn about the composition, dosage, basic channels and
Chapter 7 Fluidics System
time sequence of the analyzer's fluidic system learn about the analyzer's hardware structure; composition,
Chapter
adjusting, testing points and troubleshooting of each board
System
learn about how to replace and debug analyzer FRUs
Chapter
8
Hardware 9
Replacement
FRU and
Debugging learn about the analyzer maintenance method
Chapter 10 Maintenance
learn about the analyzer's errors and troubleshooting
Chapter 11 Troubleshooting Information
learn about the analyzer's main accessories
A.1.1.1.1.A.1AList Wearing Parts
1-3
of
Using This Manual
1.3 Labels and Symbols on the Analyzer You may find the following symbols on package or the body of the instrument:
CAUTION
During the daily use of the instrument, especially the cleaning process, the operator shall ensure the intactness of the labels.
When you see...
It means... Caution Consult the accompanying documents In all cases where this symbol is marked to find the nature of the potential HAZARDS and any actions have to be taken to avoid them BIOLOGICAL RISK WARNING, LASER BEAM PROTECTIVE EARTH (GROUND)
Off (Power) On (Power) CAUTION, RISK OF ELECTRIC SHOCK
Alternating current SERIAL NUMBER FOR IN VITRO DIAGNOSTIC USE DATE OF MANUFACTURE Temperature limitation
1-4
Using This Manual
HUMIDITY LIMITATION
Atmospheric Pressure limit
Biological risks (on the tube of the waste container cap assembly) Do not replace the waste container when the power indicator is flickering! THE DEVICE IS FULLY CONFORMANCE WITH THE COUNCIL DIRECTIVE
CONCERNING
IN
VITRO
DIAGNOSTIC MEDICAL DEVICES 98/79/EC. Applicable to closed-sampling type analyzers Warning The probe is sharp and may contain biological contaminants. Be careful when operating it! Applicable to closed-sampling models Indicate the tube positions for different types of tubes Note If the sample to be analyzed is a capillary or prediluted sample, be sure to uncap the tube before analysis.
1-5
Using This Manual
Figure 1-1 Tube position instruction label and uncapping tube reminder for capillary or prediluted samples (only for closed-sampling models)
Applicable to closed-sampling models Indicate the tube positions for different types of tubes Notes: If the sample to be analyzed is a capillary or prediluted sample, be sure to uncap the tube before analysis.
1-6
Using This Manual
Figure 1-2 Hand-pricking warning sign (Open-sampling types)
① Applicable to open-sampling type analyzers Warning The probe is sharp and may contain biological contaminants. Be careful when operating it!
1-7
Using This Manual
Figure 1-3 Bio-hazard warning sign at waste outlet and power warning label (all models)
① Warning 1. Connect only to a properly grounded outlet. 2. To avoid electrical shock, disconnect power prior to maintenance. 3. To prevent fire, only use the fuse of specified type and current rating.
② BIOLOGICAL RISK Biological risk
1-8
Using This Manual
Figure 1-4 Moving parts warning sign (both models)
Warning To avoid personal injury, do not put your hand under the syringe or inside the slot!
1-9
Using This Manual
Figure 1-5 Note and warning signs on autoloader (for all models)
① Note 1
Slide the tube into the tube rack. If it was not feasible, replace the tube barcode.
2
Make sure the tube cap is secured.
3
Make sure the unloading tray is not full and the detecting sensor is not covered, and then start analysis.
② BIOLOGICAL RISK Biological risk
1-10
Using This Manual
Figure 1-6 Optical assembly laser warning sign (for all models)
① Caution: Class 3B laser radiation when open and internal locks defeated Avoid exposure to the laser beam
1-11
Using This Manual
1.4 Safety Information You will find the following symbols in this manual: When you see...
Indication Read the statement below the symbol. The statement is alerting you to a potentially biohazardous condition. Read the statement below the symbol. The statement is
WARNING
alerting you to an operating hazard that can cause personnel injury. Read the statement below the symbol. The statement is
CAUTION
alerting you to a possibility of system damage or unreliable analysis results.
Safety precautions: For the safety of patients and operators, be sure to follow the precautions below during the installation.
WARNING
It is important for the hospital or organization that employs this equipment to carry out a reasonable service/maintenance plan. Neglect of this may result in machine breakdown or injury of human health.
Check the equipment state after repair. Make sure the equipment is safe before offering it to users.
Move and install the analyzer with a special-purpose tool (for example, a carrying handle).
Never use combustible gas (e.g. anesthetic) or combustible liquid (e.g. ethanol) around the analyzer. Otherwise, the risk of explosion may exist.
Contacting exposed electronic components while the equipment is attached to power can cause personal injury from electric shock or damage to electronic components. Power down before removing covers to access electronic components.
Connect the analyzer to a socket having sole fuse and protective switch. Do not use the same fuse and protective switch with other equipment (e.g. life supporting equipment). Otherwise, the equipment failure, over current or impulse current that occurs at the startup moment may lead to tripping.
1-12
Using This Manual
To prevent personal injury during the maintenance, keep your clothes, hairs and hands from the moving parts, such as sample probe, gripper and piercer.
Possible mechanical movement of the warned position may lead to personal injury during normal operation, removal and maintenance.
Be sure to dispose of reagents, waste, samples, consumables, etc. according to government regulations.
The reagents are irritating to eyes, skin and airway. Wear proper personal protective instrument (e.g. gloves, lab coat, etc.) and follow safe laboratory procedures when handling them and the contacted areas in the laboratory.
If reagents accidentally spill on your skin or in your eyes, rinse the area with ample amount of clean water, and seek medical attention immediately.
Before maintaining, transporting or servicing the instrument, clean and sterilize the instrument cover as well as the parts and components with biological risks (such as the sample probe). Remind the persons who handle the instrument of the related risks.
After maintenance, be sure to check the system status and confirm that it is safe before delivering it to the user.
CAUTION
Improper service may damage the system. Maintain the analyzer strictly as instructed by the service manual and inspect the analyzer carefully after the maintenance.
For problems not mentioned in this manual, contact Mindray customer service department for service advice.
To prevent personal injury or damage to equipment components, remove metal jewelry before maintaining or servicing electronic components of the equipment.
Electrostatic discharge may damage electronic components. If there is a possibility of ESD damage during servicing, then work at an ESD workstation, or wear an antistatic wrist strap while servicing the system.
1-13
Using This Manual
NOTE
This equipment must be operated by skilled/trained medical professionals.
Samples, controls, calibrators and waste are potentially infectious. Wear proper personal protective equipment (e.g. gloves, lab coat, etc.) and follow safe laboratory procedures when handling them in the laboratory.
All the analyzer components and surfaces are potentially infectious, so take proper protective measures for operation and maintenance.
The sample probe tip is sharp and may contain biohazardous materials. Exercise caution to avoid contact with the probe when working around it.
Laser warning CLASS 1 LASER PRODUCT
Caution: Class 3B laser radiation when open and internal locks defeated Please avoid the laser beam
Warning Laser radiation Please avoid the laser beam CLASS 3B LASER PRODUCT Max. Output 10mW Wavelength 635nm Standard: GB7247.1-2012 Issue date: Dec. 31, 2012
1-14
Using This Manual
1.5 Term Definition This series of analyzers have two sampling types: open-sampling and closed-sampling.
Open-sampling type analyzers
The user manually places a vacuum tube with a blood sample or an open lid under an open sampling probe, and presses the [Aspirate] button to aspirate the blood sample. Those models using the open-sampling mode are called Open-sampling types
Closed-sampling type analyzers
In this mode, closed-sampling devices are used to perform closed-cover piercing. Those models using the closed-sampling mode are called closed-sampling models
1-15
Chapter 2 System Introduction 2.1 Intended Use The Auto Hematology Analyzer is a quantitative, automated hematology analyzer for In Vitro Diagnostic Use in clinical laboratories; it provides Complete Blood Count, Leukocyte 5-part Differential, Hemoglobin Concentration Measurement, Reticulocyte Count, Nucleated Red Blood Cell Measurement, and Body Fluid Cell Count.
NOTE
The subtypes of body fluid supported by the analyzer include cerebrospinal fluid, serous cavity fluid (pleural fluid and ascitic fluid) and synovial fluid samples. You may not get accurate results if you analyze body fluid samples other than specified above.
BC-6000Plus/BC-6100Plus/BC-6200 supports the RET test. BC-6000/BC6100 does not support the RET test.
2-1
System Introduction
2.2 Parameters NOTE
The analyzer identifies the normal patient, with all normal systemgenerated parameters for In Vitro Diagnostic Use. The product flags or identifies patient results that require additional studies.
It outputs the following test parameters in blood sample analysis: Table 2-1 Blood Sample Test Report Parameters Series
English name
Abbreviation
WBC series (13) RET series (7)
White Blood Cell count
WBC
Basophils number
Bas#
Basophils percentage
Bas%
Neutrophils number
Neu#
Neutrophils percentage
Neu%
Eosinophils number
Eos#
Eosinophils percentage
Eos%
Lymphocytes number
Lym#
Lymphocytes percentage
Lym%
Monocytes number
Mon#
Monocytes percentage
Mon%
Immature Granulocyte number
IMG#
Immature Granulocyte percentage
IMG%
Reticulocyte percentage
*RET%
Reticulocyte number
*RET%
RBC
group (10)
Reticulocyte Hemoglobin Expression
RHE
Immature reticulocyte fraction
*IRF
Low fluorescent ratio
*LFR
Middle fluorescent ratio
*MFR
High fluorescent ratio
*HFR
Red Blood Cell count
RBC
Hemoglobin Concentration
HGB
Mean Corpuscular Volume
MCV 2-2
System Introduction
MCH
Mean Corpuscular Hemoglobin Mean Corpuscular Hemoglobin Concentration
MCHC
Red Blood Cell Distribution Width - Coefficient of Variation
RDW-CV
Red Blood Cell Distribution Width - Standard Deviation
RDW-SD HCT
Hematocrit Nucleated red blood cell number
NRBC#
Nucleated red blood cell percentage
NRBC%
Platelet series (7)
Platelet count
PLT
Mean Platelet Volume
MPV
Platelet Distribution Width
PDW
Plateletcrit
PCT
Immature Platelet Fraction
IPF
Platelet-large cell ratio
P-LCR
Platelet-large cell count
P-LCC
Table 2-2 Blood Sample Test Research Use Only (RUO) Parameters English name
Abbreviation
High fluorescent Cell number
HFC#
High fluorescent Cell percentage
HFC%
Optical Red Blood Cell count
RBC-O
Optical Platelet count
PLT-O
Platelet count- Impedance
PLT-I
Optical white blood cell count
WBC-O
White blood cell count –DIFF
WBC-D
Total nucleated cell counts-DIFF
TNC-D
Immature eosinophil percentage
IME%
Immature eosinophil number
IME#
High forward scatter NRBC ratio
H-NR%
Low forward scatter NRBC ratio
L-NR%
Neutrophil-to-lymphocyte ratio
NLR
Platelet-to-lymphocyte ratio
PLR
White blood cell count-WNB
WBC-N
Total nucleated cell counts-NRBC
TNC-N
Infected Red Blood Cell count
InR#
Infected Red Blood Cell permillage
InR‰ 2-3
System Introduction
Microcyte count
Micro#
Microcyte percentage
Micro%
Microcyte count
Macro#
Macrocyte percentage
Macro% MRV
Mean Reticulocyte Volume
PDW-SD
Platelet Distribution Width Standard Deviation
RPI
Reticulocyte Production Index High Fluorescent Immature Platelet Fraction
H-IPF
Immature Platelet Count
IPF#
RBC Fragment Count
FRC#
RBC Fragment Percentage
FRC%
Table 2-3 Blood Sample Test Histograms RBC Histogram
RBC Histogram
PLT Histogram
PLT Histogram Table 2-4 Blood Sample Test Scattergrams
DIFF Scattergram
DIFF Scattergram
WNB Scattergram
WNB Scattergram
*RET Scattergram
RET Scattergram
*PLT-O Scattergram
PLT-O Scattergram
*RET-EXT Scattergram
RET-EXT Scattergram Table 2-5 Blood Sample Test-Test Panels
Throughput (samples/hour)
Sample Volume (ul)
WB
WB
Capillary
PD
Blood
Capillary
PD
Blood
CBC
110
71
71
64.5
30
83
CBC+ DIFF
110
71
71
64.5
30
83
*CBC+DIFF+RET
65
49
46
64.5
30
83
*CBC+ RET
65
49
46
64.5
30
83
*RET
65
49
46
64.5
30
83
Note: The items with * only apply to BC-6000Plus, BC-6100Plus and BC-6200. The analyzer outputs the following test parameters in body fluid sample analysis:
2-4
System Introduction
Table 2-6 Body fluid sample test report parameters Series
English name
Abbreviation
WBC series (6)
White Blood Cell count-body fluid
WBC-BF
Total nucleated cell counts-body fluid
TC-BF#
Mononuclear cell number
MN#
Mononuclear cell percentage
MN%
Polymorphonuclear cell number
PMN#
Polymorphonuclear cell percentage
PMN%
(1) RBC
Red Blood Cell count-body fluid
RBC-BF
series Table 2-7 Body Fluid Sample Test Research Use Only (RUO) Parameters English name
Abbreviation
Eosinophils number- body fluid
Eos-BF#
Eosinophils percentage- body fluid
Eos-BF%
Neutrophils number- body fluid
Neu-BF#
Neutrophils percentage- body fluid
Neu-BF%
Lymphocytes number- body fluid
LY-BF#
Lymphocytes percentage- body fluid
LY-BF%
Monocytes number- body fluid
MO-BF#
Monocytes percentage- body fluid
MO-BF%
High fluorescent cell number- body fluid
HF-BF#
High fluorescent cell percentage- body fluid
HF-BF%
Red Blood Cell count-body fluid
RBC-BF
Note: The report parameter RBC-BF shows 3 decimal places; while the RUO parameter RBCBF shows 4 decimal places. Table 2-8 Body Fluid Sample Test Histograms RBC Histogram
2-5
System Introduction
Table 2-9 Body Fluid Sample Test Scattergrams DIFF Scattergram Table 2-10 Body Fluid Sample Test-Test Panels Body fluid analysis mode
2-6
System Introduction
2.3 Product Description 2.3.1 Product Structure and Components The analyzer consists of the sample processing unit, data management unit, result output unit and accessories.
2.3.2 Modules and Components
WARNING
Do not use anything sharp on the touch screen or strike on it.
Clean the touch screen with clean and soft cloth, as well as neutral cleanser or ethanol rather than chemical solution, acid or alkali solution.
Figure 2-1 Front side of BC-6000/BC-6000Plus/BC-6100/BC-6200Plus Open-sampling type
2-7
System Introduction
Figure 2-2 Front side of BC-6200, Open-sampling type
①
① ---- Touch screen
② ---- Status indicator
③ ---- Aspirate key
④ ---- Sample probe
⑤ ---- Autoloader
⑥ ---- Fluorescent dye compartment
⑦ ---- Count Key
⑧ ---- Mode switch key
Touch screen
The touch screen displays all alphanumeric and graphic data. You can use it to operate your analyzer
②
Status Indicator
The status indicator located under the touch
Ready: indicator
screen tells you about the status of the
stays in green
instrument including ready, running, error,
Running: indicator
standby and on/off, etc.
flickers in green Error: indicator stays in red standby: indicator stays in orange Off: indicator off Sample probe is lowering down: quickly flickers
③
Aspirate key
The [Aspirate] key is located behind the sample probe. Press the key to start analysis 2-8
/
System Introduction
or add diluent ④
Sample probe
The sample probe aspirates samples and
/
adds diluent ⑤
Autoloader
The autoloader is in the front of the analyzer.
/
You can use it to load tubes automatically. ⑥ ⑦
Fluorescent dye
Open the fluorescent dye compartment to
compartment
replace the fluorescent dyes
[Run] Key
When running samples under autoloading
/ /
mode, press the [Run] key to start analysis ⑧
Mode switch key
Press the mode switch key to quickly switch between the autoloading mode and the opensampling mode
2-9
/
System Introduction
Figure 2-3 Front side of BC-6000/BC-6000Plus/BC-6100/BC-6200Plus closed-sampling model
Figure 2-4 Front side of BC-6200 closed-sampling model
2-10
System Introduction
① ---- Touch screen
② ---- Fluorescent dye compartment
③ ----Autoloader
④ ---- Sample compartment
⑤ ---- Status indicator
⑥ ---- Count Key
⑦ ---- Mode switch key ①
Touch screen
The touch screen displays all alphanumeric and graphic data. You can use it to operate your analyzer
②
Status indicator
The status indicator located under
Ready: indicator stays in green
the touch screen tells you about
Running: indicator flickers in
the status of the instrument
green
including ready, running, error,
Error: indicator stays in red
standby and on/off, etc.
Sleep: indicator stays in orange Off: indicator off
③
Aspirate key
The [Aspirate] key is behind the sample probe. Press the key to start analysis or add diluent
④
Sample probe
The sample probe aspirates samples and adds diluent
⑤
Autoloader
The autoloader is in the front of the analyzer. You can use it to load tubes automatically.
⑥
Fluorescent dye
Open the fluorescent dye
compartment
compartment to replace the fluorescent dyes
⑧[Run] Key ⑧
Mode switch key
Press the key to start analysis Press the mode switch key to quickly switch between the autoloading mode and closedsampling mode
2-11
System Introduction
Figure 2-5 Back of the analyzer (both types) ① ---- Network interface
② ---- AC input
③ ---- M-6LH Lyse inlet
④ ---- M-6LN Lyse inlet
⑤ ---- M-6LD Lyse inlet
⑥ ---- M-6DR Diluent inlet
⑦ ---- DS Diluent inlet
⑧ ---- Waste outlet
2-12
System Introduction
Figure 2-6 Right side of the analyzer (both types) ① ---- USB ports
② ---- Power switch
Figure 2-7 Closed-sampling type (front cover open)
2-13
System Introduction
Figure 2-8 Open-sampling type (front cover open)
Figure 2-9 Both types (right side cover open)
2-14
System Introduction
Figure 2-10 Both types (left side cover open)
2.3.3 Accessories List of the Analyzer The configured and optional accessory list of the analyzer is shown below. Table 2-11 Configured and optional accessory list Configured Tube racks
Reagent cap assembly
Waste tube assembly
Main power cords
Optional
External barcode scanner
Autoloader Built-in barcode
scanner Printer
Sample transportation track
For any questions about the configured/optional accessories, consult your sales representative.
2-15
System Introduction
2.3.4 Tubes and Tube Racks Tube types supported by closed-sampling type analyzers Table 2-12 Tube types supported by closed-sampling type analyzers Mode
Tube types
Sample setting
Cap open?
positions Autoloading mode
Evacuated
blood
Tube racks
Capped
collection tube BD micro tube
Tube racks
Capped
Syringe tubes
Tube racks
Capped
CT-WB
Evacuated
(closed-sampling
collection tube
blood
WB tube position
Either
closed
PD/Micro-WB tube
Uncapped
type) CT-Micro-WB
Small
(closed-sampling
anticoagulated tube
type)
1.5ml centrifugal tube
position PD/Micro-WB tube
Uncapped
position 0.5ml centrifugal tube
PD/Micro-WB tube
Uncapped
position CT-PD
Small
(closed-sampling
anticoagulated tube
closed
type)
1.5ml centrifugal tube
PD/Micro-WB tube
Uncapped
position PD/Micro-WB tube
Uncapped
position CT-BF
Evacuated
blood
WB tube position
Either
(closed-sampling
collection tube
type)
Uncapped
hard/soft
WB tube position
Uncapped
tubes
WARNING
Do not use BD micro tubes or syringe tubes to run samples in closed-tube mode.
Uncap the tube before capillary or prediluted sample analysis.
2-16
System Introduction
Recommended tube types used with open-sampling type analyzers Table 2-13 Recommended tube types used with open-sampling type analyzers Mode
Tube types
Sample setting
Cap open?
positions Autoloading mode
Evacuated blood
Tube racks
Capped
BD micro tube
Tube racks
Capped
Syringe tubes
Tube racks
Capped
collection tube
In the open-sampling mode, after removing the tube cap, make sure the tube length is within 85mm.
CAUTION
Uncap the tube before capillary or prediluted sample analysis.
Use BD micro tubes and syringe tubes under autoloading mode If you are going to run samples collected with BD micro tubes and syringe tubes in autoloading mode, use tube racks specially made for the micro tubes and syringe tubes. The tube racks for BD micro tubes and syringe tubes have colored adapters installed at every tube position.
Figure 2-11 Special tube racks made for BD micro tubes and syringe tubes ① Colored adapters
2-17
System Introduction
2.4 Overview of Software Interfaces 2
1
3
4
5
① Menu Tap the
button at the top left of the software screen to display the system menu.
Below describes the software menu functions of the analyzer. Menu Level No. 1. 2.
Level 1
Level 2
Count
/
Table
/
Level 3
Review QC
L-J QC
Setup Count
3.
X-B QC
Setup Graph
Calibration
Manual Calibrator
4.
Fresh Blood CBC Gain Calibration Optical Gain Calibration
2-18
System Introduction
Calibration History Status
Statistics Temp.&Pressure Floater Status
5.
Sensor Voltage & Current Version Info. Setup
Print Setup Communication Barcode Date/Time Setup Lab Info. Setup System Setup
Signal Para. Flag Alarm Sensitivity Flag Rules Setup Alg-adjusted factors Tube Rack Type Setup Re-exam Setup
User Management 6.
Auxiliary Setup Parameter Unit Setup Reference Range Setup Para. Setup
RUO Para. Setup Microscopic Para. Setup
Maintenance Reagent Setup Auto-loading Gain Setup Re-exam Rules Setup Auto Startup/Shutdown Service
Adj. Sample Probe Pos. Adjust Autoload Pos.
7.
Debug & Self-Test
Self-Test Heating Debug Pressure Debug
2-19
System Introduction
Laser Diode Debug Sensor Debug Optical Debug
Maintenance Screen Cal. Log Advanced Toolbox 8.
Logout
/
9.
Shutdown
/
② Utility button area Name
Icon
Function
Count
Tap to enter the "Count" screen
Table
Tap to enter the "Table Review" screen
Review QC
Tap to enter the "QC" screen When the "QC" button lighted in orange, it means the analyzer is out of quality control
Reagent
Tap to enter the "Reagent Setup" screen, check
Setup
or set the remaining reagent value and expiration date, and replace the reagent; When the "Reagent Setup" button lights in orange, it means some reagent is expired or not sufficient
Diluent
When the analyzer switches to the Predilute (PD) analysis mode, tap "DILUENT" to dispense diluent
print
When the analyzer is on the "Count" screen, tap the "Print" button to print the analysis results, histograms and scattergrams of the current sample in accordance with operatorcustomized print template
When the analyzer is on the "Table Review" 2-20
System Introduction
screen, tap the "Print" button to print the analysis results for all or selected samples in the table print or graph print form
When the analyzer is on the "Graph Review" screen, tap the "Print" button to print the analysis
results,
histograms
and
scattergrams of the current sample in accordance with operator-customized print template
When the analyzer is on the "QC Table" screen, tap the "Print" button to print all QC results included in the selected QC file
When the analyzer is on the "QC Graph" screen, tap the "Print" button to print the QC graphs included in the selected QC file
When the analyzer is on the "Manual" screen, tap "Print" to print the manual calibration factors
③ Operation area It displays the contents of the corresponding screen. For example, on the "Count" screen, the area displays the corresponding keys for count operations and count results. ④ Auxiliary information area It displays the auxiliary information related to the current screen. For example, on the "Count" screen, the area displays the ID and analysis mode of the next sample; on the "Table Review" or "Graph Review" screen, the area displays the position and total number of the current sample. ⑤ Other information It displays the current system time; When error occurs, the area displays the error message.
2-21
System Introduction
2.5 Reagents, Controls and Calibrators As the analyzer, reagents, controls and calibrators are components of a system, performance of the system depends on the combined integrity of all components. Users must use the specified reagents (see the Specifications in the Appendix B), which are formulated specifically for the fluidic system of your analyzer in order to provide optimal system performance. Do not use the analyzer with reagents from multiple suppliers. In such use, the analyzer may not meet the performance specified in this manual and may provide unreliable results. All references related to reagents in this manual refer to the reagents specifically formulated for this analyzer.
CAUTION
Each reagent package must be examined before use. Product integrity may be compromised in packages that have been damaged. Inspect the package for signs of leakage or moisture. If there is evidence of leakage or improper handling, do not use the reagent.
Store and use the reagents as instructed by instructions for use of the reagents.
When you have changed the diluent, lyse or cleanser, run a background to see if the results meet the requirement.
Pay attention to the expiration dates and open-container stability days of all the reagents. Be sure not to use expired reagents.
After installing a new container of reagent, keep it still for a while before use.
2.5.1 Reagents
DS DILUENT
The DS DILUENT participates in the measurement of parameters related to RBC, PLT, WBC, RET and NRBC. This product participates in cell differentiation, counting and HGB measurement which are accomplished by using the impedance method, colorimetric method and SF Cube cell analysis technology (3D analysis using information from scatter of laser light at two angles and fluorescence signals).
M-6DR DILUENT
The M-6DR DILUENT participates in the measurement of RET-related parameters together with M-6FR DYE. 2-22
System Introduction
This product is formulated to lyse red blood cells in blood cell measurement, facilitate the dyeing effect of reticulocytes by M-6FR DYE. It participates in the measurement of RET-related parameters which is accomplished by using SF Cube cell analysis technology (3D analysis using information from scatter of laser light at two angles and fluorescence signals).
M-6LD LYSE
The M-6LD LYSE participates in WBC differentiation in the DIFF channel together with M-6FD DYE. This product is formulated to lyse red blood cells and process white blood cells in the blood cell measurement, amplify the differences among WBC sub-populations and facilitate the dyeing effect of white blood cells by M-6FD DYE. It participates in the measurement of WBC-related parameters which is accomplished by using SF Cube cell analysis technology (3D analysis using information from scatter of laser light at two angles and fluorescence signals).
M-6LH LYSE
The M-6LH LYSE is formulated to measure the hemoglobin-related parameters. This product is formulated to lyse red blood cells, release hemoglobin in red blood cells and transform it into methemoglobin, which enables the measurement of hemoglobin-related parameters by using the colorimetric method.
LM-6LN LYSE
This product participates in the measurement of NRBC-related parameters together with M6FN DYE. This product is formulated to lyse red blood cells in blood cell measurement, facilitate the dying effect of NRBCs by M-6FN DYE. It participates in the measurement of NRBC-related parameters which is accomplished by using SF Cube cell analysis technology (3D analysis using information from scatter of laser light at two angles and fluorescence signals).
M-6FD DYE
The M-6FD DYE participates in WBC differentiation in the DIFF channel together with M-6LD LYSE. This product is formulated to dye the white blood cells with the assist of M-6LD LYSE. It participates in the measurement of WBC-related parameters in the DIFF channel which is accomplished by using SF Cube cell analysis technology (3D analysis using information from scatter of laser light at two angles and fluorescence signals).
M-6FR DYE
The M-6FR DYE participates in the measurement of RET-related parameters together with M6DR DILUENT. This product is formulated to dye reticulocytes with the assist of M-6DR DILUENT. It participates in the measurement of RET-related parameters which is accomplished by using SF Cube cell analysis technology (3D analysis using information from scatter of laser light at two angles and 2-23
System Introduction
fluorescence signals).
M-6FN DYE
The M-6FN DYE is formulated to dye blood cells, for observing their morphology and structure and facilitating the cell differentiation and counting. During blood cell measurement, the M-6FN DYE is formulated to dye NRBCs with the assistance of the M-6LN LYSE, and perform NRBC measurement by combining laser scattering and SF Cube cell analysis techniques.
Probe Cleanser
The probe cleaner is formulated to clean the analyzer on a regular basis; it is a cleaning solution containing sodium hypochlorite, which can clean the measurement channels and pipelines and remove blood proteins. *Note: *M-6FR DYE and M-6DR DILUENT are only applicable to BC-6000Plus, BC-6100Plus and BC-6200 models.
2.5.2 Controls and Calibrators The controls and calibrators are used to verify the accurate operation and calibrate the analyzer. The controls are industrially prepared whole-blood products used to monitor and evaluate the analysis precision of the Hematology Analyzer. The controls are prepared with three levels, namely low, normal and high. Daily use of all levels verifies the operation of the analyzer and ensures reliable results are obtained. The calibrators are also industrially prepared whole-blood products, specifically manufactured for the calibration of WBC, RBC, HGB, MCV, PLT and other parameters of the Hematology Analyzer, so as to build the metrological traceability of analysis results. For the use and storage of controls and calibrators, please refer to the Instruction for Use of each product. All references related to "controls" and "calibrators" in this manual refer to the controls and calibrators specifically formulated for this analyzer by Mindray. You must buy those controls and calibrators from Mindray or Mindray-authorized distributors. There are 3 types of controls used with the analyzer: Table 2-14 Controls Name BR60
Hematology
Model BR60
Control BC-6D
Levels "High", "Low",
Type
QC Parameters
Others
All report parameters1*
Mindray
All
"Normal" Hematology
BC-6D
Controls
"High", "Low", "Normal"
report
parameters
except RET group parameters2*
BC-RET Hematology Controls
BC-RET
"High", "Low",
Mindray
RET group parameters4*
"Normal"
Note: 1.
The specific measurement parameters and reference values are available in the control reference
2-24
System Introduction value table; 2.
The specific measurement parameters and reference values are available in the control reference value table;
3.
Only applicable to BC-6000Plus, BC-6100Plus and BC-6200. The specific measurement parameters and reference values are available in the control reference value table.
The calibrators used with the analyzer: Table 2-15 Calibrators Name
Model
SC-CAL PLUS Hematology Calibrator
SC-CAL PLUS
2-25
Chapter 3 System Principles 3.1 Overview The principles used by the analyzer for measurement are: impedance method and SF Cube cell analysis technology for cell differentiation and counting; colorimetric method for hemoglobin measurement.
3-1
System Principles
3.2 WBC Measurement 3.2.1 SF CUBE Cell Analysis Technology In normal peripheral blood, white blood cells can be classified into 5 categories: lymphocytes, monocytes, neutrophils, eosinophils and basophils. Analyzing all types of white blood cells will provide a great deal of useful information for the clinical diagnosis of diseases. Under the influence of certain diseases, the peripheral blood may contain various abnormal cells apart from the five subpopulations of normal cells, such as atypical lymphocytes, immature cells, etc. Most of these abnormal cells are different kinds of immature cells in the cell generation process. But what they have in common is they contain a great deal of nucleic acid (DNA and RNA), the content of which decreases as the cell gets maturer. Therefore, normal cells and immature cells can be differentiated by detecting the content of nucleic acid in the cells. Body fluid refers to the fluid in side body cavities except blood vessels. There are many subtypes of body fluid, among which the most commonly seen sub-types are cerebrospinal fluid and serous cavity fluid. Both cerebrospinal fluid and serous cavity fluid are colorless and transparent in normal case, but in abnormal cases, there could be increase of cells (including leukocytes and erythrocytes). Leukocytes in body fluid can be categorized into mononuclear cells (MN) and polymorphonuclear cells (PMN). The analysis of the cells in body fluid can provide useful information for clinical diagnosis. The analyzer adopts the SF Cube cell analysis technology to recognize and detect the immature cells in blood accurately based on doing WBC 5-part differentiation, as well as identify the nucleated cells in body fluid.
Fluorescence
Light
RNA/DNA content
Side scatter
splitter
Internal cell structure
Laser beam Forward scatter Cell volume
Figure 3-1 SF Cube Technology The analyzer adopts the SF Cube cell analysis technology in its DIFF and WNB channels. The RBCs are lysed and the WBC subpopulations are made different in size and complexity by the lyse; the nucleic acid substances in WBCs are marked by the new asymmetric cyanine 3-2
System Principles
fluorescent substance. Due to the different content of nucleic acid in different WBC subpopulations, maturity stages or abnormal development status, the volume of fluorescent dye staining the nucleic acid substances can be different; the low-angle light scatter reflects cell size, the high-angle light scatter reflects intracellular granularity, and the intensity of fluorescent signal reflects the degree that the cell is stained. By sensing the difference in signal in three dimensions of the cells processed with lyse, the DIFF channel differentiates the subpopulations of WBCs (lymphocytes, monocytes, neutrophil and eosinophils), as well as identifies and flags abnormal cells like immature granulocytes, abnormal lymphocytes and blast cells. In the meanwhile, the WNB channel differentiates basophils and nucleated red blood cells and counts the WBCs. The lymphocytes are smaller in size with the nucleus taking most part of them. Lymphocytes have a high nucleus-to-cytoplasm ratio, but their nucleic acid content is low, therefore they are at a lower position in the direction of fluorescence and side scatter. The monocytes are larger in size, with high nucleus-to-cytoplasm ratio and high nucleic acid content, and less complex in structure, therefore they are at a higher position in the direction of fluorescence, and have stronger side scatter. The neutrophils and basophils are larger in size, and have medium nucleus-to-cytoplasm ratio and low nucleic acid content, therefore they are at a lower position in the direction of fluorescence, but they have stronger side scatter. The characteristics of the eosinophils are similar to those of the neutrophils, but they contain a lot of alkaline grains, so they have very strong side scatter. The blast cells, atypical lymphocytes and immature granulocytes have high nucleic acid content, so they are at a higher position in the direction of fluorescence on the scattergram. In body fluid samples, the mononuclear cells (MN) are less complex in intracellular granularity, so the side scatter is weaker, while polymorphonuclear cells are more complex in intracellular granularity, so the side scatter is stronger.
3.2.2 WBC-Related Parameters WNB Scattergram 1. WBC area 2. Bas area 3. Achromatocyte area 4. NRBC area
3-3
System Principles
WNB Scattergram 5. WBC area 6. Bas area 7. Achromatocyte area 8. NRBC area
Parameters WBC
Item
Formula/Test Methods
Unit 109/
White
WBC
blood cell
= Sum of all particles in the WBC reagion in the WNB channel L
count Bas# Bas%
109/
Basophils
Bas#
number
L = Sum of all particles in the Bas reagion in the WNB channel
Basophils percentag
Bas% =
Bas# × 100% WBC
%
e Lym%
Lymphoc ytes percentag
%
Lym% =
e
Particles in the Lym region in the DIFF channel Sum of all particles in DIFF channel except those in Ghost region
× 100%
Neu%
Neutrophi ls percentag
%
Neu% =
e
Particles in the Neu region in the DIFF channel Sum of all particles in DIFF channel except those in Ghost region
× 100%
Mon%
Monocyte s percentag
%
Mon% =
e
Particles in the Mon region in the DIFF channel Sum of all particles in DIFF channel except those in Ghost region
× 100%
Eos%
Eosinophi ls percentag e
%
Eos% =
Particles in the Eos region in the DIFF channel Sum of all particles in DIFF channel except those in Ghost region
× 100%
3-4
System Principles
IMG%
Immature Granuloc yte percentag
Lym#
%
IMG% =
Particles in the IMG region in the DIFF channel Sum of all particles in DIFF channel except those in Ghost region
e
× 100%
Lymphoc
Lym# = WBC × Lym%
ytes
109/ L
number Neu#
Neutrophi
Neu# = WBC × Neu%
ls number Mon#
Monocyte
L Mon# = WBC × Mon%
s number Eos#
Eosinophi Immature
109/ L
Eos# = WBC × Eos%
ls number IMG#
109/
109/ L
IMG# = WBC × IMG%
Granuloc
109/ L
yte number
3-5
System Principles
3.3 Derivation of NRBC-Related Parameters Parameters NRBC%
Item
Formula/Test Methods
Nucleated Red Blood
Cell
percentage
Unit %
NRBC% Particles in the NRBC region of the WNB channel = Sum of all particles in the WBC region of the WNB channel × 100%
NRBC#
Nucleated Red
NRBC#=Sum of all particles in the NRBC region of
Blood
the WNB channel
Cell
count
3-6
109/L
System Principles
3.4 Hemoglobin Concentration Measurement 3.4.1 A Test Model Using the Colorimetric Method
Figure 3-2 Colorimetric Method According to the Lambert-Beer Principle, when a beam of monochromatic light passes through a well-proportioned non-scattering light-absorbing solution, the absorbance A is proportional to the product of the thickness L and the concentration C. The sample in the HGB channel acts as the light absorbing substance after being treated by reagent, therefore the HGB concentration can be measured by measuring the absorbance.
3.4.2 HGB Measurement The Hemoglobin Concentration (HGB) is calculated per the following equation and expressed in g/L. Parameters HGB
Item
Formula/Test Methods
Hemoglobin
HGB
Concentration
Blank Photocurrent = Constant × Ln( ) Sample Photocurrent
Unit g/L
3-7
System Principles
3.5 RBC/PLT Measurement 3.5.1 Impedance Method RBCs/PLTs are counted by the Electrical Impedance method. The aspirated sample enters the RBC metering unit after two times of dilution. The little opening on the metering unit is called "aperture". A pair of electrodes is positioned on both sides of the aperture to create a constantcurrent supply. As cells are poor conductors, when each particle in the diluted sample passes through the aperture under the constant negative pressure, a transitory change in the directcurrent resistance between the electrodes is produced. The change in turn produces a measurable electrical pulse signal which is proportional to the particle size at both ends of the electrodes. And when the particles pass the aperture in succession, a series of pulses are produced between the electrodes. The number of pulses generated indicates the number of particles passed through the aperture; and the amplitude of each pulse is proportional to the volume of each particle.
Figure 3-3 Metering diagram Each pulse is amplified and compared to the internal reference voltage channel, which only accepts the pulses of a certain amplitude. All the collected pulses are thus classified based on the reference voltage thresholds of different channels, and the number of the pluses in the RBC/PLT channel indicates the number of the RBC/PLT particles. The number of cells in each channel range divided according to the pulse voltage amplitude determines the cell volume distribution. The 2-dimensional distribution diagram (scattergram), with the X-axis representing cell volume, and Y-axis representing relative cell numbers, shows the distribution of cell population.
3-8
System Principles
3.5.2 SF CUBE Cell Analysis Technology The RET channel also adopts the SF CUBE Cell Analysis Technology. The general measurement principle in RET channel is similar to that of WNB and DIFF channels, only that in the RET channel, the RBCs are not lysed, but are spherized by RET diluent. Then the nucleic acid of the spherized RBCs and the PLTs are stained by fluorescent dyes.
3.5.3 RBC-Related Parameters Parameters RBC
Item
Formula/Test Methods
Red Blood Cell count
Unit
The analyzer provides the number of red blood cells (RBC) directly by counting the red blood cells passing through the aperture.
MCV
Mean
Corpuscular
Volume
fL
histogram
HCT
Hematocrit
MCH
Mean
Corpuscular
Hemoglobin MCHC
Calculated based on the red blood cell
Mean
Corpuscular
Hemoglobin
HCT =
RBC × MCV 10
%
MCH =
HGB RBC
pg
MCHC =
HGB × 100 HCT
g/L
Concentration RDW-CV
Red
Blood
Distribution
Cells
Width
RBC Histogram
%
Standard deviation of RBC distribution
fL
-
Coefficient of Variation RDW-SD
Red
Blood
Distribution
Cells
Width
-
Standard Deviation
3.5.4 PLT-Related Parameters Parameters
Item
Formula/Test Methods
PLT
Platelet
Platelet number (PLT) is measured directly by
count
counting the platelets passing through the
Unit 109/L
aperture. MPV
Mean
Mean Platelet Volume (MPV) is calculated based
Platelet
on the PLT histogram.
fL
Volume PDW
PCT
Platelet
Platelet distribution width is derived from the
Distribution
platelet histogram, and is reported as 10
Width
geometric standard deviation (10 GSD)
Plateletcrit
PCT =
PLT×MPV 10000 3-9
/
%
System Principles
P-LCR1*
Plateletlarge
P-LCC
P-LCR is derived from the platelet histogram, it cell
%
represents the ratio of the number of platelets
ratio
with a size over 12fL to the total platelets number.
Platelet-
P − LCC = PLT × P − LCR
109/L
Immature
Derived based on PLT-O scattergram:
%
Platelet
IPF
large
cell
count IPF
、
Fraction
=
Immature platelet number in the optical channel Sum of all platelet particles in the optical channel
× 100%
Note: 1. Platelet-Large Cell Ratio (P-LCR) is derived from the platelet histogram; it represents the ratio of the number of platelets with a size over 12fL to the total platelets number. The ratio is represented in %. In the following figure, S2 represents the number of larger platelet cells, and S1+S2 represents the total PLT count.
2. Only applicable to BC-6000Plus, BC-6100Plus and BC-6200.
3.5.5 Reticulocyte Parameters Parameters *RET%
Name Reticulocy
Formula/Test Methods RET%
te percentag e
=
Unit %
Number of cells in the reticulocyte region Number of cells in mature RBC region + Number of cells in RET region
× 100% RET#
RET# = RBC × RET%
Reticulocy te number
*HFR
High Fluoresce
1012/ L
HFR =
Number of cells in HFR region × 100% Number of cells in RET region
nt Reticulocy 3-10
%
System Principles
te Ratio *MFR
Middle Fluoresce
MFR =
Number of cells in MFR region × 100% Number of cells in RET region
%
nt Reticulocy te Ratio *LFR
LFR = 100 − HFR − MFR
%
IRF = MFR + HFR
%
Reticulocy
Calculated based on the light scatter information of
pg
te
RET
Low Fluoresce nt Reticulocy te Ratio
*IRF
Immature Reticulocy te Fraction
RHE
Hemoglobi n Expressio n *Note: The RET parameters are only applicable to BC-6000Plus, BC-6100Plus and BC-6200.
3-11
System Principles
3.6 Body Fluid Parameters Body fluid refers to the fluid in side body cavities except blood vessels. There are many subtypes of body fluid, among which the most commonly seen sub-types are cerebrospinal fluid and serous cavity fluid. Both cerebrospinal fluid and serous cavity fluid are colorless and transparent in normal case, but in abnormal cases, there could be increase of cells (including leukocytes and erythrocytes). Leukocytes in body fluid can be categorized into mononuclear cells (MN) and polymorphonuclear cells (PMN). The analysis of the cells in body fluid can provide useful information for clinical diagnosis. Parameters WBC-BF
Item White
Formula/Test Methods Blood
Cell count-body
WBC − BF
MN%
109/L
= The sum of all particles in DIFF channel except Those in ghost region and HFR region
fluid TC-BF#
Unit
109/L
Total nucleated
TC − BF
cell counts-body
= The sum of all particles in Diff channel except
fluid
those in ghost region
Mononuclear
MN%
cell percentage
=
%
Particles in MN reagion of DIFF channel WBC − BF
× 100% PMN%
Polymorphonucl ear
cell
percentage
PMN% =
%
Particles in PMN reagion of DIFF channel WBC − BF
× 100% MN#
MN# = WBC − BF × MN%
109/L
PMN# = WBC − BF × PMN%
109/L
Red Blood Cell
The analyzer provides the number of red blood
1012/
count-body fluid
cells in body fluid (RBC-BF) directly by counting
L
Mononuclear cell number
PMN#
Polymorphonucl ear cell number
RBC-BF
the red blood cells passing through the aperture.
3-12
System Principles
3.7 Flush After each analysis cycle, all elements of the analyzer that the sample runs through are washed to ensure no residue is left.
3-13
Chapter 4 Software System 4.1 Login Password Service level User ID: Service Password: Se s700 (note there is a space between Se and s700). Administrator level user ID: Admin Password: Admin
NOTE
Password is case sensitive.
4.1.1 System Self-test When Logging in at Service Access Level When you log in at service access level, the analyzer will automatically run a check matching the backup data on the board card with the data in the SSD hard disk. If the board card or SSD hard disk has been replaced before, or the analyzer detects the configuration change before the abnormal shutdown, you will be prompted to restore the system or back up data. Tap "OK" to enter the backup and restoration screen, follow the prompts to complete the data backup or restoration: When the SSD hard disk has been replaced, follow the instruction and "restore" the important parameters to the new SSD hard disk. When the main control board has been replaced, follow the instruction and "backup" the data to the new main control board.
NOTE
Always perform the shutdown procedure before replacing the SSD hard disk or main control board, so the data will be automatically backed up by the software.
4-1
Software System
4.2 Calibration 4.2.1 Manual Calibration Users logged in with a service level account can enter the manual calibration screen to modify WBC/RBC/HGB/MCV/PLT/RBC-O/PLT-O factory calibration factors, Micro-WB transfer factor, PD transfer factor, and WBC-D transfer factor. Out-of-factory calibration factors should only be modified when it is absolutely necessary; and after modification, you must run samples and make sure the tests results are correct.
Figure 4-1
4-2
Software System
Figure 4-2
4.2.2 Calibration with Calibrators
Figure 4-3 Calibrator Interface at Service Access Level When performing calibration with calibrator at service access level, the analyzer calculates all 4-3
Software System
factory calibration factors automatically. The AL-WB calibration is used first. When there are 6 or more calibrations, you will be prompted to run the PD transfer factor calibration; when 6 calibrations are counted, a dialog box will be displayed prompting you to run the MicroWB calibration; when 6 calibrations have been done, you will be prompted to save the new calibration factors when exiting the screen. Before calibration, make sure to set up the lot numbers, expiration dates, analysis modes and the target values for the calibrators.
Parameters
Range
9
WBC
Factor
CV
≥ 4×10 /L
WB ≤ 2.5%
≥0.75
≤2%
Not Need
PD
and
>2%,≤6%
Recommended
≤1.25
>6%
Not Recommended
≤
4.0%
HGB
(110 ~ 180)
WB ≤ 1.0%
g/L*
PD ≤ 2.0%
12
RBC
≥3.5×10 /L
MCV
(80~100) fL*
9
PLT
≥ 100×10 /L
12
RBC-O
≥3.5×10 /L
9
PLT-O
≥ 100×10 /L
WBC-D
Same as WBC
WB ≤ 1.5% PD ≤ 2.0%
WB ≤ 1.0% PD ≤ 3.0% WB ≤ 4.0% PD ≤ 8.0%
WB ≤ 1.5% PD ≤ 2.0%
WB ≤ 4.0% PD ≤ 8.0% Same
≥0.75 and ≤1.25 ≥0.75 and ≤1.25
≤1.5% > 1.5% , ≤4.5% >4.5% ≤1.5% > 1.5% , ≤4.5% >4.5%
Not Need Recommended Not Recommended Not Need Recommended Not Recommended
≥0.75
≤1%
Not Need
and
>1%,≤3%
Recommended
≤1.25
>3%
Not Recommended
≥0.75
≤4%
Not Need
and
>4%,≤10%
Recommended
≤1.25
>10%
Not Recommended
≥0.75 and ≤1.25
≤1.5% > 1.5% , ≤4.5% >4.5%
Not Need Recommended Not Recommended
≥0.5
≤4%
Not Need
and
>4%,≤10%
Recommended
≤1.5
>10%
Not Recommended
as
WBC
CAUTION
Software prompts
range
Never use expired calibrators.
4-4
Software System
NOTE
If the calibrated factors or CVs are out of allowable range, they will be displayed in red, and the values cannot be saved.
Running calibration at service access level will reset the user-defined calibration factor to 100%.
4-5
Software System
4.3 Optical Gain Calibration Menu - Calibration - Optical Gain Calibration 1
Select the Calibrator mode.
2
Enter the gain targets.
3
Place a tube at the first tube position in a tube rack.
4
Start autoloading test.
5
When autoloading is completed, place the tube rack back to the loading area and run it again.
6
When valid gains are calculated, click “Save” and exit the current screen.
Figure 4-4 Note that the optical gain calibration factors will affect the test results. Always confirm run tests after optical gain calibration, and make sure the tests results are correct.
4-6
Software System
4.4 Review 4.4.1 Export Table Review-Export
Figure 4-5 Follow the software instruction to select the content to be exported. When there are many sample records, keep in mind that it will take you a relatively long time to export a large volume of data if you select to export all records, with the inf. files and graphs.
4-7
Software System
4.4.2 Special information
Figure 4-6 Meanings of special information HGB background voltage
The voltage when diluent is added to the HGB reaction bath
HGB measurement voltage
The voltage when blood sample and lyses are added to the HGB reaction bath
DIFF channel particle number
Total particle count at the DIFF channel
WNB channel particle number
Total particle count measured at the WNB channel
RET channel particle number
Total particle count at the RET channel
RBC particle number
Total RBC particle count at the impedance channel
PLT particle number
Total PLT particle count measured at the impedance channel
4-8
Software System
4.5 Setup screen 4.5.1 Maintenance Menu Setup-Maintenance
Set the wait time before the analyzer entering standby.
Set up the auto probe cleanser maintenance time
Set up other conditions to trigger Probe Cleanser maintenance, including intervals (after setting the interval, a more complicated Probe Cleanser maintenance time sequence will be called. For example, the setting in below graph requires for every 7 days, the more complicated Probe Cleanser procedure will be performed during analyzer shutdown or during auto maintenance), and the total test thresholds for different channels.
Figure 4-7
4.5.2 Reagent Setup When there is no reagent-related error warnings 1
Select the reagents that need to be set (multiple options allowed). And tap “Setup”.
4-9
Software System
2
Scan or manually enter the barcode.
3
After setting up all the reagents, you can tap the Replace button.
Figure 4-8 When there are reagent-related warnings (reagent expired, low volume, etc.) 1.
Tap “Setup” on the “Reagent Setup” screen.
4-10
Software System
2
Scan or manually enter the barcode, and tap “Replace” to replace the reagents.
When the warnings occur during the auto-loading analysis process, a “reagent setup” dialog box automatically displays.
4-11
Software System
4.5.3 Communication
Figure 4-9 Communication setup
Data Communication Channel
Choose LIS or labXpert
Note that if labXpert is selected here, when there are QC settings on the main unit software and the labXpert, the labXpert QC setting will prevail. LIS
When LIS is used, set the analyzer as the server, and the LIS serves as the client. The port is 5100. When LIS is selected, configure ACK synchronization overtime, auto retransmit,
auto
communication,
print
bitmap
transmission,
scattergram or histogram transmit methods etc. as necessary. labXpert
When “labXpert” is selected, “Reexam communication timeout” is set. The default value is 5 seconds.
Protocol setup
IP Address: Set the IP for the analyzer; 10.0.0.12 by default Subnet mask: Subnet mask for the analyzer network; use 255.255.255.0 for most cases 4-12
Software System
Default gateway: Gateway IP
Mac address: The Mac address of the analyzer is fixed by manufacturer and cannot be changed.
4.5.4 Gain Setup Setup - Gains Setup
Figure 4-10 Gain setup Tap the WB, PD, and BF mode tabs, and set FS, SS, FL and PMT gains for the DIFF, WNB and RET channels. The MCV_G and HGB gains set on the WB mode are shared by all modes.
NOTE
As the gain settings will affect the test results, be careful when you adjust them.
4.5.5 Auxiliary Setup Setup - Auxiliary Setup: to set sample ID entry method: Auto Increase or Manual Entry. Set up for the “First sample after startup”. Set whether to use Auto-Scan rack No.
4-13
Software System
4-14
Software System
4.6 Debug & Self-Test 4.6.1 Adjust. Sample Probe Positions Menu - Service - Debug & Self-Test - Adj. Sample Probe Pos.
Figure 4-11 For information about how to adjust sample probe positions, refer to 5.2.5 Sampling assembly. 1
Select the position to be adjusted.
2
Tap "Start".
3
Select "Fine Adjustment" or "Coarse Adjustment”.
4
After completing the adjustment, tap "Save Steps" to exit the screen.
5
The buttons in the “Position Observe” area are used to observe the positions after adjustment. Tap “Horizontal Pos.”, the sample probe moves horizontally and stays at a position above the target position (around the centre of its working position in the Y direction). Tap “Vertical Pos.” the sample probe lowers down to the target position. You can check whether the adjustment gives satisfactory results by observing the sample probe position against the fixture.
6
After the adjustment, tap the “Verfity” button to verify the positions other than the Vertical Direction Home Pos.. The sample probe moves to its final working position.Before position verification, take away the fixtures.
4-15
Software System
Figure 4-12 Note: pressing “All to Factory Settings” will restore all position adjustment values to the factory configuration.
4.6.2 Adjust Autoloader Position Menu - Service - Debug & Self-Test - Adjust Autoload Pos. 1
Select the position to be adjusted.
2
Tap "Start".
3
Select "Fine Adjustment" or "Coarse Adjustment”
4
After completing the adjustment, tap "Save Steps" to exit the screen.
5
Calibrate the position.
4-16
Software System
Figure 4-13 Note: pressing “All to Factory Settings” will restore all position adjustment values to the factory configuration.
4.6.3 Auto-loading Debug Menu - Service - Debug & Self-Test - Adjust Autoload Pos. includes: Mix Mechanism, Feed end pos., etc.
4-17
Software System
Figure 4-14
4.6.4 Sensor Debug Menu - Service - Debug&Self-Test - Sensor Debug includes: Dye Sensors. Recalibrate the sensor after replacing the sensor or DYE connection tubing. Calibration method: After taping Calibrate, check whether the analysis voltage is within the reference range, and then tap Save.
Figure 4-15
4-18
Software System
4.6.5 Optical Debug Menu - Service - Debug&Self-Test - Optical Debug To confirm optical system debug. For debug details, see 9.40 Optical System.
Figure 4-16
4-19
Software System
4.7 Status The “Status” menu displays the analyzer’s temperature, pressures, voltages, current, floater status and sensor status. You can also find the software version information under the menu.
Figure 4-17 Status-Sensor Status When you tap Menu-“Status”-“Sensor”-“Drive Board” and enter the sensor status screen, all the motors displayed on the screen (except for that of the DIL (10mL) syringe, the ASP (100uL) syringe and SP (250uL) syringe) are relased of the moment placed on them. You will see the tube gripper lowers down, and you can now move the aspiration assembly in the horizontal direction. When you exit the screen, the analyzer initializes all these motors to their original status by placing moment on them again
4.8 Indicators The indicator on the front cover of the analyzer may light in 3 colors. When it flickers, it flickers every 2 seconds. The indicator changes according to the instrument status, the table below describes the corresponding meanings: Table 4-1 Main unit status indicator Analyzer status
Indicators
Notes
Ready
Stay in green
Waiting for actions
Running
Flicker in green
Performing actions
Running with error
Flicker in red
Running with error
Error and not running
Stay in red
There is/are error(s), and the analyzer is not running
No error, but fluidic actions are not
Stay in yellow
allowed
Startup initialization or standby, not involving fluidic actions
4-20
Software System
Enter/exit standby
Flicker in yellow
Enter/exit standby
Sample Probe is lowering down (for
Quickly flicker in
/
open-sampling type analyzers
yellow
4-21
Software System
4.9 Advanced Toolbox The "Advanced Toolbox" provides two functions: language switch and data export The screen is shown below.
Figure 4-18 Advanced toolbox
4.9.1 Language Setup The analyzer supports the Chinese and English languages.
NOTE
New language setting will become effective after analyzer re-start.
4.9.2 Debug Data Export You can use this function to export instrument information, software debug information, reproducibility test results, accuracy test results, factory calibration results, background test results, carryover results, aging data, as well as gain calibration results, system self-test results, version information, configuration information, inf. files, user operation logs and LIS communication logs.
4-22
Software System
Figure 4-19 Debug Data Export
NOTE
The USB should have been formatted to FAT32 before you copy and paste the "update" directory to it.
Recommended USB models: Kingston 8/16G, SanDisk 8/16G, Maxell 4/8G.
Make sure there is enough free space (at least 4G) on the USB.
See the table below for the specific exported data type when you select each software option. Table 4-2 Exported data by options Software option
Exported data
Instrument information
Software
Notes version,
The following items are all saved in
temperature and pressure,
a single csv file:
sensor status, floater status,
Software version, temperature and
voltage¤t,
gains,
pressure, sensor status, floater
calibration factors,
aging
status,
performance
data,
blank
calibration factors, heating debug
performance
data,
data (table), laser diode debug
count
4-23
voltage¤t,
gains,
Software System
Software option
Exported data
Notes
carryover
performance
data,
repeatability
performance
data,
logs,
calibration logs, L-J QC data,
X-B
accuracy
QC
data,
data, heating
debug data (table), pressure debug data (table), laser diode debug data, baseline debug data
data, baseline debug data
The following information are saved respectively, in different csv. Files: aging performance data,
blank
count performance data, carryover performance
data,
repeatability
performance data, logs, calibration logs, L-J QC data, X-B QC data, accuracy data, pressure debug data (table)
SW debug data
Information of Table Review
/
screen Inf file
Inf file, curve file
/
Sample data
Trace logs, update logs,
/
labXpert
communication
logs, pressure debug data, pressure
debug
data,
database file (6000.db), etc file folder, config file folder, optical debug data
4.9.3 Enable “Low Speed Scan” for Low Quality Sample Barcode This function is only available on analyzers configured with a built-in barcode scanner. When the barcode labels used at customer’s site are not of good quality, for example, not clear, or are contaminated, or get worn out, enable “Low speed scan”.
NOTE
When “Low speed scan” is enabled, inform the user that the analyzer throughput will lower down a little.
1
Tap "Menu" > "Service" > "Advanced Toolbox" to enter the “Advanced Toolbox” screen.
4-24
Software System
2
Check “With internal barcode scanner” and “Low speed scan”.
4-25
Software System
4.10 Software Update 4.10.1 Prepare the USB for update Copy the update.tar.gz file to the root directory of the formatted USB.
NOTE
The USB should have been formatted to FAT32 before you copy and paste the "update" directory to it.
Only the update.tar.gz file is in the root directory of the USB. You must not modify the file name. You must not unzip the file.
4.10.2 Update 1
Insert the USB to one of the USB ports on the analyzer, and perform update following either of the below methods:
2
Version Info. - Details - Update;
Figure 4-20 Version Info. The "Update" process includes two steps: Step 1: update the guide and operation system; 4-26
Software System
Step 2: update the software module. If the update guide and the operation system are also needed to be updated, the system will prompt you to restart the analyzer between step 1 and step 2; if only the software module need to be updated, the update will start from step 2 directly.
CAUTION
Do not pull the USB or disconnect power during the update; otherwise the analyzer may not start.
NOTE
The update usually takes about 10 minutes but depends on the number of modules to be updated. Do not leave the analyzer as the process requires user operation.
4.10.3 When Update Fails If the update fails, try again.
4-27
Software System
4.11 Communication Troubleshooting
Physical connection
Check whether the network cable is properly connected; and whether the network physical connection is correct.
Communication
Check whether the network settings (including the communication setup for both analyzer and LIS) are correct.
Network firewall
4-28
Chapter 5 Mechanical System 5.1 Introduction to Mechanical Structure The analyzer is mainly composed of the following components: cover, rack, autoloader, optical assembly, sampling assembly, rotary scanning assembly, stabilizing assembly, power supply, hardware board, syringe, dosing pump, bath, valve assembly, wires, pipes, etc. And their specific positions are introduced in the following figure.
Figure 5-1 Main unit structure 1
Figure 5-2 Main unit structure 2
5-1
Mechanical System
Figure 5-3 Main unit structure 3 1
Autoloader
2
Pinch valve assembly
3
Power supply
4
Bürkert valve
5
Bath assembly
6
Optical assembly
7
Gas tank
8
Valve Drive Board
9
Heating control board
10
Valve Drive Board
11
Hard disk
12
Main Control Board
13
Preheating
14
Display
15
DYE detection sensor
18
Waste
bath
assembly 16
screen
and
cover
DYE bag
17
Sampling assembly
and
reagent
connector 19
Reagent
detection
20
Valve assembly
21
Dosing pump assembly
assembly 22
Valve assembly
23
Bath assembly
24
Gas Valve assembly
25
Syringe
26
Rotary
27
Scanner
30
RET
scanning
assembly 28
HGB
test
bath
29
assembly 31
RBC test assembly
DIFF
reaction
bath
assembly 32
Right
reaction
bath
assembly
side
valve
33
Network Interface
assembly 34
USB ports
5.1.1 Front Side of the Analyzer The front side of the analyzer mainly includes the touch screen and buttons, as well as the autoloader door (closed-sampling model). Their positions are as follows.
5-2
Mechanical System
Figure 5-4 Front side of the Analyzer 1 --- Touch screen
2 --- Count/Mode switch key
3 --- Indicator
4 --- Autoloader door (closed-sampling model)
5.1.2 Rear Side of the Analyzer The rear side of the analyzer mainly includes the network port, power socket, reagent inlets and exhaust fan. Their positions are as follows.
Figure 5-5 Rear side of the Analyzer
5-3
Mechanical System
1 --- Network port
2 --- AC input
3---- M-6LH Lyse inlet
4---- M-6LN Lyse inlet
5---- M-6LD Lyse inlet
6---- M-6DR Diluent inlet
7---- DS Diluent inlet
8---- Waste outlet
5.1.3 Left Side of the Analyzer On the left side of the analyzer, the reagent inlets and reagent detection are at the lower left side; the valves controlling various tubes, dosing pump assembly, and dosing pump are located in the middle part; the syringes are distributed at the lower right side to provide power for the accurate aspiration. See the following figure.
Figure 5-6 Left Side of the Analyzer 18
Fluid
and
reagent
19
connector 21
Dosing
Reagent
detection
20
Valve assembly
23
Bath assembly
assembly pump
22
Valve assembly
25
Syringe
assembly 24
Gas Valve assembly
5.1.4 Right Side of the Analyzer The right side of the analyzer mainly includes HGB bath, DIFF reaction bath, RET reaction bath (only for high-configuration models), RBC bath, and four USB ports. Refer to the following figure for their specific positions.
5-4
Mechanical System
Figure 5-7 Right Side of the Analyzer 28
HGB test bath assembly
29
DIFF
reaction
bath
30
assembly 31
RBC test assembly
32
Right
34
USB ports
5-5
reaction
bath
assembly side
assembly
RET
valve
33
Network Interface
Mechanical System
5.2 Mechanics Subsystem Introduction 5.2.1 Autoloader The autoloader is used for storing and transporting the tube rack. There are two types of autoloaders, the OV type autoloader which is used with the opensampling type analyzers, and the CT type autoloader, which is used with the closed-sampling type analyzers. The only differences between the two autoloaders is that the OV type autolader has an open loading space and an [Aspirate] key, and the latter has a closed sample compartment. However, the auto loading structure and functions of the two autoloaders are exactly the same. Front housing locking screw
OV aspirate key
Figure 5-8 Autoloader for open-sampling type analyzers Front housing locking screw
Closed sample compartment
Figure 5-9 Autoloader for closed-sampling type analyzers
The two types of autoloaders can either be used with the tube rotatory scanning mechanism (with the built-in barcode scanner) and the tube detection assembly. Therefore there are in total 5-6
Mechanical System
4 configurations:
For open-vial sampling type analyzer
It not only detects the presence of test tubes, but also scans tube and tube barcodes
The sample number can be either a barcode number or an auto-increment number
With tube detection assembly
Only detect the presence of test tubes
The sample number can be automatically increased
With rotary scan mechanism (including internal barcode scanner)
It not only detects the presence of test tubes, but also scans tube and tube barcodes
The sample number can be either a barcode number or an auto-increment number
Only detect the presence of test tubes
The sample number can be automatically increased
With rotary scan mechanism (including internal barcode scanner) Mutually exclusive, only one can be selected
OV autoloader
Autoloader
Mutually exclusive, only one can be selected
CT autoloader
With tube detection assembly For closed-tube sampling type analyzer
Figure 5-10 Different configurations for autoloaders In order to simplify the description, if there is a need for the explanation in later sections, only pictures of two configurations will be shown: a CT autoloader with a rotary scanning mechanism and an OV autoloader with a tube detection assembly. Test tube rotary scanning assembly
Loading in-position detection switch
Back supporting board assembly Loading tray face plate
Front supporting board assembly
Unloadin g tray face plate
Tray full detection sensor
Loading mechanism
Unloading mechanism
Feeding mechanism
Closed sample compartment assembly
Figure 5-11 Closed-sampling type autoloader + Rotary scanning mechanism
5-7
Mechanical System Tube Rack Loading InPosition Detection Switch
Tube detection assembly
Back supporting board assembly
Loading tray face plate
Front supporting board assembly
Loading mechanism
Unloading tray face plate OV tube Aspirate key stopper detection switch
Tray full detection sensor
Unloading mechanism
Feeding mechanism
Figure 5-12 Open -sampling type autoloader + Tube detection assembly Facing to the autoloader, the function positions in the autoloader analysis area are arranged as follows, where the tube detection position and the barcode scan position overlap. However, only the autoloader with a rotary scanning mechanism has the tube barcode rotary scanning function.
Empty Empty
Empty
Empty
Empty
Piercing
Mix
Empty
Tube detection Barcode scanning
Figure 5-13 Layout of positions in the autoloader analysis area
5-8
Empty
Mechanical System
Figure 5-14 Installation method of autoloader and main unit The main unit supports the autoloader with two crossbeams. When the autoloader is installed on the analyzer, make sure that the positioning pin of the autoloader is inserted into the corresponding pin hole of the main unit, and that the left and right sides of the autoloader back metal contact the baseplate of the main unit (refer to Figure 5-14 and Figure 5-15 . If they do not contact the main unit baseplate, which means that the wire is inserted or the autoloader is not pushed into the correct position). Then pre-tighten the connecting screws at the bottom of the autoloader to the crossbeam.
Figure 5-15 Autoloader needs to contact with the main unit (right side)
5-9
Mechanical System
Figure 5-16 Autoloader needs to contact with main unit (left side) Before powering on the main unit, first confirm the relative position of the main unit to the autoloader. The procedure is as follows: pull the sampling assembly to the position in the upper front of the floating blood barrier, and visually inspect whether the center of the probe wipe groove is aligned with the center of the floating blood barrier limit slice (distance ≤± 0.5 mm). If it is not convenient to observe, you can press the sample probe downwards a little by hand to observe the alignment of the probe tip and the center of the blood barrier limit slice, but do not let the sample probe get into contact with any hard object. After confirming the alignment, lift the sample probe to avoid bending the sample probe when horizontally dragging the sampling assembly. If the center of the sampling assembly probe wipe groove is not aligned with the center of the floating blood barrier limit slice, or the tip of the sample probe is not aligned with the center of the blood barrier limit slice, you need to remove the right cover of the main unit, loosen the positioning pins on the main unit (refer to Figure 5-17). Then move the autoloader left or right to align the positions of the main unit and the autoloader. Make sure that there is no gap between the back of the autoloader and the main unit when moving the autoloader. After the alignment, tighten the positioning pin screw of the main unit and the connection screw between the bottom of the autoloader and the crossbeam.
5-10
Mechanical System
Probe wipe
Blood barrier limit slice
Figure 5-17 Main unit and autoloader position confirmation
Figure 5-18 Main unit and autoloader position confirmation
5-11
Mechanical System
Figure 5-19 Main unit positioning pin hole The autoloader's auto-loading mechanism includes a loading mechanism, a feeding mechanism, an unloading mechanism, a back supporting board assembly, a front supporting board assembly, etc. The closed autoloader also includes a closed sample compartment. Loading Mechanism The function of the loading mechanism is to achieve longitudinal loading of the tube rack in preparation for feeding the tube rack into the analysis area. If there is a tube rack on the loading tray, the loading mechanism will trigger the micro-switch when pushing the tube rack (does not trigger the end position sensor). If there isn't a tube rack on the loading tray, the loading mechanism will trigger the end position sensor. Loading motor
Loading end position sensor
Right pincher height adjustment bracket Loading home position Left pincher height sensor adjustment bracket
Figure 5-20 Loading mechanism The role of the pincher height adjustment bracket is to adjust the height of the pincher relative to the loading tray, and to ensure that the top of the pincher does not exceed the Figure 5-22 upper limit, the bottom of the pincher does not exceed the lower limit. 5-12
Mechanical System
Right pincher
Left pincher
Figure 5-21 Note height requirements of the pincher
Upper limit Lower limit
Figure 5-22 Loading pincher height limit for pushing tube rack Feeding mechanism The feeding mechanism sends the tube rack to be tested into the analysis area. The feed mechanism of the instrument is used to feed or retract the tube rack. When feeding, the retracting pincher is under the face plate. When retracting, the feeding pincher is under the face plate.
5-13
Mechanical System
Retracting pincher 2
Feeding pincher 1
Retracting pincher 1
Feeding pincher 2
Feeding home position sensor
Feeding motor
Figure 5-23 Feeding mechanism Unloading mechanism The function of the unloading mechanism is to push the tested tube rack into the unloading tray. There is a reflective sensor at the end of the unloading tray to detect whether the tube rack of the unloading tray is full. Unloading pushing plate
Unloading motor
Unloading home position sensor
Figure 5-24 Unloading mechanism Front supporting board assembly The front supporting board assembly and back supporting board assembly form the feeding channel for a tube rack together, which limits the front-back position of the tube rack in the analysis area. The front supporting board is equipped with a floating blood barrier, which is used to prevent the blood from splashing on the bottom of the sampling assembly probe wipe and form the blood slag when puncturing the tube (falling the blood slag into the reaction bath will change the measurement result). The left-right position, the front-back position of the front supporting board can be adjusted, and the height of the floating blood barrier bracket relative to the front supporting board can also be adjusted. Adjust the front-back position of the front supporting board in order to make the 5-14
Mechanical System
feeding channel width suitable for passing through the tube rack, the purpose of adjusting the left-right position is to align the theoretical center of the floating blood barrier with the theoretical center of the tube rack. Adjust the height of the floating blood barrier to allow the tube to pass safely. Floating blood barrier Blood barrier limit bracket
Floating blood barrier bracket
Test tube limit slice
Front supporting board
Figure 5-25 Front supporting board assembly If the front supporting board is disassembled while repairing the autoloader, you need to readjust the front-back position and the left-right position of the front supporting board with the fixture shown below. Floating blood barrier height adjustment positioning surface
Floating blood barrier left-right position adjustment positioning surface
Feeding channel width adjustment positioning surface
Tube detection assembly left-right position adjustment positioning surface Rotary scanning mechanism rotating wheel assembly leftright position adjustment positioning surface
Left counter pinch roller groove
Right counter pinch roller groove
Figure 5-26 Autoloader feeding channel adjustment fixture
5-15
Mechanical System
Push th e fixtu re to th e ri ght from on e side of the unlo ading tray into th e feeding chann el
The left and right cou nte r pinch rolle rs ar e p ressed at the lowest position of the fixtu re groove
The bottom su rfa ce of the floating blood bar rier bracket is close to the positioning surface o f th e fixture, lock the flo atin g bloo d b arrier rack screw ① and ②
Move the front suppo rtin g boa rd l eft or r ight to make the left sid e o f the floating bloo d b arrier rack closely contact with th e fixtu re positioning surface (but do not mo ve the fixtu re)
Push th e fron t su pporting boa rd to th e d irection of the back supp orti ng b oard to make the fron t supporting boa rd closely contact with the fixtu re
Lock the fr ont suppo rtin g boa rd l ocking scr ew ③ and ④
Confirm with the test tub e r ack. When drag the te st tube ra ck through the fe eding channe l, there should be no obvious friction. If obvious friction is detecte d, adju st a gain
End
Figure 5-27 Front supporting board assembly adjustment step and method with fixture Before starting the adjustment, make sure that the left and right counter pinch rollers are pressed on the bottom of the groove
Push the fix ture into the feed ing channel from left to right
Figure 5-28 Fixture placement requirements
5-16
Mechanical System
The bottom surface of the floating blood barrier assembly is close to the positioning surface of the fixture, and then tighten the screw ① and ②
①
②
④ ③
The left side of the floating blood barrier assembly is close to the fixture positioning surface, and push the front supporting board in the direction of the red arrow to make it close to the fixture, then tighten the screw ③ and ④
Figure 5-29 Front -back, left-right position adjustment for front supporting board assembly You can take the tube rack as a temporary fixture and adjust the front supporting board assembly as follows if the adjustment fixture is not available: Draw a vertical line in the center of the U-shaped groove which is in the middle of the front supporting board
Draw a tick mark in the center of the tube position 6's top surface on the test tube rack
Push the test tube position 6 to the auto-sampling position
The left and right counter pinch rollers are pressed at the lowest position of the test tube rack groove
Move the front supporting board assembly left or right to align the vertical line drawn on the front supporting board with the scale drawn on the test tube rack
Ensure that the front and back supporting boards are roughly parallel and the spacing between them is slightly wider than the test tube rack
Lock the front supporting board locking screw ③ and ④
Confirm with the test tube rack. When drag the test tube rack through the feeding channel, there should be no obvious friction. If obvious friction is detected, adjust again
Adjust the floating blood barrier bracket height to make the blood barrier and the sample probe wipe be separated by 2 to 3 mm, and lock the floating blood barrier bracket screw ① and ②
Put a test tube (length ≤ 85 mm) on the test tube rack to make the bottom of the blood barrier 1 mm higher than the top surface of the test tube, otherwise readjust the blood barrier rack height
End
Figure 5-30 Front supporting board assembly adjustment steps and methods without fixtures
5-17
Mechanical System
Figure 5-31 Left-right position adjustment method for front supporting board assembly
The distance between the front and back supporting boards is slightly wider than the width above the test tube rack, and there is no obvious friction when dragging the tube rack through the feeding channel.
20.4mm 20mm
Figure 5-32 Front-back position requirements for front supporting board assembly
5-18
Mechanical System
D=2~3mm
The bottom of the blood barrier is higher than the test tube
Figure 5-33 Height requirements for floating blood barrier bracket
The front-back position of the limit slice can be adjusted to ensure that the front of the limit slice abuts against the test tube rack
Figure 5-34 Installation requirements for tube rack limit slice The front-back position of the tube rack limit slice is adjusted with a tube rack. Make sure the frontal side of the limit slice is locked against the tube rack. Back supporting board assembly The back supporting board assembly and front supporting board assembly together form the feeding channel for a tube rack, which limits the front-back position of the tube rack in the 5-19
Mechanical System
analysis area. The back supporting board assembly is equipped with left and right counter devices. The left and right counter devices can not only press the tube rack (to prevent the lateral movement of the tube rack while puncturing or mixing the tubes), but also detect whether the tube rack has moved when feeding or retracting the tube rack. Back supporting board
Left counter pinch roller Left counter rotation block
Right counter pinch roller Right counter rotation block
Left counter photocoupler Right counter photocoupler
Left counter photocoupler barrier
Right counter photocoupler barrier
Figure 5-35 Back supporting board assembly
Groove Step
Figure 5-36 Test tube rack There are 10 grooves in front of the tube rack (one groove for each tube position), and there are steps between the grooves. When the tube rack enters the analysis area, the left counter pinch roller or right counter pinch roller presses in the groove of the test tube rack. When the test tube rack moves laterally, the pinch roller will go through the groove step groove process. The counter sensor will produce a change in the state of blocked non-blocked blocked and the corresponding test tube rack moves one position. In order to generate the correct sensor signal, the sensor barrier is required to completely block the sensor when the pinch roller is in the groove, and the sensor barrier is completely out of the sensor when the pinch roller is on the step. The position of the counter sensor barrier relative to the sensor is adjustable left or right. Adjust it referring to the following steps:
5-20
Mechanical System
The left and right cou nte r p inch rolle rs ar e p ressed at the lowest position of the te st tube rack gr oove
Push th e test tube position 5 to the autosampling position
Push th e test tube rack to the left to make the pinch rolle r stop on the steps
Adju st the left-righ t positi on of th e pho tocoup ler barrier to make the barr ier block the photocoupler and at least 1 mm pa ss the pho tocoup ler end face
Make sure the photocouple r ba rrier is completely ou t of the photocouple r an d the distance from the ph oto cou pler end face is abo ut 1 mm. Otherwise, repe at ste p 3 to read just th e b arrier position
End
Figure 5-37 Counter sensor barrier adjustment steps and methods
The pinch roller is pressed at the lowest position of the groove
d≥1mm
When the pinch roller stops at the lowest position of the groove, the photocoupler barrier completely blocks the photocoupler detection zone and passes at least 1 mm beyond the end face of the photocoupler detection zone.
Figure 5-38 Counter sensor barrier adjustment method
d≈1mm
The pinch roller is pressed on the step
When the pinch roller stops on the step, the photocoupler barrier completely disengages from the photocoupler detection zone and is approximately 1 mm from the end face of the photocoupler detection zone.
Figure 5-39 Counter sensor barrier position confirmation 5-21
Mechanical System
Tube detection assembly For the analyzer that is not equipped with a rotary scanning mechanism, a tube detection assembly is mounted on the autoloader back supporting board. The tube detection assembly is located at the tube detection position. The function of this assembly is to detect whether there is a tube on the tube rack passing through the tube detection position. The tube detection assembly on the back supporting board can be adjusted left or right. You can adjust the left-right position of the tube detection assembly by using the same fixture for adjusting the front supporting board assembly as shown in the figure below. Tube detection assembly is tightly pressed to this positioning surface and tightly locked The premise is that the left and right counter pinch rollers of the back supporting board assembly are pressed at the fixture groove
Figure 5-40 Adjustment method for tube detection assembly position (with fixture) If the fixture is not available, you can also use the tube rack to execute the adjustment as follows.
The premise is that the left and right counter pinch rollers of the back supporting board assembly are pressed at the lowest position of the test tube rack groove
Visual inspection: The center of the tube detection assembly and the center of the tube rack hole position are roughly coincident
Figure 5-41 Adjustment method for tube detection assembly position (without fixture)
5-22
Mechanical System
Sample compartment assembly The sample compartment assembly is used for measuring the inserted STAT samples Whole blood position Tube stopper
Micro WB position Photocoupler barrier
Micro-switch
Compartment home position photocoupler
Limit panel
Sample compartment motor
Micro-switch cable binding panel
Compartment body assembly
Rail protector
Figure 5-42 Sample compartment assembly Adapter Clamping block Compression nut
Micro-switch
Compression spring
Adapter base Adapter spring Adapter nut
Figure 5-43 Compartment body assembly There are 2 sample positions in the compartment body assembly. The whole blood position is used to measure whole blood samples and body fluid samples. The Micro-WB position is used to measure Micro-WB samples and pre-diluted samples. The sample compartment assembly is mounted on the bottom of the closed autoloader and the left-right position is adjustable relative to the bottom panel.
5-23
Mechanical System
Sample compartment assembly locking screws, when loosening the screws, sample compartment assembly can be adjusted left or right
Figure 5-44 Sample compartment assembly fixing method on the bottom panel of the closed autoloader The left-right position of the sample compartment should be adjusted with reference to the sample probe. When using the probe in the whole blood position, make sure the probe can be roughly aligned with the center of the fixing hole. The sample probe is centered around the whole blood position of the sample compartment assembly
Figure 5-45 Left-right position adjustment method for sample compartment assembly In addition, the micro-switch connection wire of the sample compartment will move when opening or closing the sample compartment. In order to prevent the wires from being worn out due to wear, the wires should be avoided touching the face plate hem during the movement.
5-24
Mechanical System The cable does not touch the panel during the movement
Figure 5-46 Wiring considerations for sample compartment micro-switch connection
5.2.2 Rotary Scanning Assembly (With Built-in Scanner) The rotatory scanning assembly supports sample barcode scanning and tube rack barcode scanning; besides, it has the tube detection function. The rotary scanning assembly includes a tube fixing mechanism, a tube rotary mechanism, and a scanner. The tube fixing mechanism and the scanner are fixed in front of the front panel of the main unit, and the tube rotary mechanism is fixed on the autoloader. Tube rotary motor
Coupling
Rotating wheel front-back adjustment panel
Rotating wheel Rubber wheel
Bracket
Figure 5-47 Test tube rotary mechanism The support rack is fixed with the autoloader and its left-right position is adjustable relative to the autoloader, while the front-back position of the rotating wheel front-back adjusting plate is adjustable relative to the support rack.
5-25
Mechanical System
Rotating wheel frontback adjustment panel locking screws, when loosening the screws, the rotating wheel can be adjusted forward and backward
Figure 5-48 Fixing method for rotating wheel front and rear adjustment panels
Remove the rubber wheel to make the frontback, left-right directions of the rotating wheel be tangent to the curved surface set by the fixture The premise is that the left and right counter pinch rollers of the back supporting board assembly are pressed at the lowest position of the fixture groove
Figure 5-49 Front-back, left-right position adjustment method for tube rotary mechanism (with fixture) When the fixture is available, the left-right, and front-back positions of the tube fixing mechanism can be adjusted directly in accordance with the above figure. If there is no fixture, use the tube rack to visually inspect and adjust the left-right position first to make the rotating wheel roughly align with the tube rack tube position. Then adjust the front-back position: make the rotating wheel slightly protrude toward the tube rack tube position, to make the tube not only pass through normally but also contact with the rotating wheel. After the adjustment, push the tube gently in the direction of the rotating wheel, and try to rotate the rotating wheel to see if it can rotate normally. If the tube is stuck or does not move, you need to readjust the position.
5-26
Mechanical System The left and right sides of the rotating wheel are roughly aligned with the test tube rack hole
The premise is that the left and right counter pinch rollers of the back supporting board assembly are pressed at the lowest position of the test tube rack groove
Figure 5-50 Front-back, left-right position adjustment method for tube rotary mechanism (without fixture) Photocoupler lead binding hole
Test tube compression motor
Photocoupler lead fixing panel
Back photocoupler barrier Compression mechanism photocoupler
Sliding support Spring Front photocoupler barrier
Guide rod
Pinch roller fixed support Pinch roller
Figure 5-51 Tube fixing mechanism The fixing mechanism sensor is fixed on the sliding support and can be moved forward or backward following the sliding support; the front sensor barrier is fixed on the pinch roller fixing support, and can be moved forward or backward following the pinch roller fixing support. The principle of the tube fixing mechanism for detecting the presence or absence of a tube is: The stepping motor drives the sliding support forward through the synchronous belt, and the sliding support pushes the pinch roller fixing support moving forward together through a spring.
If there is a tube at the tube detection position, when the pinch roller comes into contact with the tube, the forward movement of the pinch roller fixing support will be stopped. However, the sliding support keeps moving forward with the compression mechanism sensor. There will be a relative motion between the sensor and the front sensor barrier, 5-27
Mechanical System
and finally the compression mechanism sensor will be blocked by the front sensor barrier;
When there is no tube at the tube detection position, there is no obstacles restricting the pinch roller movement, the compression mechanism sensor and front sensor barrier will move forward together, so the sensor will not be blocked by the front sensor barrier.
Therefore the sensor signal blocked/unblocked status indicate whether there is a tube at the tube detection position. The front-back position of the front sensor barrier located on the pinch roller fixing support is adjustable. In order not to miss or mistakenly detect tubes, adjust the front sensor barrier position referring to the following figure.
When the spring is not compressed, the end position photocoupler barrier is flush with the frontal side of the photocoupler
Figure 5-52 Front-back position adjustment requirements for front sensor barrier The compression mechanism sensor moves with the sliding support. In order to prevent the sensor cable from being worn out, the sensor cable must be bundled on the sensor lead fixing panel and fixed under the sensor lead binding hole as shown below:
5-28
Mechanical System
Figure 5-53 Bundling requirements for compression mechanism sensor lead The tube fixing mechanism locking screws, when loosening the screws, the fixing mechanism can be adjusted left or right
Figure 5-54 Fixing method for compression mechanism on the front panel The compression mechanism can be adjusted left or right on the front panel. Insert a tube rack in the feeding area, making sure that the counter pinch roller is at the lowest position of the tube rack groove, and adjust the pinch roller of the tube fixing mechanism to be roughly centered with the tube rack hole position (use the left and right sides of this tube rack hole position for reference, deviation ≤ ± 0.5mm).
5-29
Mechanical System
Figure 5-55 Left-right position adjustment method for compression mechanism After adjusting the tube fixing mechanism and tube rotary mechanism, the adjustment effect can be confirmed on the autoloader self-test screen. Select MenuServiceDebug&Self-TestSelf-Test, select the Autoloading Assembly to enter the autoloader self-test screen.
Figure 5-56 Path for entering self-test screen Tap the button first, and then put an empty tube rack on the first row of the loading tray. Put an empty tube into the first tube position of the tube rack, and tap the button twice to send the empty tube to the scanning position. Then tap to see if the tube can rotate. 5-30
Mechanical System
Figure 5-57 Autoloader assembly self-test screen
5.2.3 Test Tube Stabilizing Mechanism The stabilizing mechanism is used to eliminate the random oscillation of the tube in the tube rack during pinching and make the tube oscillate in a fixed direction, which can prevent the sample probe from sticking on the tube cap, then the probability of bending the probe can be reduced. Wheel
Front-back adjustment bracket
Stabilizing mechanism bracket
Clamping block
Rotating bracket Spring piece
Figure 5-58 Stabilizing mechanism The stabilizing mechanism is fixed below the sampling assembly of the main unit front panel. 5-31
Mechanical System
And the stabilizing mechanism can be adjusted in right-left direction relative to the main unit front panel.
Stabilizing mechanism locking screws, when loosening the screws, the stabilizing mechanism can be adjusted left or right
Figure 5-59 Fixing the stabilizing mechanism on the front panel Select MenuServiceDebug&Self-TestSelf-Test, select the Autoloading Assembly to enter the autoloader self-test screen.
Figure 5-60 Path for entering self-test screen
5-32
Mechanical System
Figure 5-61 Autoloader assembly self-test screen Tap the button first, and then put an empty tube rack on the first row of the loading tray. Tap the button five times to send the first position of the tube rack to the piercing position. Use your hand to press the wheel of the stabilizing mechanism and observe whether the stabilizing mechanism clamping block is exactly centered with the front opening of the tube rack. If the right and left sides of the clamping block are close to the tube rack, you need to adjust the left-right position of the stabilizing mechanism.
5-33
Mechanical System
Figure 5-62 Ideal position of the stabilizing mechanism clamping block relative to the tube rack
5-34
Mechanical System
Front-back adjustment bracket locking screws, when loosening the screws, the clamping block can be adjusted forward or backward
Figure 5-63 Front and rear adjustment structure for stabilizing mechanism clamping block The front-back position adjustment requirements of the stabilizing mechanism are as follows: When the wheel is not pressed, the clamping block should be adjusted to a position about 1 mm behind the autoloader back supporting board (in order not to interfere with the tube rack feeding).
d≈1mm
Figure 5-64 Front and rear adjustment visual inspection method for stabilizing mechanism clamping block (top view)
5.2.4 Mixing Assembly The mixing assembly is used to reverse and mix samples during the auto-sampling measurement. The mixing assembly is fixed to the rear of the main unit front panel. 5-35
Mechanical System
Lift motor (Z direction motor)
Z direction end position photocoupler R direction photocoupler barrier
R direction home position photocoupler Z direction home position photocoupler
Mix motor (R direction motor)
Y direction end position photocoupler Y direction home position photocoupler
Shift motor (Y direction motor)
Y direction photocoupler barrier
Figure 5-65 Mixing assembly (rear view)
Z direction home position photocoupler
Tube gripper Gripper pressing panel
Figure 5-66 Mixing assembly (front view)
5-36
Mechanical System
Mix assembly locking screws, when loosening the screws, mix assembly can be adjusted left or right
Figure 5-67 Fixing mixing assembly to the front panel of the main unit After disassembling the mixing mechanism, it is necessary to re-adjust the front-back position, left-right position, and height of the tube gripper relative to the tube rack so as to ensure the reliability of the gripper for removing the tube. In order to prevent interference during the adjustment process, it is necessary to loosen the screws on the power-off protection board of the mixing assembly first, then push the protection board to the right, and lock one screw (to prevent the protection board from moving). Mix assembly power-off protection board, loosen the 3 screws of the poweroff protection board before adjusting the mix assembly. Push the power-off protection board to the right and tighten 1 screw.
Figure 5-68 Mixing assembly power-off protection board
5-37
Mechanical System
Enter the autoloader self-test screen (refer to Figure 5-69 and Figure 5-70), tap the button, and then put an empty tube rack on the first row of the loading tray. Tap the button five times to send the first position of the tube rack to the piercing position. Select Menu Service Debug & Self-Test Adjust Autoload Pos., then select Mix mechanism, tap , and then tap .
Figure 5-69 Path for entering Adjust Autoload Pos. Adjust the left-right position of the mixing assembly on the front panel of the main unit, and tap the , , , and buttons on the Figure 5-70 screen to move the gripper until it is roughly aligned with the tube in front-back and left-right directions. After the adjustment, tighten the four locking screws of the mixing assembly (the gripper position may shift in the process of tightening the screws, which may require multiple adjustments), tap , and then tap . Place a tube into the mix position, and tap the button. When the tube is placed back into the tube rack, observe if the tube obviously interferes with the tube rack. If yes, you need to readjust the mixing assembly.
5-38
Mechanical System
④
⑤
⑥
Figure 5-70 Mixing mechanism adjustment screen
Figure 5-71 Left-right, front-back position confirmation for mixing mechanism If you have exceeded the adjustment range when tapping the , , , and button but still failed to adjust the mixing mechanism to a proper position, loosen the 2 inner hexagon locking screws of the tube gripper (as shown in the following figure), and adjust the front-back position and angle of the gripper on the shaft. If it is hard to manage these 2 screws, you can tap to raise the gripper and operate. After adjusting the front-back position and angles of the gripper relative to the shaft, 5-39
Mechanical System
tighten the screws (be sure to lock them tightly), tap to return the gripper back to the original position, and then readjust the left-right, front-back positions of the mixing gripper.
Tube gripper locking screw
Figure 5-72 Tube gripper locking screws After adjusting the front-back, left-right positions of the tube gripper, adjust the height of the tube gripper. The distance between the gripper bottom surface and the tube rack top surface needs to be controlled within (1.5-2.5) mm, and the bottom surface of the gripper pressing panel is slightly lower than the bottom surface of the blood barrier.
The bottom of the gripper pressing panel is slightly lower than the bottom surface of the blood barrier d=(1.5~2.5)mm
Figure 5-73 Tube gripper height adjustment method After adjusting the tube gripper height relative to the tube rack, adjust the distance between the power-off protection board and gripper. Tap in Figure 5-70, adjust the distance between the power-off protection board and gripper to the range of (1.5 to 2.5) mm. After the adjustment, tap to restore the gripper position.
5-40
Mechanical System
(1.5~2.5)mm
Figure 5-74 Distance requirements between tube gripper and power-off protection board After adjusting the above positions, put a tube into the mix position, and tap the button to confirm the adjustment effect.
5.2.5 Sampling assembly The sampling assembly is used to aspirate and dispense the sample. Hose fixing bracket
Vertical (Z direction) motor
Horizontal confirm position photocoupler Vertical home position photocoupler Horizontal (Y direction) motor
Probe wipe
Sample probe
Shielding cover
Horizontal home position photocoupler barrier Horizontal home position photocoupler
Figure 5-75 Sampling assembly
5-41
Mechanical System
Piercing slide
When replacing the sample probe, pay attention to the mounting direction of the sample probe
Nut
Lead screw
Figure 5-76 Sampling assembly Table 5-1 Sample probe aspirating and dispensing positions Open-sampling type
Closed-sampling type
Aspiration
Auto-sampling position, open-
Auto-sampling position, CT-WB sampling
positions
vial sampling position
position, CT-micro-WB sampling position
Dispensing positions
HGB bath, WNB bath, DIFF bath, RET bath (high configuration type), RBC bath
Table 5-2 Situations that need to re-confirm or re-adjust sample probe position Situations for reconfirming or
Position
readjusting sample probe position (1) When having reassembled or replaced
Vertical direction home pos.
the vertical home position sensor
Vertical
(2) When having replaced the sampling assembly
Open-vial sampling position
/
Not required Only for closed-sampling type: (1) When having reassembled or replaced
CT sampling position
Front-back, left-
the sampling assembly
(common tube)
right, vertical
(2) When having replaced the autoloader (3) When having reassembled or replaced the sample compartment assembly Only for closed-sampling type:
CT sampling position
Front-back, left-
(1) When having reassembled or replaced
(micro tube)
right, vertical
the sampling assembly (2) When having replaced the autoloader 5-42
Mechanical System
(3) When having reassembled or replaced the sample compartment assembly (1) When having reassembled or replaced Auto-sampling
Front-back, left-
position
right, vertical
the sampling assembly (2) When having replaced the autoloader, or reassemble the autoloader's front or back supporting board assembly (1) When having reassembled or replaced
HGB bath pos.
Front-back,
the sampling assembly
vertical
(2) When having reassembled or replaced the HGB bath (1) When having reassembled or replaced
WNB bath pos.
Front-back,
the sampling assembly
vertical
(2) When having reassembled or replaced the WNB\DIFF bath (1) When having reassembled or replaced
DIFF bath pos.
Front-back,
the sampling assembly
vertical
(2) When having reassembled or replaced the WNB\DIFF bath (1) When having reassembled or replaced
RET bath pos.
Front-back,
the sampling assembly
vertical
(2) When having reassembled or replaced the RET bath (1) When having reassembled or replaced the sampling assembly
RBC bath pos.
Front-back, vertical
(2) When having replaced the horizontal home position sensor of the sampling assembly (3) When having reassembled or replaced the RBC bath
Note: check and confirm first, adjust the sample probe position if needed The positions of various reaction baths in the main unit are shown in the figure below:
5-43
Mechanical System
HGB bath DIFF bath WNB bath
RBC bath
RET bath
Figure 5-77 Positions of various reaction baths in the main unit Select Menu Service Debug & Self-Test Adj. Sample Probe Pos. to enter the Adj. Sample Probe Pos. screen:
③
②
①
Figure 5-78 Path for entering the Adj. Sample Probe Pos. screen
5-44
Mechanical System
Check the saved steps of last adjustment
The tip moves to the last adjusted position for observation and debugging
The tip moves to the last adjusted position, start adjusting from the last adjusted position
The tip moves about 2 mm above the fixture, start adjusting from the default position
Restore factory configured position
Real work position
Figure 5-79 Adj. Sample Probe Pos. screen The probe wipe height-determining fixture is used to adjust the vertical direction home position, one end of the probe wipe height-determining fixture is 0.4mm longer than the other end. When adjusting the vertical direction home position, insert the probe wipe height-determining fixture into the probe wipe from the bottom, and adjust the sample probe position using the and buttons to make the longer end of the fixture touch the probe tip, while the shorter one can not touch.
Figure 5-80 Probe wipe height-determining fixture
5-45
Mechanical System
Figure 5-81 Operation method of probe wipe height-determining fixture When adjusting the sample probe position in the HGB bath, WNB bath, DIFF bath, RET bath, and RBC bath, you will use a fixture similar to the following figure: The front and rear direction of the sample probe should be within this area
The tip of the sample probe is flush with the surface
Step facade
Figure 5-82 Fixture for adjusting the sample probe position in the reaction bath Put the fixture into the round hole of the reaction bath to make the step facade face toward the right side of the main unit (be sure that the fixture should be flat and not to be topped by insulation wool or something else). Adjust the front-back, up-down position of the sample probe to make the probe align with the center of the round hole, and the probe tip is aligned with the lower step surface of the fixture.
5-46
Mechanical System
Figure 5-83 Adjusting the sample probe position in the reaction bath with fixture The adjusting fixture for the auto-sampling position is shown in the figure below. Remember to remove the floating blood barrier before adjusting. Otherwise, the fixture's cross-shape slot will not be found. The fixture is inserted into the analysis area from one side of the unloading tray towards the right, and the fixture should be tightly attached to the floating blood barrier bracket.
This facade closely contacts with the floating blood barrier bracket
The sample probe is flush with the center of the cross-shape slot The tip of the sample probe is flush with this surface
Figure 5-84 Fixture for adjusting the sample probe position at the auto-sampling position 5-47
Mechanical System
(2) Lower the blood barrier limit bracket
(3) Take out the blood barrier from the gap
(1) Insert a cross-head screwdriver into the hole to loosen this screw
When restoring, remember to raise the blood barrier limit bracket to the same height as the top surface of the blood barrier
Figure 5-85 Removal method of the floating blood barrier
Figure 5-86 Fixture operation method for adjusting the sample probe position at the auto-sampling position The fixtures for adjusting the CT-WB and CT-micro-WB positions are shown below. When placing the CT-micro-WB fixture, it is necessary to first remove the adapter at the CT-micro-WB position of the sample compartment assembly. When adjusting, align the sample probe with the center hole located on the fixture and align the probe tip with the upper surface of the fixture.
5-48
Mechanical System Adjusting fixture for the sample probe at the CT-WB position
Adjusting fixture for the sample probe at the CT-micro-WB position
Figure 5-87 Fixture for adjusting the sample probe position in the closed sample compartment One step of the sampling assembly horizontal motor equals 0.1626 mm, and one step of the vertical motor equals 0.04 mm. The following methods can be used for debugging if the fixture is not available: (1) Vertical direction home position Adjust the sample probe downward first until the probe tip is flush with the bottom of the probe wipe (you can feel it with your hand), and then move it upward 180 steps (7.2 mm) from this position. (2) WNB/DIFF/RET bath Tap the and buttons to align the sample probe with the center of the bath (visual inspection) first, then lower the sample probe until it is flush with the bath inlet (you can put a thin piece of paper on the bath inlet then adjust the tip until it touches the paper), and then move the sample probe upward 100 steps (4 mm) from this position. (3) HGB/RBC bath Disassemble the shield box of the HGB/RBC bath, and then adjust them using the same method with the WNB/DIFF/RET bath. (4) Auto-sampling position Before adjusting the auto-sampling position, it is recommended to remove the floating blood barrier in order to prevent the sample probe from pricking the floating blood barrier. Put a tube rack in the analysis area (note that the pinch roller is pressed in the groove of the tube rack), tap the and buttons to align the sample probe with the center of the tube rack tube position (visual inspection) , and then lower the sample probe to be flush with the top surface of the tube rack (you can put a thin piece of paper on the top of the tube rack then adjust the probe tip until it touches the paper), finally move the sample probe upward 975 steps (39 mm) from this position. (5) CT-WB sampling position Tap the and buttons to align the sample probe with the center of the CT-WB position (visual inspection), then lower the sample probe to be flush with the top of the sample compartment (you can put a thin piece of paper on the top of the sample compartment 5-49
Mechanical System
then adjust the probe tip until it touches the paper), and then move the sample probe upward 305 steps (12.2 mm) from this position. (6) CT-micro-WB position After adjusting the CT-WB sampling position, the U-D of the CT-micro-WB position can be adjusted to the same level as the CT-WB sampling position, and the F-B of the CT-micro-WB position are 123 steps more than that of the CT-WB sampling position.
5.2.6 Syringe Assembly Syringe motor
Syringe Home position photocoupler
Photocoupler barrier
Figure 5-88 Structure of ASP syringe (100uL) and SP syringe (250uL) ASP syringe assembly and SP syringe assembly have different motor models and syringe capacities, do not mix them together.
5-50
Mechanical System
Syringe motor
Syringe
Coupling
Home position photocoupler Lead screw
Figure 5-89 DIL Syringe (10mL) structure
5.2.7 Temperature Control Module The temperature control subsystem in the analyzer is used to heat the reagents such as diluents, lyses, and the assemblies such as reaction incubation baths, providing a suitable reaction environment for the analyzer reaction system.
5-51
Mechanical System
Figure 5-90 Exploded view of preheating bath structure
Figure 5-91 Explosive view of reaction bath assembly structure
5-52
Mechanical System
When the internal components of the preheating bath assembly and the reaction bath assembly are faulty, the entire assembly needs to be replaced in maintenance. The measurement assembly should be replaced using the modular design solution.
Tools
NO.107 cross-head screwdriver
Procedures
1
Make sure that the analyzer is powered off normally, and then pull out the power cord;
2
Fluidics exhaust;
3
Remove the components that need to be replaced;
4
screws need to be disassembled when replacing the preheating bath (refer to the left figure below); 8 screws need to be disassembled when replacing a set of reaction bath components (refer to the right figure below);
5-53
Chapter 6 Optical System 6.1 Fundamentals of Optical System The optical system uses a laser beam to irradiate reagent-treated blood cells through the flow cell, collecting forward scattered light, side scattered light, and lateral fluorescence from each blood cell. The forward scattered light reflects the volume information of the cell, the side scattered light reflects the internal nuclear and particle information of the cell, and the lateral fluorescence reflects the internal nucleic acid information of the cell. Through analyzing and processing the above three optical signals, the blood cells for the blood sample can be analyzed. The top view of the optical path of the analyzer's optical system is shown in the figure below: SFL Signal Output Laser drive board
FSC
Power
Fluorescent pre-amplification board
19
SSC
APD
Signal
Signal
18 1
17
Power
Fluorescent light collection assembly
20
Optical signal board
Side scattered light collection assembly Signal
3
Power
4
5
6
PD
Signal
14 13
Side scattered light collection system
Waste
15
16
PD 8 11
2
Beam control system
Flow cell
9
10 Forward scattered light collection assembly
7
Sheath fluid
12
Sample flow
Power Power supply system
Figure 6-1 Top view of optical path 1. Laser drive board
11. Forward light-suppressing diaphragm
2. Laser
12. Forward PD
3. Laser collimating lens
13. Lateral collection lens
4. Optical isolator
14 Dichroic mirror
5. Cylindrical len A
15. Lateral aperture diaphragm
6. Cylindrical len B
16. Lateral PD
7. Flow cell
17. Fluorescent aperture diaphragm
8. Radiation-proof diaphragm
18. Filter
9. Plano-convex lens
19 Fluorescent preamplification board
10. Lenticular lens
20. 6-1
Optical signal board
Optical System
The analyzer's optical system uses semiconductor laser (2) as the source of light. The laser drive board (1) provides power supply for the laser, which emits a red laser beam of 635nm. The laser beam passes through the collimating lens (3) and gets collimated, and passes the optical isolator (4), then it is adjusted by cylindrical lens A (5) and B (6) which are placed orthogonally, to form a flat elliptic laser beam going through the sample flow in the center of the flow cell (7).
Figure 6-2 Laser spot through the flow cell Blood cells treated with lyse and fluorescent reagents are wrapped by a sheath fluid that forms a hydrodynamic focusing phenomenon at the flow cell, which in turn passes through the flow cell as shown in Figure 6-2. The flat elliptic laser beam irradiates light on each blood cell passing through the flow cell, excites scattered light and fluorescence, and direct light that has not been scattered by the cell is blocked by the radiation-proof diaphragm (8). The 1~10° forward scattered light passes through the radiation-proof diaphragm, and is collected via a Plano-convex lens (9) and a lenticular lens (10), and then passes through a forward light-suppressing diaphragm (11). It converges on the forward PD (12) to form a forward scattered signal. Both side scattered light and side excited fluorescence are collected by the lateral collection lens (13); and then separated by a dichroic len (14): the side scattered light with a stable wavelength is reflected by the len; and the side excited fluorescence, with its wavelength becoming longer, passes through the len. Side scattered light converges on the lateral PD (16) via a light-suppressing diaphragm (15) to form a side scattered signal; side excited fluorescence passes through the fluorescent light-suppressing diaphragm (15) and the long-pass filter (18) to further filter the side scattered light and converges on the Si-PMT on the fluorescent preamplification board (19) to form a fluorescent signal. The three channels of optical signals are further amplified and processed by the optical signal board (20), and then are uploaded to the analyzer signal processing system to form a scattergram.
6-2
Optical System
6.2 Composition of the Optical System Remove the upper cover of the analyzer's optical system insulation box. The assemblies are shown in the figure below.
Figure 6-3 Optical system assemblies 1. Optical lateral cover assembly
8. Lateral PD assembly
2. Front optical assembly
9.Fluorescent
preamplification
board
assembly 3. Flow cell assembly
10. Optical signal board
4. Rear collection assembly
11. NTC nut
5. Forward PD assembly
12. Optical base plate assembly
6. Lateral collection assembly
13. Optical upper cover assembly
7. Dichroic len assembly The front optical module (2) has a semiconductor laser (635 nm), a collimator lens, optical isolator, cylindrical len A, and cylindrical len B. The laser drive board on the optical lateral cover assembly (1) provides a stable current input to the front optical assembly, and the front optical assembly is responsible for irradiating the shaped laser beam to the flow cell detection area. The flow cell assembly (3) includes a flow cell and a rectifying assembly, and creates a fluid state in the flow cell where the stable sheath fluid wraps the sample flow. The reagent-treated cells in the laser irradiation flow cell excite scattered light and fluorescence. The rear collection assembly (4) includes a radiation-proof diaphragm, a Plano-convex lens, and a lenticular lens. The 1~10° forward scattered light emitted by the cells converges on the PD photosensitive surface of the forward PD module (5). The lateral collection assembly (6) has a lateral collection lens near the flow cell, and the lens can be slightly adjusted in three dimensions to ensure the collection and convergence of side scattered light and fluorescence, which are then respectively 6-3
Optical System
reflected and transmitted by the dichroic mirror assembly (7). The side scattered light converges to the photosensitive surface of the lateral PD assembly (8). The fluorescent signals transmitted through the dichroic mirror converge at the diaphragm of the fluorescent aperture in the fluorescent preamplification board assembly (9) and reach the photosensitive surface of SiPMT after passing the filter. The above three channels of signals are transmitted to the optical signal board (10) at the same time, so as to further amplify and process the blood cell scattering signal, and then the signal is uploaded to the analyzer signal processing system, and finally a scattergram is formed. The optical assembly are all mounted on the base plate assembly (12), and a heating membrane is installed under the base plate assembly to perform overall temperature control of the optical system. The entire optical system is provided with an insulation box to shield outside light, heat, vibration, electromagnetic field and dust.
6-4
Optical System
6.3 Troubleshooting Optical Faults 6.3.1 Scattergram Abnormal
Tools
NO.107 cross-head screwdriver
Consumables
4k-07 standard particle (7um), calibrator, 1.5mL centrifuge tube, microfiber dust cloth, anhydrous alcohol
Note
Many factors may cause abnormal scattergrams. Follow below steps to locate the problem. 1.
First, check whether the analyzer reports error. If so, remove the error. When the analyzer does not report any error, but the scattergrams are abnormal: first check whether all the 3 scattergrams (DIFF, RET and WNB) are abnormal. If only one of Themis abnormal, most probably the problem is not within the optical system. Check for the fluidic system, reagents system or temperature control system instead. (There are rare cases that when not all 3 scattergrams (DIFF, RET and WNB) are abnormal, and the fluidic system, reagent system, and temperature control system are OK too. Go to the next step to perform optical system investigation.)
2.
If all the 3 scattergrams are abnormal, it is most likely that the optical system is abnormal. Log in to the main unit with the service level account and click "Menu → Service → Debug & Self-Test→ Optical Debug” to enter the optical debug screen.
3.
Gently mix the 4k-07 standard particle vials, and add 4 drops of 4k-07 standard particles to 1 mL of deionized water, so as to prepare a standard particle sample.
4.
Place the standard particle sample under the sample probe and press the Aspirate key to run the standard particle sample. After the count is completed, the scattergrams of the standard particle sample will be automatically displayed. Note that the total of particles should be greater than 1000; if not, dispense more standard particles into the centrifuge tubes and run it again.
5.
The WNB and DIFF channels’ CV and optical background voltage values of Table 6-1 the 4k-07 standard particles counting results FS and SS should be within the range shown in , and the WNB and DIFF channels’ Gravity Center Pos. of FS and SS should also be within their ranges. Table 6-1 4k-07 standard particle CV range Items
Acceptance Criteria WNB
FS DIFF
Center of gravity
480.00~615.00
CV
≤2.5%
Center of gravity
480.00~615.00
CV
≤3.2% 6-5
Optical System
WNB SS DIFF
Center of gravity
998.0~1350.0
CV
≤19.0%
Center of gravity
998.0~1350.0
CV
≤19.0%
Forward optical background voltage
≤100mv
Total number of particles
1000~6000
6.
If the CV, blank count and the center of gravity all meet the requirements as in Table 6-1, but the blood sample scattergrams are still abnormal, then the optical system is OK. Check the fluidic system, reagent system, or temperature control system.
7.
If the CV and the blank count meet the requirements as in Table 6-1 but the center of gravity does not, perform the optical gain calibration in accordance with the instruction in the “Optical Gain Calibration” section.
8.
When either CV or the blank count does not meet the requirements in Table 6-1, the problem may be caused by a dirty flow cell.
9.
Click "Menu → Service → Maintenance" to enter the maintenance screen, click "Flow cell" button in the "Probe Cleanser Maint." area, and then follow the software instruction to perform probe cleanser maintenance to the flow cell (the purpose is to eliminate impurities on the internal wall of the flow cell, which always cause high blank count).
10. After that, click "Menu → Service → Cleaning" to enter the cleaning screen, click the "Flow Cell Flush" button to perform flow cell flushing, and then do 4k-07 standard particles test to confirm whether the scattergrams are improved. If the scattergram quality is not improved or still not good enough, repeat steps 9) to 10). If still not improved, do as follows (below procedure mainly intends to eliminate impurities attached to the exterior wall of flow cell. If the exterior wall is dirty, you can often see bright glitter on the surface of the flow cell). 11. Use a cross-head screwdriver to remove the top and right panels of the main unit, and the top cover of the optical system insulation box. 12. Wipe the surface of the flow cell with a clean, lint-free cloth and absolute alcohol. Check whether there is reagent leakage in the tube to the flow cell during wiping. If the tube is damaged and the reagent leaks to contaminate the surface of the flow cell, replace the tube. After that, restore the upper cover of the insulation box, and do 4k-07 standard particles and fresh blood test to confirm the effect. 13. If it does not work, replace the optical system. Note Laser radiation. ESD protection. Do not perform any counting operation when the top cover of the insulation box is not properly secured, otherwise the PMT is easily damaged.
6-6
Optical System
6.3.2 Laser Diode Current Abnormal
Equipment
Multimeter
Tools
NO.107 cross-head screwdriver
Note
1.
Click Service - Debug & Self-Test - Laser Diode Debug to enter the laser diode debug screen.
2.
Check the “Optical system temperature” on the software screen. If the temperature is within the range, tap “Test” to start laser diode debugging. (When the temperature is out of range, address the “Optical system temperature abnormal” error.)
3.
After debugging, check the laser diode current again:
When the current is within the range, tap “Save”, and end the debugging.
When the current is higher than 0mA, but is not within the range, replace the optical system;
When the current is at 0 mA, follow below instruction to check the wire connected to the laser diode:
(1) Power off the analyzer, disconnect the power cord. (2) Wear a pair of clean disposable rubber gloves to protect yourself from electrostatic damage; 6-7
Optical System
(3) Use a cross-head screwdriver to remove the top and right panels of the main unit, and the top cover of the optical system insulation box. (4) Check whether the laser diode wire connector is loose. If the laser cable is disconnected, replace the wire and install the top cover of the insulation box on the optical system. (5) Restart the analyzer to check if there is an error. If the laser diode current is still abnormal, replace the optical system. Note Laser radiation. ESD protection. Do not perform any counting operation when the top cover of the insulation box is not properly secured, otherwise the PMT is easily damaged.
6.3.3 When the Optical Gain Cannot be Calibrated If you have performed the optical gain calibration for several times, and the optical gain is still not in range, then the optical gain cannot be calibrated.
Tools
NO.107 cross-head screwdriver
Note
1. Make sure that the laser diode current is within the normal range; if it is abnormal, start the laser diode current troubleshooting according to section 6.3.2 ; if it is normal, perform the next step. 2. Make sure that the analyzer is shut down and powered off, and the plug is pulled out. 3. Wear a pair of clean disposable rubber gloves to protect yourself from electrostatic damage; 4. Use a cross-head screwdriver to remove the top and right panels of the main unit, and the top cover of the optical system insulation box. 5. Replace the front optical signal board and check the wires to make sure they are in place. 6. Perform a cleaning sequence after power-on, and perform optical gain calibration again. If the calibration is still not possible, replace the optical system. Note Laser radiation. ESD protection. Do not perform any counting operation when the top cover of the insulation box is not properly secured, otherwise the PMT is easily damaged. Make sure that all the cables connected to the pre-amplification board are OK.
6-8
Optical System
6.3.4 Maintenance and Replacement of Optical System Optical system maintenance
Probe cleanser maintenance
Flow cell flushing
Analyzer cleaning
Flow cell exterior wall cleaning
Optical system FRU
Main replaceable components of the optical system include the laser control board and its connecting cables, the optical signal board and its connecting cable.
Before the replacement, you need to shut down the analyzer and do ESD protection.
After replacing the corresponding assembly, turn on the analyzer, perform a cleaning sequence, and then enter the Optical Debug screen. Perform steps (2) to (5) in section 6.3.1 to further confirm that the analyzer meets the requirements in Table 6-1.
Optical system replacement procedure and precautions 1
Pull out the cables, optical system cable, flow cell connecting tube, and waste box connecting tube at the top of the analyzer that will affect the opening of board-fixing sheet metal;
2
As shown in Figure 6-4: Fix a new set of optical system to the main unit with the 6-M3x12 cross-recessed pan head screws (torque requirement is 4-6kfgcm); connect the base plate heating wire, optical base plate overheat protection switch wire to the back optical system; connect the optical temperature sensor connection wire; insert the optical system signal wire into the main control board J2, insert the optical system control wire into the main control board J4, insert the optical system power supply wire into the analog board J7, insert the laser control board connection wire into the main control board J3 and analog board J1 socket; reconnect the wire that has been previously pulled out due to affecting the opening of the fixing plate; fix the main control board assembly to the top cover of the main unit with the 2-M4x8 cross-recessed pan head combination screw (diagonal position, torque requirement is 6-8kfgcm).
6-9
Optical System
Figure 6-4 Assembly procedure for replacing optical system
光学系统控制线 连接于母板J6
Optical base plate overheat protection switch cable connects to socket J4 on the motherboard
Optical system temperature sensor
Optical system control cable connected to J6 on motherboard
Optical system signal cable connected to J7 on motherboard
Figure 6-5 Amplification diagram of connecting optical system wires 6-10
Optical System
3
Connect the flow cell and waste box tubing as shown below;
Figure 6-6 Flow cell and waste container tubing
Note Laser radiation. ESD protection. Do not perform any counting operation when the top cover of the insulation box is not properly secured, otherwise the PMT is easily damaged. Make sure that the optical system cable and flow cell tubing are connected correctly and securely. 4
After installing the optical system, start the analyzer, and tap “Service”-“Debug&Self-test”“Laser Diode Debug” to enter the “Laser Diode Debug” screen.
5
Check for the optical system temperature. When its value is within the range, tap “Test” to start laser diode debug. (When the temperature is out of range, address the “Optical system temperature abnormal” error.)
6
When the test completes, check whether the laser diode drive current falls into the allowed range. 6-11
Optical System
If it is within the range, tap “Save” and end the debugging.
If it is out of the range, follow the instruction in 6.3.2 Laser Diode Current Abnormal to troubleshoot the problem. If it is within the range, tap “Save” and end the debugging.
6.3.5 Replacing Optical Assembly after Analyzer Upgrading with the New Optical Assembly and New Optical Signal Board (After EIV013) All the analyzer produced after EIV013 uses the high-end optical assembly (new optical assembly). Table 6-2 Notes on the new and old optical assemblies PN
Matching
optical
Notes
signal board New
optical
115-062790-00
assembly Old
optical
115-044092-00
assembly
New optical signal
Use the new optical
board (051-002779-
signal
02), blue
with the new optical
Old
optical
signal
board
only
assembly, and the
board ( 051-002779-
old
00), green
board only with the
optical
old
signal optical
assembly. When you need to replace the problem optical assembly with a new optical assembly, follow below instruction: 1. Check the analyzer main unit software version. If the software version is below that of EIV013, update the software to the newest version. When you cannot remember the exact software version of EIV013, you can check the information using the following method: Tap Menu-“Service”-“Advanced Toolbox”-“System Configuration”, and check the “Other Configuration” area. If you can see the “With new optical assembly” option, the analyzer is at least with the EIV013 configuration.
6-12
Optical System
2. Make sure “With new optical assembly” is selected on the “Service”-“Advanced Toolbox”-“System Configuration” screen. 3. Repalce the optical assembly.
Special Situation
When under certain special circumstances, you need to replace the optical assembly with an old optical assembly (“before EIV013” version), follow below instruction. 1. Check the analyzer main unit software version. (See the instruction in Step 1 of above section) 2. Replace the optical assembly.
If the software version is before the EIV013 version, you can replace the optical assembly directly; or you can first upgrade the software to the newest version, but make sure the “With new optical assembly” option on the “Service”-“Advanced Toolbox”-“System Configuration” screen is not selected.
If the software version is the EIV013 version or after the EIV013 version, tap Menu“Service”-“Advanced Toolbox”-“System Configuration”, and make sure the “With new optical assembly” option is not selected.
Replacing the new optical signal board
Use the new optical signal board only with the new optical assembly, and the old optical signal board only with the old optical assembly (see .Table 6-2).
6-13
Chapter 7 Fluidics System 7.1 Fluidics System Overview The analyzer uses multi-section sample distribution method. The sample is dispensed into each channel in sequence after being aspirated into the probe. The procedure is shown as follows:
Figure 7-1 Sample probe dispensing sample procedure The sample will be incubated and measured in each channel individually after being dispensed. The HGB channel measures samples using the colorimetric method, the WNB, DIFF, and RET channels measure samples using the optical scattering sheath flow method, and the RBC channel uses the impedance method. The measurement principle is shown below:
7-1
Fluidics System
20uL 20uL 20uL
Flow cell LR lyse
LD Lyse LB Lyse
LD lyse
LB lyse
DR diluent
1mL
1mL
1mL
DIFF reaction bath 1:54
20uL
Sheath fluid heating bath
WNB reaction bath 1:69
15uL
RET reaction bath 1:266
4uL
Dispense blood segments
FCM bath
250uL syringe LH lyse
Diluent
Diluent
0.52mL
1.5mL
25uL
Dispense blood segments 6uL
HGB reaction bath 1:339
RBC count bath 1:20000
2mL
Figure 7-2 Measurement principles for various channels
7-2
Fluidics System
7.2 Measurement Flow Whole Blood
Test channel
RBC/PLT
HGB
Measurement Channel
RBC/PLT Channel
HGB
Test method
RBC/PLT Channel
HGB
Flag Message
PLT histogram
PLT
Parameters
WBC/RET
4DIFF Channel
MPV
RBC
4DIFF Scattergram
HGB
Lymph%
Mono%
Neut%
Eosi%
WNB Scattergram
RET Scattergram
Lymph#
Mono#
Neut#
Eosi#
NRBC% BASO%
WBC#
RET% RET# PLT-O
MCV RDW-SD
PDW
MCH RDW-CV
P-LCR
Reagents
RET Channel
WBC/RET
RBC histogram
HCT
WNB Channel
NRBC# BASO#
MCHC
M-60 Diluent
LD Lyse
LN Lyse
DR Diluent
LD fluorescent reagent
LN fluorescent reagent
DR fluorescent reagent
LH Lyse
Figure 7-3 Measurement Flow 7-3
LFR MFR HFR IRF
Fluidics System
7.3 Sample Dilution Flow Chart 7.3.1 Whole blood mode RET 4uL RET bath 1:266
DR 1040uL + FR 20uL
WNB 15uL WNB bath 1:69
LN 1000uL + FN 20uL Whole blood sample DIFF 20uL
DIFF bath 1:54
LD 1040uL + FD 20uL
LH 520uL
HGB 6uL
HGB (before lysing) 1:251
DIL 1500uL
Second aspiration 25uL
RBC 1:20000
DIL 1975uL
Figure 7-4 Whole blood sample dilution flow chart
7-4
HGB 1:339
Fluidics System
7.3.2 Prediluted mode RET 8uL RET bath 1:801
DR 1040uL + FR 20uL
WNB 25uL
Manually diluted sample 1:6
WNB bath 1:251
LN 1000uL + FN 20uL
DIFF 30uL DIFF bath 1:218
LD 1040uL + FD 20uL
LH 520uL
HGB 8uL
HGB (before lysing) 1:1131
DIL 1500uL
Secondary aspiration 80uL
RBC 1:28125
DIL 1975uL
Figure 7-5 Prediluted Sample dilution flow chart
7-5
HGB 1:1543
Fluidics System
7.4 Sample Volume Table 7-1 Sample volume Inspection
Whole blood
Micro-WB
Item
mode
mode
64.5L
30L
RET sample
4L
4L
8uL
HGB sample
6L
6L
8uL
WNB sample
15L
6L
25uL
DIFF sample
20L
6.5L
30uL
25uL
25L
65uL
Aspiration capacity
RBC diluted sample
7-6
Prediluted mode Manual dilution: 20uL blood sample and 100uL diluent; aspirate 83L
Fluidics System
7.5 Time of Preparation and Measurement Table 7-2 Time of Preparation and Measurement Channel Time of Preparation Time of Measurement
WNB
DIFF
RET
HGB
RBC
channel
Channel
Channel
Channel
Channel
≤10s
≤21s
≤46.5s
≤5.3s
≤9s
6s
6s
4s
/
10s
7-7
Fluidics System
7.6 Temperature Control for Fluidics System Table 7-3 Temperature Control for Fluidics System Inspection Item Target temperature (℃) Alarm temperature (℃)
Multi-channel diluent
Optical
Reaction
preheating bath
system
bath
32
32
42
±3
+6/-2
±3
7-8
Fluidics System
7.7 Reagent Consumption Volume The consumption volumes of various reagents in measurement mode are as follows (unit: mL): Table 7-4 Reagent consumption volume Scenario
Name
Diluent
HGB
DIFF
RET
WNB
Channel
Channel
Channel
channel
DIL
LH
LD
FD
DR
FR
LN
FN
Continuous
WB CBC
40
1.04
0
0
0
0
1.5
0.02
measurement
WB CD
40
0.52
1.56
0.02
0
0
1.5
0.02
WB CDR
55
0.52
1.56
0.02
1.56
0.02
1.5
0.02
WB CR
50
1.04
0
0
1.56
0.02
1.5
0.02
WB RET
50
1.04
0
0
1.56
0.02
1.5
0.02
Micro-WB CBC
45
1.04
0
0
0
0
1.5
0.02
Micro-WB CD
50
1.04
1.56
0.02
0
0
1.5
0.02
Micro-WB CDR
60
1.04
1.56
0.02
1.56
0.02
1.5
0.02
Micro-WB CR
55
1.04
0
0
1.56
0.02
1.5
0.02
Micro-WB RET
55
1.04
0
0
1.56
0.02
1.5
0.02
PD CBC
45
1.04
0
0
0
0
1.5
0.02
PD CD
50
1.04
1.56
0.02
0
0
1.5
0.02
PD CDR
60
1.04
1.56
0.02
1.56
0.02
1.5
0.02
PD CR
60
1.04
0
0
1.56
0.02
1.5
0.02
PD RET
60
1.04
0
0
1.56
0.02
1.5
0.02
OV enters shallow sleep (1H~3H)
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Sleep
7-9
Fluidics System
Mode switch
Startup/shutdown
OV exits shallow sleep (1H~3H)
6
0.52
0
0
0
0
0
0
CT-AL enters shallow sleep (1H~3H)
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
CT-AL exits shallow sleep (1H~3H)
6
0.52
0
0
0
0
0
0
Enter deep sleep (3H~24H)
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
OV exits deep sleep (3H~24H)
120
5.2
3.12
0.06
3.12
0.06
3
0.06
CT exits deep sleep (3H~24H)
120
5.2
3.12
0.06
3.12
0.06
3
0.06
AL switches to CT
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
CT switches to AL
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
AL switches to OV
2
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
OV switches to AL
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
CT shutdown (routine shutdown every
145
0.52
1.56
0.06
0
0
3
0.06
RET
145
0.52
1.56
0.06
2.6
0.06
3
0.06
OV shutdown (routine shutdown every
140
0.52
1.56
0.06
0
0
3
0.06
140
0.52
1.56
0.06
2.6
0.06
3
0.06
Startup 1 (normal)
120
5.2
3.12
0.06
3.12
0.06
3
0.06
Startup 2 (abnormal)
240
10.4
6.24
0.12
6.24
0.12
6
0.12
Replace DIL
16
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Replace LH
0.016
12.48
0
0
0
0
0
0
Replace LN
0.016
0
0
0
0
0
12
0.04
Replace LD
0.016
0
12.5
0.04
0
0
0
0
day) CT
shutdown
(accumulative
modes > 200) day) OV shutdown 4 (accumulative RET modes > 200)
Replace reagents
7-10
Fluidics System
Replace DR
0.003
0
0
0
12.5
0.04
0
0
Replace FN
3
0
0
0
0
0
0
0.84
Replace FD
3
0
0
0.84
0
0
0
0
Replace FR
3
0
0
0
0
0.84
0
0
7-11
Fluidics System
7.8 Fluidic Parts and Functions 7.8.1 Sample probe The sample probe is used to aspirate and dispense samples, move between each incubation bath through horizontal and vertical motors to dispense samples.
7.8.2 Probe Wipe The probe wipe is used to provide a cavity to clean the exterior walls of the sample probe using the liquid flow; and collect the waste produced by cleaning the interior walls.
7.8.3 Pumps
Air pump (P1): provides pressure for the pneumatic system. It provides 120kPa and N40kPa pressure chambers directly to build the pressure.
Waste pump (P2): Collects probe wipe waste
Waste pump (P3): Drains WC1
Dosing pumps: meter the output of the reagent device. There are 11 dosing pumps set in the analyzer, and their functions are shown below:
DP1~DP4 are used to quantitatively output DR, LD, LN, and LH reagents respectively;
DP5 and DP6 are used to quantitatively output the diluent to the RBC channel and HGB channel respectively;
DP8 is used to buffer the DIL bath during the filling process;
DP9~DP11 are used to quantitatively output FR, FD, and FN reagents respectively.
Figure 7-6 Dosing pump symbol
7-12
Fluidics System
Liquid chamber connector
Air cell connector
Figure 7-7 Dosing pump appearance
7.8.4 Syringe
Aspiration syringe (Asp-Syringe): the full range is 100μl, quantitatively aspirates and dispenses the blood sample, and aspirates the secondary diluted sample.
Dilution syringe (Dil-Syringe): the full range is 10ml, pours the diluent into the FCM bath;
Sample injection syringe (Sp-Syringe): the full range is 250uL, pours the sample fluid into the flow cell to form a stable sample flow through working with the sheath fluid.
The syringe symbol is shown in the figure below.
Figure 7-8 Syringe symbol
7.8.5 Valves
Mindray valves
Two-way valve: to build up or cut off a passage. When power off, the passage from the inlet of the valve to outlet is cut off; when power on, the passage is build up.
Three-way valve: to switch among passages. When power off, the public end and the NO (normally open) end are connected; when power on, the public end and the N.O.(normally open) end are connected.
Note: the operating voltage of Mindray valves is 12V, and maximal bearable pressure is 200KPa. The internal movement of the valves is driven by electromagnet and the 7-13
Fluidics System
restoration is driven by the spring, so it is recommended not put the valves power-on for too long. When the electromagnet valve is working, the spring pole will lower down, and it will rise to the initial position when power off. You can touch the spring pole and feel the descending or ascending, in order to determine whether it is in action.
Figure 7-9 Symbols of two-way Mindray valve (left) and three-way Mindray valve (right)
Spring pole
Figure 7-10 Appearance of two-way Mindray valve (left) and three-way Mindray valve (right)
Two-way/Three-way pressure proof Mindray valve
Function: The two-way pressure proof Mindray valve has higher reserve pressure resistance compared with the ordinary two-way Mindray valve, while its operating principle is the same as that of the ordinary Mindray valve. The three-way pressure proof Mindray valve has higher reserve pressure resistance at the NC end compared with the ordinary three-way Mindray valve, while its operating principle is the same as that of the ordinary Mindray valve.
Note: when replacing valves, carefully distinguish ordinary two-way/three-way Mindray valves from pressure-proof valves. In the fluidics diagram, the pressure proof valve has the same symbol as the Mindray valve.
7-14
Fluidics System
Two-way/Threeway pressureproof Mindray valve
Two-way Mindray valve
Figure 7-11 Two-way/Three-way pressure proof Mindray valve
LVMK two-way/three-way valve
Function: LVMK two-way/three-way valve has the same function as the twoway/three-way Mindray valve, but the valve pump's working volume and pressure deformation are better than the Mindray valve. It is mainly used for sampling tubing and pipelines with high quantitative requirements.
Figure 7-12 LVMK two-way/three-way valve
LVM valve of 20uL dosing pump
Function: works with the 20ul dosing pump, dispensing the fluorescent dyes from the reagent bag in the optical reaction bath.
Note: the maximal bearable pressure of the LVM fluidic valve is 200KPa, and the CV of the flow is about 0.03.
Figure 7-13 LVM valve of 20uL dosing pump 7-15
Fluidics System
Check valve
Function: only allow one-way flow of gas or liquid. Only allow gas or liquid to flow from A to B (B to A is not allowed).
Note: be aware of the direction of flow for the check valve (as indicated by the arrow in the figures above).
Figure 7-14 Symbol and appearance of check valve
Pinch valve
Function: opens and closes the pipeline by clamping and releasing the hose using compressed gas as the power.
Note: when removing and installing the pinch valve, 120kPa positive pressure must be released first.
Figure 7-15 Appearance of pinch valve
7.8.6 Baths
WNB bath, DIFF bath and RET bath: provide optical channel sample reaction place. The bath body has the temperature control function and can achieve constant temperature incubation.
RBC bath: consists of front bath, back bath and an aperture. It is where the RBC sample is mixed for analysis; supports the measurement of RBC/PLT.
HGB bath: provides HGB channel sample reaction place for HGB colorimetric analysis. 7-16
Fluidics System
7.8.7 Filters
Waste filter LF1: filters impurities from the WC1 to protect the waste pump P3
Probe wipe filter LF2: filters impurities from the probe wipe to protect the waste pump P2;
Waste filter
Probe wipe filter
Figure 7-16 Appearance of probe wipe filter and waste filter
Diluent filter LF3: filters impurities from the FCM bath to protect the optical channel;
Figure 7-17 Diluent filter
Sheath fluid filter LF4: blocks tiny bubbles in the FCM channel.
7-17
Fluidics System
Figure 7-18 Appearance of sheath fluid filter
7.8.8 Liquid Pressure Detection Components
Sampling pressure sensor LPS: collects the pressure condition of the sampling tubing for sampling abnormal flags.
Pressure sensors PS1~PS6: monitor the pressure in the pressure tank for the pressure feedback during the pressure build-up process.
7-18
Fluidics System
7.9 Pneumatic System 7.9.1 Pneumatic System Introduction P1
OPEN
OPEN
OPEN
120KPa SV61
SV62
SV60 PS6
SV64
PS1
PS5
SV65 PS3 PS2
GC-120KPa 600mL
GC-50KPa 600mL GC-N40KPa 600mL
GC-90KPa 600mL
SV63
50KPa
90KPa
N40KPa
Waste f rom the pressure flowing tubes
7.9.2 Introduction of Pneumatic Parts and Functions
Air pump P1: provides the pressure for the entire pneumatic system.
Pressure chamber GC-120kPa: stores the 120kPa compressed gas to provide the pressure for the pinch valve, and fills the pressure for the 90kPa, 50kPa pressure tank;
Pressure chamber GC-90kPa: stores the 90kPa compressed gas to provide the stable pressure for the FCM bath, which is used to outputting the sheath fluid for the optical measurement;
Pressure chamber GC-50kPa: stores 50kPa compressed gas to provide fluid power for the various dosing pumps and DIL cistern;
Vacuum chamber GC-N40kPa: stores -40kPa compressed gas to provide the vacuum power for the WC1 and RBC analysis.
Pressure sensors PS1~PS6: monitor and feed back the pressure of each air reservoir.
7-19
Fluidics System
7.10 Fluidic Channels and Fluidic Structure 7.10.1 WNB Channel DT SV26
SV48
SV58
LN DP01 DP11 20uL FN DYE bag SV27
50kPa N40kP a
WNB
DIFF RH 2
DIFF
WNB
LN reagent container
RET RH 2
RH 3
RET
SV18
DP3 1.0mL
SV14
PV02/SV75 SP_SYRINGE
SV36
WC1-O
WC2-S
50kPa
SV33
SV44
WC1-N
SV08
PV01/SV74
OPEN
50kPa
FC
Figure 7-19 WNB measurement channel Process description: the M-6 LN LYSE is aspirated from the LN cistern and dispensed into the WNB preheating bath by DP3 (1mL), bringing the preheated LN LYSE into the WNB bath. The lyse first lyses the normal red blood cells, and then perforates other cells. The FN DYE is then dispensed into the WNB bath by DP11 (20uL), and combined with the nucleic acid in white blood cells or nucleated red blood cells. The solenoid valve SV08 controls the 50kPa pressure to bubble during the whole process (referred to as incubation process) to facilitate the reaction. After incubation, the sample is pushed by the vacuum of WC1 to go through pinch valves PV02 and PV01, and then aspirated into the sample preparation tubing. The syringe then pushes the sample to go to the flow cell. Wrapped by the sheath fluid, the sample flow goes through the flow cell while the optical system starts to identify the cells passing through the flow cell. These signals will then be analyzed and processed to get the WNB scattergram. After the measurement, the analyzer will clean the flow cell and downstream tubing with diluent, and the syringe will restore to the initial status, getting ready for the measurement of next channel (DIFF).
7-20
Fluidics System
7.10.2
DIFF Channel DT
SV47
SV57
LD
FD Dye bag
SV25
50kPa N40kPa
WNB
DIFF RH 2
WNB
LD reagent container
RET RH 3
RH 2
RET
SV17
DIFF
DP01 DP10 20uL
DP2 0.5mL
SV13
PV03/SV76
SV07
SP_SYRINGE
WC1-O
WC2-S
50kPa
SV36
SV43
WC1-D
PV01/SV74
SV33
OPEN
50kPa
FC
Figure 7-20 DIFF measurement channel Process description: the LD LYSE is aspirated from the LD cistern and dispensed into the DIFF preheating bath by DP2 (0.5mL), bringing the preheated LD LYSE into the DIFF bath. The lyse first lyses the normal red blood cells, and then perforates the white blood cells. The FD DYE is then dispensed into the DIFF bath by DP10 (20uL), and combine with the nucleic acid in the white blood cells. The solenoid valve SV07 controls the 50kPa pressure to bubble during the whole process (referred to as incubation process) to facilitate the reaction. After incubation, the sample is pushed by the vacuum of WC1 to go through pinch valves PV03 and PV01, and then aspirated into the sample preparation tubing. The syringe then pushes the sample to go to the flow cell. Wrapped by the sheath fluid, the sample flow goes through the flow cell while the optical system starts to identify the cells passing through the flow cell. These signals will then be analyzed and processed to get the DIFF scattergram. After the measurement, the analyzer will clean the flow cell and downstream tubing with diluent, and the syringe will restore to the initial status, getting ready for the measurement of next channel (RET).
7-21
Fluidics System
7.10.3
RET Channel DT
SV46
SV56
DR DP01 DP9 20uL FR DYE bag SV24
50kPa N40kPa
WNB
DIFF RH 2
RH 3
RH 2
DIFF
WNB
DR reagent container
RET RET
SV16
DP1 0.5mL
SV13
PV04/SV77 SP_SYRINGE
WC1-O
WC2-S
50kPa
SV36
SV38
WC1-R
SV06 PV01/SV74
SV33
OPEN
50kPa
FC
Figure 7-21 RET measurement channel Process description: the DR DILUENT is aspirated from the DR cistern and dispensed into the RET preheating bath by DP1 (0.5mL), bringing the preheated DR DILUENT into the RET bath. The DR diluent first spherizes the cells. The FR DYE is then dispensed into the RET bath by DP9 (20uL), and combined with the reticulocyte and the nucleic acid in the white blood cells. The solenoid valve SV06 controls the 50kPa pressure to bubble during the whole process (referred to as incubation process) to facilitate the reaction. After incubation, the sample is pushed by the vacuum of WC1 to go through pinch valves PV04 and PV07, and then aspirated into the sample preparation tubing. The syringe then pushes the sample to go to the flow cell. Wrapped by the sheath fluid, the sample flow goes through the flow cell while the optical system starts to identify the cells passing through the flow cell. These signals will then be analyzed and processed to get the RET scattergram. After the measurement, the analyzer will clean the flow cell and downstream tubing with diluent, and the syringe will restore to the initial status.
7-22
Fluidics System
RBC/PLT Channel
50kPa
RH1RBC
N40kPa
7.10.4
SV66 VC
TS1 SV30 DIL RBC SV32 VC-N30KPa 180mL
DP6 2.0mL
SV69 ICF1
SV12
50kPa
OPEN
T52
SV35 SV05
DP8 8mL
SV42
OPEN 50kPa
50kPa
WC1-RC
WC1-VC
SV67
SV41
Figure 7-22 RBC measurement channel Process description: The dosing pump DP06 (2mL) pushes the diluent in the DIL bath into the HGB bath, dispense the 25uL secondary dilution sample with the sample probe, bubble and mix the sample. The mixed sample passes through the aperture and generates a corresponding pulse signal under the vacuum of the VC bath.
7-23
Fluidics System
7.10.5
HGB Channel DT SV49
N40kPa
50kPa
LH
SV66
SV23
RH1HGB
LH reagent container
HGB SV29
SV28 DIL
DP4 0.5mL
DP5 1.5mL SV11 SV69
OPEN
DP8 8mL
OPEN
50kPa
50kPa
SV14
SV45
WC1-H
OPEN 50kPa
SV67
50kPa
SV09
Figure 7-23 HGB measurement channel Process description: The dosing pump DP05 (1.5mL) pushes the diluent in the DIL bath into the HGB bath; the dosing pump DP04 (0.52mL) pushes the LH lyse into the HGB bath. Then the sample is mixed by small bubbles. Place the well-mixed sample in still for a while and then obtain the measurement voltage. Since the blank voltage of the sample is attained before the measurement, the HGB can be calculated based on the colorimetric equation.
7-24
Fluidics System
7.11 Introduction to Sequences Taking the CBC+DIFF+RET analysis in the CT-WB mode as an example:
7.11.1
CT-WB Analysis Sequences
0~12s: as shown in the figure below The sample probe moves to the CT-WB position. The sampling tube builds vacuum through closing SV55 and opening SV54. When it is ready, the ASP syringe performs whole blood sample aspiration through the ASP syringe after the preparation. Clean the sample probe after piercing; Drain the RET bath, HGB bath, WNB bath, DIFF bath, RBC bath; Dispense 0.5ml RET diluent into the RET bath through DP1 and SV24, clean each involved tubing and bath, drain the bath and get ready for the subsequent procedure; Dispense 1.5ml diluent into the HGB bath through DP5 and SV29, measure the blank voltage, and drain the HGB bath after the measurement; Dispense 1ml lyse into the WNB bath through DP3 and SV27, clean each involved tubing and bath, drain the bath and get ready for the subsequent procedure; Dispense 0.5ml lyse into the DIFF bath through DP2 and SV25, clean each involved tubing and bath, drain the bath and get ready for the subsequent procedure; Dispense 2.0ml diluent into the RBC bath through DP6 and SV30, and then wash the bath, drain the RBC bath and get ready for the subsequent procedure; 9.0
V03-N40kPa SV01-50kPa
CV07
T53
T73
T54
DP8 8mL
SV67
WC2-S
WC2-C
OPEN PV05/SV50
DT LH
T42 SV34 T43
Waste Container
SV49
T41
C29 T35 C11 T38
C30 T39
T11
T15
LN
C36
SV48
C21 T19
T12
T16 T17
T13 T14
T36
C16
C12
C17
C13
C18
C14
C19 C20
C15
C1 C6
C2 C7
C3 C8
C4 C9
C5 C10 DIL reagent container
T32
T31 C50
T5
SV47
T33
LD
C35
DIL-V40
T48 T49
SV46 C33
T44
T113 WCT
P7-T4-P8
T28
T25
CV06
T26
10mL
T29
T30
T34
C34
PV06/SV51
FCM-90kPa V66-N40kPa
V66-50kPa
7-25
C22 T20
PUMP_WASTE T353
T361
T18
DIL
C165 T146
C23 T21
P3
LH T360
T359
T346
T352
C25
C157
C144
T351 C147
C143
P5-T3-P6
T243
T245
T244
T246 LH-1
T374 SV45 SV09
C156 LN
LF1
T338
T390 C152 C151 T391 T386 T356 T357 T387
C155
C24
SV72 T45
SV01
C134 T344 CV04
C150 T355
LD
T22
T392
T337
T370
T345 C146 T350
T10
WC1-B
C133 T114
T9 LH reagent container
C65
T389 T385
C135 T339 T343 CV03 C26
C161 WC2
C145 T349
P3-T2-P4 T7 LD reagent container
C66 T135
J11-T144-J12-P11 T373
T331
T336
T347 T348
T112
C56
T84
T383
T8 LN reagent container
SV41
T134
C164
T47
SV69 T52
C137
T91
SV73
C38
T332
C136 T340 T342 CV02 C27
T358
T46 C46 T110
T55
T50
T354 DR
C40
T51
C149
T388
C177
T59 T58
C28
C154
T396
T57
T341
T384
SV68
T56
C138
WC1
P1-T1-P2 T6 DR reagent container
WC2-C
T145
WC1-H
P2
DP4 0.5mL
SV09-50kPa
C58
T371 C162 T124
SV05-50kPa
T95
T118
T111
T393 ICF2
C139
T333
DIL
C37
T133 SV35
SV05 SV42 C47
SV29
C163 T372
DIL-V40
C57 LF2
T224 T211
TC T397 C178
C175 T394
T335
C41 T64 T61 C176 T60T395
T62
SV28 T210
T138 DP5 C70 1.5mL SV11
J6-T122-J7-P10 C54
SV04
SV09-50kPaT300
T315
CV01
T289
FCM
C39
SV12-50kPa OPEN
DIL-CL
T105
ICF1
C125
C174
LF3
T132 T108
WC1-VC
SV40 J2-T92-J3
T409
VCN30KPa 180mL
SV12 SV12-50kPa OPEN
10mL
J61-T85-J62
C51
T97
T410
T90
C124
T330
SV23
HGB
SV32
C153
T334
T63
C68
T121 T130 C64 T131
T119
T100 DP6 2.0mL
SV17-50kPa T364
CV05
WC1-N WC1-H WC1-D WC1-R WC1-VC WC1-S
T115 SV03 T116 T117
T295 SV08-50kPa T299
PV01
WC1-O WC1-RC C118
V66-50kPa
C123
SV07-50kPa T298
C130 T306 C132 T363
C140
T269
T294
C129
SV16-50kPa T314
SV66
C63 T129
T120
T106
T96
C188
ASP_SYRINGE
VC
T94 C187
T127 C62
LF4
C49
C69
SV30 RBC
T74
T75
T140
C95 T168 T177
DIL
T69
VC TS1 C45
LPS T76
T288
C122
PV02
SV75
SV74
T293
WC1-B
SV52
C61
T329
DR
C60
C59
T77 T82
SV39
C42
RH1HGB
DIL_SYRINGE
T89
J8-T126
T125
C121 T292
SV05-50kPa T296 SV06-50kPa T297
T305 SV14-50kPa T312
SV18-50kPa
C83
PS4
T128
SV55
C55
FCM1
T178
SV02 C48
C128
SV13-50kPa T311
C113
RH1 -CL
T65
T68
C127 T303
SV12-50kPa T310
T304
C112
LH
C43
C44
C126 T302
SV11-50kPa T309
V67-50kPa
T147 SV20
T179 C96
SV01-50kPa T308
LH-1
T362
T180
T102
T93
T227
T301
T323
SV18-N40kPa
T148
C67
T198
T328
FCM1
C171
T327
SV17-N40kPa
FCM2
T184 C97
RH1RBC
PWD
SV71
T229
T70
WC1-R
T194
SV16-N40kPa
C98
C52
PN
T149
DIL-CL
SP_SYRINGE
WC1-S
C169
T190
T66
T88
C94 T150
FCM-90kPa
SV38
T380
C93 T151
J27-T185-J28 T186
T67
SV53
T322
C92
T228
SV22
Piercing manifold
T87
C111
T320
T399
SV31 T401 PV07/SV78 SV37 T382 C180 J15-T163-J16 C173
SV54
C110 T321
T326
OPEN SV67-50kPa
PV04/SV77
PV03/SV76
PV02/SV75
SV43
T378
WC1-RC
WC2-S
T381
J13-T152-J14
C91 SV44
C99
T235
C53
T325
SV04-N40kPa
T209 C90
T153 C172
C89
OPEN
T167
T154 C170 T379
C88
WC1-D
T405
J48-T234-J49
WC1-O
T176
J17-T164-J18
J68-T404-J69 C181 T403
T375 SV36 C166
SV03-N40kPa SV07-50kPa
SV06-50kPa
T159 T197 C179 T398
T158 T155 C168 T377
C87
WC1-N
SV33
T156
T402
J23-T175-J24
T376 C167
T193
T157
C86 C182
SV07
SV06 T189
PV01/SV74
C85 J19-T165-J20
J66-T400-J67
J33-T195-J34-P26
T279
T268
T262
SV04-N40kPa
FCM2
J21-T166-J22
T162
C109
SV08-50kPa
C80 T161
T290
C120 T324
SV66-N40kPa
PV03
SV76 T265 OPEN
OPEN
SV13 SV08
T160 T181
FC
J31-T191-J32-P25
C79
RH1 -SH
T172
T173
50KPa
SV21
T169
SV70
C114
SV63
C117
T267
OPEN
T261
C186 T366 Positive pressure waste
GC-90KPa 600mL
T365
SV14-50kPa OPEN SV13-50kPa
GC-50KPa 600mL
C107 T250
90KPa
T171
T208 C71
T213 T221
C72
T318 GC-N40KPa 600mL T319
OPEN
C78
T170
T242
C183
T222
T230
SV14
PV04
SV77
T264
T23
C77
DP3 1.0mL
CV08
C76
T287
DP2 0.5mL
T27
C75
DP1 0.5mL
T266
OPEN
T260 C106 T282
T291
RH 3
T263
C105
C116
C119
T24
T219
PS2
PV07
SV78
OPEN
T278
PV06
SV51 T408
T259
J52-T281 T283
T274
N40KPa
T174 C81
LN
DR
RET
RH 2
RE T
SV18-50kPa SV18-N40kPa
DIFF
RH 2
T272
SV27
T258 OPEN T407
SV65 PS3
C101
T248
T284 SV25
J29-T187-J30-P24
C84 J54-T240-J55 C148 J56-T241-J57
C184 J50-T271
C115
T247
T285 C100
PV05
SV50
T255
T406
SV64
PS1
T286
GC-120KPa 600mL
J25-T182-J26 C82 T183
T280
T317
C160
T225 DI FF
WNB
SV17-50kPa SV17-N40kPa
C159
SV24
SV18
SV16-50kPa SV16-N40kPa
SV17
PS6
C104 T254 C108 T253
120KPa
T270
SV61 J51-T276-J53
C158
WNB
SV16
F D FN DYE bag
T201
C103
T252
SV60
T316
T257
OPEN C102
T251
PS5
C73
DP01 DP11 20uL
F D FD DYE bag
T200
T256
OPEN
C141
SV62
C74 P23-J43
DP10 20uL
FR FR DYE bag
T199
SV26 J46-T217-J47
T218
SV58 P22-J42
DP02 DP9 20uL
OPEN
P17
SV57 P21-J41
SV56
J36-T203-P14
P15
C142
OPEN
P13 J35-T202-P12
LD
P1
J38-T205-P18 J39-T206-P19 J40-T207-P20 J37-T204-P16
Fluidics System
12~31s: as shown in the figure below The sample probe sequentially moves to the RET bath, HGB bath, WNB bath, and DIFF bath for blood sample dispensing. The blood sample dispensed to the RBC bath is the diluted sample from the HGB bath. Clean the exterior and probe wipe after each blood dispensing. Dispense the DR Diluent into the RET bath through DP1 and SV24; at the same time, add the fluorescent dye into the RET bath through DP9 and SV56; open SV06 to bubble, and then the sample in the bath starts reacting; Dispense the diluent into the HGB bath through DP5 and SV29; at the same time, add the LH lyse into the HGB bath through DP4 and SV28; open SV09 to bubble, and then the sample in the bath starts reacting; Dispense the LN lyse into the WNB bath through DP3 and SV27, at the same time, add the fluorescent dye to the DIFF bath through DP11 and SV58; open SV08 to bubble, and then the sample in the bath starts reacting; Dispense the LD lyse into the DIFF bath through DP2 and SV25; at the same time, add the fluorescent dye into the DIFF bath through DP10 and SV57; open SV07 to bubble, and then the sample in the bath starts reacting; Dispense the diluent into the RBC bath through DP6 and SV30; open SV05 to bubble, and then the sample in the bath starts reacting; 9.0
7-26
CV07
C22
SV47
T33
T32
T53
T73
LH
C29 T35 C11 T38
C30 T39
T11
T15
T12
T16 T17
T13 T14
T18 T54
DP8 8mL
SV67
WC2-S
WC2-C
Waste Container
SV49 DT
LN
T43
OPEN
C21 T19
T41
LD
C36
SV48
T42 SV34
DIL-V40
C35
T113 WCT
T36
C16
C12
C17
C13
C18 C19
C14
C20
C15
C1 C6
C2 C7
C3 C8
T5
SV46 C33
T31 C50
PUMP_WASTE T353
T361
T20
T44
P3
P7-T4-P8
T34
C34
T352
C25
C157
C143 T346
P5-T3-P6
T25
T28
T29
T30
CV06
T26
C23 T21
T351 C147
LH T360
C144
C4 C9
C5 C10 DIL reagent container
C165 T146
C156 LN
T345 C146 T350 LF1
T338
T344 CV04
T370
T10
T374 SV45 SV09
T48 T49 SV69
T52
T343 CV03 C26
T359 C24
DR
T50
C134
T339
T390 C152 C151 T391 T386 T356 T357 T387
C155
T22
SV01
C150 T355
LD T358
SV72 T45
SV73
DIL
T373
T47 T55
T51
C133 T114
T392
T337
T91
SV68
C40
C38
C135
WC2
C145 T349
T9 LH reagent container
FCM-90kPa
10mL
C154
C136 T340 T342 CV02 C27
T389 T385
DR T46 C46 T110
C177
T59 T58
C28
C149 T354
WC1-B
V66-50kPa
C164
SV12-50kPa OPEN
WC1-B
CV05
DIL
C37 DP4 0.5mL
T341
T388
C41 T64 T61 C176 T60T395
T56
T336
C137
T331
C161
T348 T112
C56
T84
T383 T347
PV05/SV50
T393 ICF2
C138
T332
WC1
P3-T2-P4 T7 LD reagent container
C66 T135
C65
T394
C139
T333
T384
T396
T57
TC T397 C178
C175
T8 LN reagent container
T243
T245
T244
T246 FCM1
FCM2 LH
LH-1
SV29
WC1-H
SV41
WC1-VC
C47 WC2-C
T134 SV05-50kPa
P2
WC1-RC
T97
LF2
T371 C162 T124
SV09-50kPaT300
C153
CV01
SV66
T62
T224 T211
SV28 T210
SV09-50kPa
SV42 T118
T111
SV04
C174
LF3
T138 DP5 C70 1.5mL SV11
T133 SV35
SV05
DIL-V40
C125
T330
T289
FCM
C39
C163 T372
C54
C132 T363
T335
SV23
T132
C57
FCM-90kPa
WC1-R J8-T126
T105
DIL-CL
VCN30KPa 180mL
ICF1
C124
T295 SV08-50kPa T299
T315
C140
WC1-N WC1-H WC1-D WC1-R WC1-VC WC1-S
T115 SV03
T294
C130 T306
T334
T63
C69
SV32
LF4
C49
HGB
T106 C51
C95 T168 T177
C68
T121 T130 C64 T131
SV12 SV12-50kPa OPEN
10mL
J61-T85-J62
T140
T127 C62
T119
T100 DP6 2.0mL
SV16-50kPa T314
WC1-O WC1-RC
T116 T117
C123
PV01
SV74
C118
V66-50kPa
C122
SV07-50kPa T298
T305 SV14-50kPa T312
T269
T293
C129
SV13-50kPa T311
C113
T288
T292 SV05-50kPa T296 SV06-50kPa T297
T304
C112
T329
C63 T129
T120
SV30
C128
T323
C83
T69
RH1HGB
C61
C127 T303
SV12-50kPa T310
SV18-50kPa
DIL
PS4
VC
T90
C58
FCM1
T178
C42
OPEN
T125
C126 T302
SV11-50kPa T309
T262
V67-50kPa
PV02
SV75
OPEN
C121
T147 SV20
T179
T128
C60
SV01-50kPa T308
SV17-50kPa T364
SV02 C48
RBC
T95
T328
RH1 -CL
T362
TS1
T96
T410
ASP_SYRINGE
VC
C188
T327
SV17-N40kPa
T301
LH-1
T65
T68
C59
C45
T74
T409
T227
C96
SV52
SV40 J2-T92-J3
SV16-N40kPa
SV18-N40kPa
T148
C67
C43
T77
T94 C187
SV71
T229
T70
T198
C44
LPS T76
T93
T149
C98
T82
PWD
C94 T150
DIL_SYRINGE
SP_SYRINGE
T186
T89
T75
C93 T151
DIL-CL
C171
SV55
SV39
C92
J27-T185-J28
RH1RBC
C55
J13-T152-J14 T228
T180
T102
T88
C111
T209
T381 SV38
T380
T194
T184 C97
Piercing manifold
PN
C110 T321
T326
V66-N40kPa
PV04/SV77
PV03/SV76
PV02/SV75
C169
T190
C52
SV53
SV06-50kPa
SV22
T66
T87
T325
SV04-N40kPa
T320
T399
T67
SV54
SV03-N40kPa SV07-50kPa
T322
C90
T153 C172
C89
WC1-D
T405
WC1-S
SV43
T378
WC1-N
WC2-S
T154 C170 T379
C88
C91 SV44
C99
T235
C53
SV07
T159 T197 C179 T398
T158 T155 C168 T377
C87
SV31 T401 PV07/SV78 SV37 T382 C180 J15-T163-J16 C173
WC1-O
T176
T375 SV36 C166
T167
T402
J23-T175-J24
C167
T156 J17-T164-J18
J68-T404-J69 C181 T403 J48-T234-J49
T162
T279
T268
OPEN
SV04-N40kPa
FCM2
J66-T400-J67 SV33
C109
SV06 T193
T157
C86 J19-T165-J20 C182
T324
SV66-N40kPa SV08-50kPa
C80 T161
T189
PV01/SV74
C85
T173
T376
T160 T181
FC
C183
SV08
OPEN SV67-50kPa
RH1 -SH
T290
C120
SV13
C79
T169
T172
J21-T166-J22
50KPa
SV21
T242 SV70
90KPa
T174 C81
N40KPa
C72
T171
C117 OPEN SV13-50kPa
T221
C186 T366 Positive pressure waste
GC-90KPa 600mL
T365 C114
PV03
SV76 T265
C107 T250 SV63
C78
T170
C84 J54-T240-J55 C148 J56-T241-J57
T213
T318 GC-N40KPa 600mL T319
OPEN SV14-50kPa
V03-N40kPa
T222
T230
SV14 T208 C71
PV06/SV51
C77
DP3 1.0mL
P1-T1-P2 T6 DR reagent container
C76
DP2 0.5mL
T267
OPEN
T261
SV01-50kPa
DP1 0.5mL
PV04
SV77
T264
T282 GC-50KPa T287 600mL
T266
OPEN
T260 C106
T291
RH 3
T263
C105
C116
C119
PV07
SV78
OPEN
T283
PS2
T278
T23
RH 2
C75
T272
T274
CV08
RET
RE T
SV18-50kPa SV18-N40kPa
T219
T248
GC-120KPa 600mL
T225
DIFF
RH 2
T286
SV27
PV06
SV51 T408
T259
J52-T281
T284 SV25
T258 OPEN T407
SV65 PS3
C101
T317
C160
J25-T182-J26 C82 T183
C184 J50-T271
C115
T247
PV05
SV50
T255
T406
T27
C159
SV24
WNB
SV17-50kPa SV17-N40kPa
SV16-50kPa SV16-N40kPa
PS5
T24
C158
SV18
T280 SV64
PS1 J51-T276-J53
DI FF
SV17
F D FN DYE bag
T201
C104 T254 C108 T253
120KPa
T270
SV61
T285 C100
T257
OPEN C103
T252
SV60
T316
WNB
SV16
DP01 DP11 20uL
F D FD DYE bag
T200
T256 C102
T251
C141 PS6
C73 P23-J43
DP10 20uL
FR FR DYE bag
T199
P22-J42
P21-J41
DP02 DP9 20uL
C142
OPEN
SV62
C74
SV58
SV57
OPEN
T218 SV56
LN
DR
SV26 J46-T217-J47
OPEN
LD
P1
Fluidics System
31~42.6s: as shown in the figure below Open SV39 and SV53, and then the 10mL syringe pushes the diluent out of the sample probe cleaning channel. In the meanwhile, open SV40 to clean the exterior of the probe. When the cleaning is completed, the sample probe returns to its “ready for work” status; Keep the HGB bath sample still for a moment, and then start measurement; drain the HGB bath after the measurement; dispense diluent to wash the bath twice (1.5mL diluent each time); Open SV32 to form a sample flow, and start the RBC channel measurement; With the corporate efforts of SV36, PV01 and PV02, the sample in the WNB bath gets to the inlet of the three-way connector of the flow cell; open SV70 to form the sheath flow; With the help of SV33, the SP_SYRINGE sample syringe pushes the WNB sample located in the sample preparation tubing into the optical analysis area of the flow cell for the measurement; Drain the WNB bath; open SV71 and PV02 to dispense about 1.4ml diluent into the WNB bath. The WNB bath then gets ready for analysis; Open SV71, SV36 and PV01 to clean the optical analysis sample preparation channel; Other auxiliary actions: Prime the FCM cistern with diluent from the diluent container through the DIL_SYRINGE syringe; Prime the DIL cistern through the DIL vacuum; Drain WC1 to the waste container The WNB channel tests completes. 9.0
正压废液
SV41
C66 T135
WC1-B
SV45 SV09
C165
7-27
V03-N40kPa
SV47
T33
CV07
T28
T32
C36
T73
C29 T35 C11 T38
C30 T39
T11
T15
T12
T16 T17
T13 T14
T18 T54
DP8 8mL
SV67
WC2-S
OPEN PV05/SV50
DT LH
T43
Waste Container
SV49
T41 T42 SV34 LN
C35
T53
SV48
C21 T19
T36
C16
C12
C17
C13
C18
C14
C19 C20
C15
C1 C6
C2 C7
C3 C8
T5
SV46 C33
T44
T31 C50
P7-T4-P8
T26
T25
CV06
T29
T30
T34
C34
T113 WCT
P5-T3-P6
FCM-90kPa
T48 T49 SV69
T52
T20
PUMP_WASTE T353
C4 C9
C5 C10 T10
C65
C164
SV72 T45
T352
T361 C22
T21
C143 T346
DIL reagent container
C47 WC2-C
T134
WC1-VC
P2
T371 C162 T124 WC1-RC
T97
C58
T96
T95
T133 SV35
SV05 SV42 T118
T50
C23
C24 T22
C144
P3
LH T360
T359
T345 C146 T350
C25
C157
LN
LD
T370
T351 C147
C152 C151 T391 T357 T387 T356 C156
WC2
LF1
T338
T344 CV04
C161
C145 T349
P3-T2-P4 T7 LD reagent container
C54
J11-T144-J12-P11
T47 T55
T51 C38
C155
T386
SV01
C56
T84
T383 T347
T8 LN reagent container
C163 T372
DIL-V40 T111
SV68
C40
DIL
J6-T122-J7-P10
WC1-H
T108
SV09-50kPa
ICF1
DIL_SYRINGE
T132
C57
LF2
DP4 0.5mL
C133 T114
T392 C134
WC1
T348 T112
T337
T339 T343 CV03 C26 T390
C150 T355
C137
T331
C135
T91
SV73 C37
T138 DP5 C70 1.5mL SV11
T340 T342 CV02 C27
T358
C177
T59 T58
T56
T336
T389 T385
DR T46 C46 T110
T396
T57
C28
C149 T354 C154
C41 T64 T61 C176 T60T395
T62
T224 T211
SV28 T210
SV29 VCN30KPa 180mL
SV12 SV12-50kPa OPEN
C51
SV40 J2-T92-J3
T409
SV32
CV01 T388 T384
LF3 C69
C138
T332 C136
T341
CV05
SV23
HGB
C139
T333
DIL
FCM T63
T130
T106 T90
T315
C174
SV66
C63 T129
T100 DP6 2.0mL
T394
T330
T289
LF4
TC T397 C178
C175
T393 ICF2
T335
10mL
LH-1
C95
C49
C68
SV12-50kPa OPEN
ASP_SYRINGE
J61-T85-J62
PWD
DIL-CL
T74
SV04
C153
T334
T168 T177
C39
SV39
C125
LD
T127 C62
C64 RBC
SV09-50kPaT300
DIL-V40
T140
VC
SV30
C132 T363
WC1-B
C83 DIL
T69
RH1HGB
TS1 C45
C124
T295 SV08-50kPa T299
SV16-50kPa T314
C140
WC1-H WC1-D WC1-R WC1-VC WC1-S
T115 SV03 T116 T117
C123
SV07-50kPa T298
C130 T306
SV18-50kPa
LH
C42 PS4
C61
C129
SV14-50kPa T312
DR
SV52
LPS T76
10mL
FCM1
T178
WC1-N
T294
T147 SV20
T179
WC1-O WC1-RC C118
V66-50kPa
C122
PV01
SV74
T293
T305
T329
T288
T292 SV05-50kPa T296 SV06-50kPa T297
C128
SV13-50kPa T311
C113
V66-50kPa
WC1-R
T125 C60
T77 T82
VC
T362
T128
C59
C112 T323
V67-50kPa
C121
T304
SV17-50kPa T364
SV02 C48
C127 T303
SV12-50kPa T310
RH1 -CL
T65
T68
SV11-50kPa T309
LH-1
C67
C43
C44
T89
T410
T227
C96
SV55
C187
T328
SV18-N40kPa
T229
T70
T198
T327
SV17-N40kPa
C98
T102
T93
SV71
T228
J8-T126
T186
穿刺汇流板
C188
C94
J27-T185-J28
C52
T94
C93
FCM2
C171
SV16-N40kPa T209
T180
RH1RBC
C55
C111
DIL-CL
T184 C97
T66
T88
C110 T321
C126 T302
V66-N40kPa
SV38
T380
T194
PV07/SV78
T67
PN
SV06-50kPa
SV22
SP_SYRINGE
WC1-S
SV43 C169
SV31
SV53
T326
T301
SV01-50kPa T308
C92
T399
T235
T87
T325
SV04-N40kPa
OPEN SV67-50kPa
SV44
C99
SV37 T382 C180 C173
SV54
SV03-N40kPa SV07-50kPa
T279
T322
C90
C172
T381
C91
C181 J48-T234-J49
SV07
FCM1
C89
SV05-50kPa
WC1-O
T159 T197 C179 T398
C170 T379
OPEN
T167
C88
C168
WC1-N
T176 WC2-S
C167
T193 T158 C87
WC1-D
T375 SV36 C166
J33-T195-J34-P26
T320
FCM-90kPa
PV01/SV74 C86
C182
J66-T400-J67
T162
C109
T324
SV06
C85 C183 J21-T166-J22 SV33
T161
SV66-N40kPa SV08-50kPa
SV04-N40kPa
FCM2
FC
PV04/SV77
T181 T169
SV70
PV03/SV76
T242
T290
C120
SV13 SV08
C80 PV02/SV75
C81
J31-T191-J32-P25
C79
T269
WC2-C
50KPa
90KPa
SV21 RH1 -SH
PV02
SV75
T262 OPEN
C78 C84 J54-T240-J55 C148
PV03
T268
OPEN
T9 LH reagent container
C114
SV63
C117
C186 T366
GC-90KPa 600mL
T365
SV14-50kPa OPEN SV13-50kPa
T265
C107 T250
N40KPa
J29-T187-J30-P24
T208 C71
T213 T221
C72
T318 GC-N40KPa 600mL T319
OPEN
PV06/SV51
T222
T230
SV14
SV76
P1-T1-P2 T6 DR reagent container
T243
T245
T244
T246
DP3 1.0mL
T267
OPEN
T261
SV01-50kPa
C77
DP2 0.5mL
PV04
SV77
T264
T282 GC-50KPa T287 600mL
T266
OPEN
T260 C106
T23
DP1 0.5mL
T263
C105
C116
C119
CV08
C76
T283
PS2
T278
T291
RH 3
J25-T182-J26 C82 T183
C53
LN
DR
RET
RH 2
C75
T272
T274
PV07
SV78
OPEN
T27
SV18-50kPa SV18-N40kPa
SV17-50kPa SV17-N40kPa
T219
T248
GC-120KPa 600mL
T225
DIFF
RH 2
T286
SV27
PV06
SV51 T408
T259
J52-T281
T284 SV25
T258 OPEN T407
SV65 PS3
C101
T24
WNB
C184 J50-T271
C115
T247
T285 C100
PV05
SV50
T255
T406
SV64
PS1
T317
C160 SV24
SV18
SV16-50kPa SV16-N40kPa
C159
RE T
SV17
C104 T254 C108 T253
120KPa T280
J51-T276-J53
C158
WNB
SV16
F D FN染料袋
T201
C103
T252
T270
SV61
PS5 T316
T257
OPEN C102
T251 SV60
PS6
C73
DP01 DP11 20uL
F D FD染料袋
T200
T256
OPEN
C141
SV62
C74
DI FF
DP10 20uL
FR FR染料袋
T199
P22-J42
P21-J41
DP02 DP9 20uL
SV26 J46-T217-J47
T218
SV58
SV57
OPEN
P17
P23-J43
SV56
J36-T203-P14
P15
J40-T207-P20 J37-T204-P16
C142
OPEN
P13 J35-T202-P12
LD
P1
J38-T205-P18 J39-T206-P19
Fluidics System
42.8~59.7s: as shown in the figure below The RBC channel measurement completes; drain the RBC bath, and wash the RBC bath twice (with 2.0mL diluent each time); With the corporate efforts of SV36, PV01 and PV03, the sample in the DIFF bath gets to the inlet of the three-way connector of the flow cell; open SV70 to form sheath flow; With the help of SV33, the SP_SYRINGE sample syringe pushes the DIFF sample located in the sample preparation tubing into the optical analysis area of the flow cell for the measurement; Drain the DIFF bath; open SV71 and PV03 to dispense about 1.5ml diluent into the DIFF bath; the DIFF bath gets ready for analysis; Open SV71, SV36 and PV01 to clean the optical analysis sample preparation channel; Other auxiliary actions: Prime the FCM cistern with diluent from the diluent container through the DIL_SYRINGE syringe; Prime the DIL cistern through the DIL vacuum; Drain WC1 to the waste container; DIFF channel measurement completes. 9.0
SV41
T124
C66 T135
WC1-B
C165
7-28
CV07
SV47
T33
T32
C29 T35 C11 T38
C30 T39
T11
T15
T12
T16 T17
T13 T14
T18 T54
DP8 8mL
SV67
WC2-S
WC2-C
OPEN
DT LH
T43
Waste Container
SV49
T41 T42 SV34 LN
C36
T73
PV05/SV50
FCM-90kPa
C35
T53
SV48
C21 T19
T36
C16
C12
C17
C13
C18 C19
C14
C20
C15
C1 C6
C2 C7
C3 C8
T5
SV46 C33
T44
T31 C50
P7-T4-P8
T34
C34
T113 WCT
P5-T3-P6
T25
T28
T29
T30
CV06
T26
V66-50kPa
SV45 SV09
T20
PUMP_WASTE T353
C4 C9
C5 C10 T10
C65
SV72 T45
P3
T361 C22
T21
C143 T346
T352
C25
C157
C144
T351 C147
LH T360
C23
C24
T345 C146 T350
DIL reagent container
C47 WC2-C
WC1-VC
P2
WC1-RC
C58
T96
T95
T97
LF2
T134
T118
T111
C164
C156 LN
T359
T370
LF1
T338
T344 CV04
WC2
T9 LH reagent container
T133 SV35
SV05
DIL-V40
J11-T144-J12-P11
T48 T49 SV69
T52
T339 T343 CV03 C26
C161
C145 T349
P3-T2-P4 T7 LD reagent container
C163 T372
C57
T50
T51 C38
DIL
ICF1
DIL_SYRINGE
T132
WC1-H
SV40 J2-T92-J3
T409
DP4 0.5mL
T47 T55
SV01
C134
T91
SV68
C40 SV73
T392
T337
C135
T390 C152 C151 T391 T386 T356 T357 T387
C155
T22
C137
T331
C150 T355
LD T358
C177
T59 T58
T56
T340 T342 CV02 C27
T389 T385
DR T46 C46 T110
T396
T57
C37 T138 DP5 C70 1.5mL SV11
SV09-50kPa
C51
SV29 VCN30KPa 180mL
SV12 SV12-50kPa OPEN
T90
SV32
T100 DP6 2.0mL
SV12-50kPa OPEN
ASP_SYRINGE
J61-T85-J62
PWD
DIL-CL
T74
10mL
T62
T224 T211
SV28 T210
T354 C154
DIL
SV23
C69
T130
C28
C149
T388
LF3
C68
CV05
T384
C41 T64 T61 C176 T60T395
C136
T341 CV01
SV66
FCM
T336
T335
T289
T63
HGB
C64 RBC
C174 C138
T332
C56
T84
T383 T347 T348
T112
C133 T114
T330 C139
WC1
T8 LN reagent container
T243
T245
T244
T246 LH-1
LF4
C49
TC T397 C178
C175 T394
LD
T127 C62
C95 T168 T177
C39 SV30
SV04
T393 ICF2
T334
C63 T129
TS1 C45
LPS T76
C125
C153
T333
DIL-V40
T140
VC
T77 T82
SV09-50kPaT300
WC1-B
SV52
C61
C132 T363
T315
C140
DR
T125 C60
C59
T69
RH1HGB T128
C48
C83 DIL
PS4 SV02
T89
10mL
C42
T65
T68
SV55
VC
FCM1
T178
LH
C43
T102
T410
SV18-50kPa
C124
T295 SV08-50kPa T299
T147 SV20
WC1-N WC1-H WC1-D WC1-R WC1-VC WC1-S
T115 SV03
T294
C130 T306
SV17-50kPa T364
C98
C44
SV16-50kPa T314
RH1 -CL
T179 C96
T329
WC1-O WC1-RC
T116 T117
C123
PV01
SV74
C118
V66-50kPa
C122
SV07-50kPa T298
T305 SV14-50kPa T312
T269
T293
C129
SV13-50kPa T311
C113
T288
T292 SV05-50kPa T296
T304
C112 T323
LH-1
T362
J8-T126
T186
Piercing manifold
C188
T227
C67
T198
T328
FCM2
C171
T327
SV17-N40kPa SV18-N40kPa
J27-T185-J28
C52
T93 T94 C187
SV71
T229
T70
WC1-R
T194
SV16-N40kPa
FCM1
SV38
C94
V67-50kPa
PV02
SV75
T262 OPEN
C121
SV06-50kPa T297
C128
SV12-50kPa T310
FCM-90kPa
T380
C93
T228
T180
RH1RBC
SV39
C111
DIL-CL
C169
T184 C97
T66
C55
C110 T321
T209
SV22
SP_SYRINGE
WC1-S
SV43
PV07/SV78
T67
T88
SV06-50kPa
T399 SV31
SV53
T326
V66-N40kPa
PV04/SV77
PV03/SV76
SV44
C99
T235
T87
T325
SV04-N40kPa
T301
C126 SV01-50kPa T308 T302 SV11-50kPa T309 C127 T303
C92
C91
C181
SV37 T382 C180 C173
SV54
T320 SV03-N40kPa
SV07-50kPa
T279
T322
C90
T381
J48-T234-J49
SV07
C172
SV05-50kPa
WC1-O
C89
C170
OPEN
WC2-S
C88
C168
WC1-N
T167
C87
WC1-D
T375 SV36 C166
T176
J33-T195-J34-P26
T159 T197 C179 T398
T158
C86 C182
J66-T400-J67
T162
C109
T324
SV06 PV01/SV74
C85 C183 J21-T166-J22
C167
T161
SV66-N40kPa SV08-50kPa
OPEN
SV04-N40kPa
FCM2
FC
PV02/SV75
T181 T169
SV70
T290
C120
SV13 SV08
C80
T242
SV33
J31-T191-J32-P25
C79
OPEN SV67-50kPa
SV21 RH1 -SH
PV03
T268
V03-N40kPa
50KPa
90KPa
N40KPa
C186 T366 Positive pressure waste
GC-90KPa 600mL
T365 C114
SV63
C117 OPEN SV13-50kPa
T265
C107 T250
SV14-50kPa
T221
C72
J29-T187-J30-P24
T208 C71
T213
T318 GC-N40KPa 600mL T319
OPEN
PV06/SV51
T222
T230
SV14
PV04
T267 SV76
P1-T1-P2 T6 DR reagent container
C77
DP3 1.0mL
SV01-50kPa
C76
DP2 0.5mL
T266
OPEN
T261
T23
C75
DP1 0.5mL
GC-50KPa T287 600mL
SV77
T264
T282
T291
RH 3
OPEN
T260 C106
CV08
RET
RH 2
T263
C105
C116
C119
PV07
SV78
OPEN
T283
PS2
T278
C78 C84 J54-T240-J55 C148
C81
PN
LN
DR
T219
T272
T274
T27
SV18-50kPa SV18-N40kPa
SV17-50kPa SV17-N40kPa
T225
DIFF
RH 2
T248
GC-120KPa 600mL
PV06
SV51 T408
T259
J52-T281
T24
WNB
T286
SV27
T258 OPEN T407
SV65 PS3
C101
T284 SV25
PV05
SV50
T255
T406 C184
J50-T271
C115
T247
T317
C160
J25-T182-J26 C82 T183
C53
PS5
SV24
SV18
SV16-50kPa SV16-N40kPa
C159
RE T
SV17
T280 SV64
PS1 J51-T276-J53
C158
WNB
SV16
C104 T254 C108 T253
120KPa
T270
SV61
T285 C100
T257
OPEN C103
T252
SV60
T316
F D FN DYE bag
T201
T256 C102
T251
C141 PS6
C73
DP01 DP11 20uL
F D FD DYE bag
T200
C142
OPEN
SV62
C74
DI FF
DP10 20uL
FR FR DYE bag
T199
P22-J42
P21-J41
DP02 DP9 20uL
SV26 J46-T217-J47
T218
SV58
SV57
OPEN
P17
P23-J43
SV56
J36-T203-P14
P15
J40-T207-P20 J37-T204-P16
OPEN
P13 J35-T202-P12
LD
P1
J38-T205-P18 J39-T206-P19
Fluidics System
60~75.7s: as shown in the figure below With the corporate efforts of SV36, PV07 and PV04, the sample in the RET bath gets to the inlet of the three-way connector of the flow cell; open SV70 to form sheath flow; With the help of SV33, the SP_SYRINGE sample syringe pushes the RET sample located in the sample preparation tubing into the optical analysis area of the flow cell for the measurement; Drain the RET bath; open SV71 and PV04 to dispense about 2.6ml diluent into the RET bath. The RET bath gets ready for analysis; Open SV71, SV36 and PV07 to clean the optical analysis sample preparation channel; Other auxiliary actions: Prime the FCM cistern with diluent from the diluent container through the DIL_SYRINGE syringe; Prime the DIL cistern through the DIL vacuum; Drain WC1 to the waste container; The RET channel measurement completes. 9.0
T124
C65
WC1-B
V03-N40kPa
CV07
T34
SV46 C33
SV47
T33
T32
T44 C34
SV48 T73
T54
DP8 8mL
SV67
C165
WC2-S
OPEN
Waste Container
SV49 DT
LH
T43
PV05/SV50
C21 T19
T41
C29 T35 C11 T38
C30 T39
T11
T15
LN
C36
T31 C50
T42 SV34
T12
T16
LD
C35
T53
T113 WCT
T17
T13 T14
T36
C16
C12
C17
C13
C18 C19
C14
C20
C15
C1 C6
C2 C7
C3 C8
T5
T28
T25
T30
CV06
T26
T29
T20
PUMP_WASTE T353
P7-T4-P8
SV72 T45
P3
T361 C22
T21
C143 T346
T352
C25
C157
C144
P5-T3-P6
V66-N40kPa
V66-50kPa
SV45 SV09
C23
C24
T345 C146 T350
LH T360
T370
T351 C147
T18
DIL
C164
T48 T49 SV69
T52
C156 LN
T359
WC2
C145 T349
LF1
T338
T344 CV04
T390 C152 C151 T391 T386 T356 T357 T387
C155
T22
SV01
C150 T355
LD T358
DIL-V40
LH-1
LH
T50
T339 T343 CV03 C26
C161
C4 C9
C5 C10 DIL reagent container
C66 T135 WC1-VC
SV41
SV05-50kPa
C47 WC2-C
P2
WC1-RC
C58
T96
T95
T97
LF2
T134
T118
T111
10mL
FCM1
DIL-CL
FCM2
T133 SV35
SV05
DIL-V40
C57
J11-T144-J12-P11
DIL_SYRINGE
C163 T372
T47 T55
T51
C133 T114
T392 C134
C56
T84
T383 T347 T348
T112
T337
C135
T91
SV68
C40
C38
T340 T342 CV02 C27
C137
T331
WC1
T10
T409
DP4 0.5mL
T132 ICF1
C154
SV73 C37
T138 DP5 C70 1.5mL SV11
T336
T389 T385
DR
C177
T59 T58
T56
C28
C149 T354
T46 C46 T110
WC1-H
SV40 J2-T92-J3
SV29 VCN30KPa 180mL
SV09-50kPa
C51
SV32
CV01 T388
DIL
T396
T57
C138
T332 C136
T341
T384
C41 T64 T61 C176 T60T395
T62
T224 T211
SV28 T210
C139
T333
CV05
SV23
C69
SV12 SV12-50kPa OPEN
T90
T393 ICF2
C174
SV66
FCM
TC T397 C178
C175
T330
LF3
T130
T100 DP6 2.0mL
SV04
T394
T335
T289
T63
C68
SV12-50kPa OPEN
ASP_SYRINGE
J61-T85-J62
PWD
DIL-CL
T74
SV39
10mL
LF4
C49
HGB
C64
C125
C153
T334
C63 T129
SV30 RBC
C55
VC
T127 C62
C95 T168 T177
C39 C45
LPS T76
T410
T140
VC TS1
T82
SV09-50kPaT300
WC1-B
SV52 T77
C83 DIL
T69
RH1HGB
C61
C132 T363
T315
C140
DR
T125 C60
C59
J8-T126
T89
C188
C42 PS4
T128
C48
SV55
T93 T94 C187
FCM1
T178
SV02
T102
C124
T295 SV08-50kPa T299
T147
T65
T68
RH1RBC
Piercing manifold C52
T88
SV18-50kPa
WC1-H WC1-D WC1-R WC1-VC WC1-S
T115 SV03 T116 T117
C123
T294
C130 T306
SV17-50kPa T364
SV20
C43
T66
SV16-50kPa T314
RH1 -CL
T179 C96
T329
WC1-N
C118
V66-50kPa
C122
SV07-50kPa T298
T305 SV14-50kPa T312
WC1-O WC1-RC
T293
C129
SV13-50kPa T311
C113
T288
T292 SV05-50kPa T296 SV06-50kPa T297
T304
C112
LH-1
T362
T180
C44
C128
T323
C98
T67
C127 T303
SV12-50kPa T310
PV01
SV74
T9 LH reagent container
T227
J27-T185-J28 T186
T328
SV18-N40kPa
C67
T198 WC1-R
C171
FCM-90kPa
PV04/SV77
PV03/SV76
T184 C97
T327
SV17-N40kPa
C126 T302
SV11-50kPa T309
V67-50kPa
C121
P3-T2-P4 T7 LD reagent container
SV71
T229
SV22
SP_SYRINGE
WC1-S
T194
PV07/SV78
SV16-N40kPa
SV01-50kPa T308
T269
T8 LN reagent container
T243
T245
T244
T246
C94
FCM-90kPa
T402
SV38
OPEN
WC1-O
T380
WC1-D
WC2-S
SV43 C169
SV31
T235
SV53
C111
T301
C92
C91 SV44
C99
SV37 T382 C180 C173
T87
C110 T321
T326
T209 C93
C89
C170
T399
SV54
T325
SV04-N40kPa
T320
SV06-50kPa
C88
C168
T228
C181
SV03-N40kPa SV07-50kPa
T279
T322
C90 C87
WC1-N
T176
SV07
T158
C86 C182
T375 SV36 C166
T167
J33-T195-J34-P26
SV06 PV01/SV74
C85 C183 J21-T166-J22
C167
T161
C109
T262
SV04-N40kPa
FCM2
FC
PV02/SV75
T181 T169
SV70
T290
C120 T324
SV66-N40kPa SV08-50kPa
PV02
SV75
OPEN
SV13 SV08
C80
T242
SV33
J31-T191-J32-P25
C79
OPEN SV67-50kPa
SV21 RH1 -SH
T268
OPEN
WC2-C
50KPa
90KPa
C72
J29-T187-J30-P24
C117 OPEN SV13-50kPa
T221
C186 T366 Positive pressure waste
GC-90KPa 600mL
T365 C114
PV03
SV76 T265
C107 T250 SV63
N40KPa
T213
T318 GC-N40KPa 600mL T319
OPEN SV14-50kPa
PV06/SV51
T222
T230
SV14 T208 C71
PV04
T267
P1-T1-P2 T6 DR reagent container
C77
DP3 1.0mL
T266 SV77
T264 OPEN
T261
SV01-50kPa
C76
DP2 0.5mL
GC-50KPa T287 600mL
T23
C75
DP1 0.5mL
T263 OPEN
T282
T291
RH 3
T260 C106
CV08
RET
RH 2
C105
C116
C119
PV07
SV78
OPEN
T283
PS2
T278
C78 C84 J54-T240-J55 C148
C81
PN
LN
DR
T219
T272
T274
T27
SV18-50kPa SV18-N40kPa
SV17-50kPa SV17-N40kPa
T225
DIFF
RH 2
T248
GC-120KPa 600mL
PV06
SV51 T408
T259
J52-T281
T24
WNB
T286
SV27
T258 OPEN T407
SV65 PS3
C101
T284 SV25
PV05
SV50
T255
T406 C184
J50-T271
C115
T247
T317
C160
J25-T182-J26 C82 T183
C53
PS5
SV24
SV18
SV16-50kPa SV16-N40kPa
C159
RE T
SV17
T280 SV64
PS1 J51-T276-J53
C158
WNB
SV16
C104 T254 C108 T253
120KPa
T270
SV61
T285 C100
T257
OPEN C103
T252
SV60
T316
F D FN DYE bag
T201
T256 C102
T251
C141 PS6
C73
DP01 DP11 20uL
F D FD DYE bag
T200
C142
OPEN
SV62
C74
DI FF
DP10 20uL
FR FR DYE bag
T199
P22-J42
P21-J41
DP02 DP9 20uL
SV26 J46-T217-J47
T218
SV58
SV57
OPEN
P17
P23-J43
SV56
J36-T203-P14
P15
J40-T207-P20 J37-T204-P16
OPEN
P13 J35-T202-P12
LD
P1
J38-T205-P18 J39-T206-P19
7.11.2 CT-micro-WB Analysis Sequences The process of the CT-micro-WB analysis is almost the same as that of the CT-WB analysis; The differences between the two modes are: 1. the piercing action is not required for the microWB mode, and the building and balancing vacuum actions (which are related with tube piercing) are also canceled; 2. the dilution ratio and analysis time of the micro-WB mode are different from the WB mode.
7-29
Fluidics System
7.11.3 CT-PD Analysis Sequences The process of the CT-PD analysis is almost the same as that of the CT-WB analysis; The differences between the two modes are: 1. The piercing action is not required for the PD mode, he piercing action is not required for the micro-WB mode, and the building and balancing vacuum actions (which are related with tube piercing) are also canceled; 2. The dilution ratio and analysis time of the PD mode are different from the WB mode; 3. The sample in the PD mode is manually diluted in a certain proportion, and the sample in the whole blood mode is the venous blood without the dilution.
7.11.4 Autoloading Whole-Blood Analysis Sequences You can achieve automatic batch analyses of blood samples by using the autoloading presentation mode, which includes transporting and feeding of tube racks, tube grabbing, automatic aspiration of sample, etc.; Except the differences in the bulk tube delivery, tube loading, and auto mixing, the AL-WB measurement procedure is identical to the CT-WB measurement procedure.
7-30
Fluidics System
7.12 Fluidics Diagram The following are the fluidics diagram and assemblies involved: 1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
MRSZ/R05N01.291.02(4.0)
V03-N40kPa
CV08
CV07
LN
T20
T73
T54
DP8 8mL
LH
C29 T35 C11 T38
C30 T39
T11
T15
T12
T16
LD
WC2-S
PV05/SV50
PV06/SV51
DT
LN
T43
Waste Container
SV49
T41
WC1-B
C36
DIL-V40
C35
T53
SV48
T17
T13 T14
SV67
C16
C12
C17
C13
C18 C19
C14
C20
C15
T36
C1 C6
C165 T146
C2 C7
C3 C8
T5
T32
C21
T19
C4 C9
C5 C10 T10
SV47
T33
T42 SV34
DR
T48 T49 SV69
SV46 C33
T44
T113
WCT
DIL reagent container
T34
C34
T31 C50
PUMP_WASTE T353
P7-T4-P8
SV72 T45
P3
T361 C22
T21
C143 T346
T352
P5-T3-P6
C23
C24
C144
T351 C147
LH T360
T359
T345 C146 T350
LF1
C25
C157
T370
T9 LH reagent container
T28
T25
C156
WC2
C145 T349
T338
T390 C152 C151 T391 T386 T356 T357 T387
LD
T22
C134 T344 CV04
C150 T355 C155
T358
SV01
T29
T30
CV06
T26
C135 T339 T343 CV03 C26
WC2-C
OPEN
SV01-50kPa
C133 T114
T392
T337
T18
T374 SV45 SV09
C136 T340 T342 CV02 C27
T84 C161
T348 T112
T23
FCM-90kPa
10mL
LH
LH-1
V66-N40kPa
V66-50kPa FCM1
FCM2
WC1-B
T336
C56
T383 T347
P3-T2-P4 T7 LD reagent container
C65
T47 T55
T52
C137
T331
T91
SV68
T50
C138
T332
T389 T385
DR
T46 C46 T110
C40
T51
T354 C154
SV73
C38
C28
C149
T388
C177
T59 T58
T56
C37 DP4 0.5mL T145
C164 J11-T144-J12-P11 T373
C66 T135
CV05
T384
T396
T57
T143
T138 DP5 C70 1.5mL SV11
WC1-VC
P2
T134 SV05-50kPa
SV41
WC1-RC
T97
T96
C47 WC2-C
T371 C162 T124
T62
T224 T211
SV28 T210
T137 SV29
T133 SV35
SV05 SV42 T118
T111
C69 T212
T341 CV01
SV23
C39
C163 T372
DIL-V40
C57 LF2
T393 ICF2
C139
T333
C31
WC1
T8 LN reagent container
J6-T122-J7-P10 T123 C54 T83
T394
C174
LF3 HGB
TC T397 C178
C175
T330
C41 T64 T61 C176 T60T395
T63
T132 T108
SV04
SV09-50kPaT300
T335
OPEN SV67-50kPa
VCN30KPa 180mL
T109
C125
T315
DIL
DIL
ICF1
C153
T289
FCM
DIL_SYRINGE
T121 C64 T130 T131
T107
SV17-50kPa T364
SV08-50kPa T299
WC1-H
C51
LF4
C49
SV09-50kPa
SV12
C124
T295
C132 T363
T334
WC1-H WC1-D WC1-R WC1-VC WC1-S
T115 SV03 T116 T117
C123
T294
SV16-50kPa T314
C140
WC1-N
C118
T288
C122
SV07-50kPa T298
C130 T306
PV01
WC1-O WC1-RC
T293
T305 SV14-50kPa T312
FCM-90kPa
DIL-CL
SP_SYRINGE
T90
C95 T168 T177
C68
T141
SV32
T236
T104
C121 T292
SV05-50kPa T296
SV06-50kPa T297
C129
SV13-50kPa T311
C113
SV66
C63 T129
T120
C128 T304
C112
T329
J9-T139-J10
T127 C62
T119
T100 DP6 2.0mL
T140
T136
SV12-50kPa OPEN
DIL-CL
RBC
C127 T303
SV12-50kPa T310
SV18-50kPa
DIL
T69
RH1HGB
C61
C126 T302
SV11-50kPa T309
T269 SV74
P1-T1-P2 T6 DR reagent container
T243
T245
T244
T246 OPEN
T369
J8-T126
C60
SV30
SV12-50kPa OPEN
10mL
J61-T85-J62
ASP_SYRINGE
VC
WC1-R OPEN
T125
J4-T101-J5
SV01-50kPa T308
T323
C83
C42 PS4
T105
T80-P9
FCM1
T178
T128
C48
T290
T147
SV20 T179
T106
C58
F
T362
VC
T74
T95
T328
SV18-N40kPa
T148
C67
TS1
SV40 J2-T92-J3
T327
SV17-N40kPa
RH1 -CL
SV02
C59
T99
T75
SV16-N40kPa
T301
LH-1
T65
T68
T103
C45
SV39
T409
T149
SV71 T227
C96
SV52
T82
C55
T410
T198
C43
RH1RBC
T77
C188
C171
C44
LPS T76
T93 T94 C187
C94 T150
C98
T89
PWD
C93 T151
T229
T70
T279
T322
C92
J27-T185-J28 T186
SV55
E
J13-T152-J14 T228
T180
T102
T88
SV38
T380
T194
T184 C97
T98
SV53
C111
T209
T381
WC1-D
T405
WC1-S
C169
T190
C52
PN
PV04/SV77
PV03/SV76
PV02/SV75
SV43
T378
T66
T87
C110 T321
T326
T320
SV06-50kPa
SV22
T67
SV54
T325
SV04-N40kPa
SV07-50kPa
T399
SV31 T401 PV07/SV78 SV37 T382 C180 J15-T163-J16 C173
穿刺汇流板
C53
SV07
C90
T153 C172
C89
C91 SV44
C99
T235
D
SV03-N40kPa
SV08-50kPa
J33-T195-J34-P26
T159 T197 C179 T398
T154 C170 T379
C88
WC1-N
WC2-S
T155 C168 T377
C87
J17-T164-J18
J48-T234-J49
WC1-O
T176
T156
J68-T404-J69 C181 T403
T375 SV36 C166 T167
T162
C109
PV02
SV75
T262 OPEN
C120 T324
SV66-N40kPa
SV06 T193
T158
T157
C86
SV33
正压废液
SV13
C80 T161
T189
PV01/SV74
C85
T402
J23-T175-J24
T376
C114
SV63
C117
OPEN SV13-50kPa
T268
OPEN
SV04-N40kPa
FCM2
FC
C167
SV14-50kPa
SV08
T160 T181
J66-T400-J67
T208 C71
T265
C186 T366
GC-90KPa 600mL
T365
PV03
SV76
C107 T250
T267
OPEN
T261
50KPa
RH1 -SH
J19-T165-J20 C182
T213
T318 GC-N40KPa 600mL T319
OPEN
T221
C72
J31-T191-J32-P25
C79
T169
SV70
T173
C
SV21
T172
C183
T222
T230
T196
SV14
90KPa
T171
DP3 1.0mL
PV04
SV77
T264
T282 GC-50KPa T287 600mL
T266
OPEN
T260 C106
C78
T170
T242
J21-T166-J22
DP2 0.5mL
T263
C105
C116
C119
T274
N40KPa
T174 C81
DP1 0.5mL
J29-T187-J30-P24
C84
J54-T240-J55 C148 J56-T241-J57
T283
PS2
T278 GC-120KPa 600mL
T214
T291
RH 3
T233 C77
T192
T272
SV27
T223
PV07
SV78
OPEN
T284 SV25 T231
T408
T259
J52-T281
PV06
SV51
T407
SV65 PS3
T27
J60-T239-P29
T226 C76
T188
J50-T271
C115 C101
T248
T258 OPEN
C184
J51-T276-J53 T247
T285 C100
T286
PV05
SV50
T255
T406
SV64
T317 T232 SV24
J25-T182-J26 C82 T183
LN
DR
T220 C75
B
T368
J59-T238-P28
T367
T219
C104 T254 C108 T253
120KPa T280
PS1
PS5
C160
RET
RH 2
C103
T252
T270 SV60
PS6
T257
OPEN C102
T251 SV61
T24
SV18-50kPa SV18-N40kPa
SV17-50kPa SV17-N40kPa
SV16-50kPa SV16-N40kPa
DIFF
RH 2
T225
RE T
WNB
SV18
C159
DI FF
SV17
WNB
SV16
C158
T256
OPEN
C141
T316
F D FN染料袋
T201
C142
SV62
T215
C73
DP01 DP11 20uL
F D FD染料袋
T200
J44-T216-J45
C74
J58-T237-P27
P22-J42
P21-J41
DP10 20uL
FR
FR染料袋
T199
SV26 J46-T217-J47
T218
SV58
SV57
DP02 DP9 20uL
P17
P23-J43
SV56
J36-T203-P14
P15
J40-T207-P20 J37-T204-P16
OPEN
P13 J35-T202-P12
LD
P1
J38-T205-P18 J39-T206-P19
A
保密:此图及其全部知识产权(含著作权)归深圳迈瑞生物医疗电子股份有限公司所有。未经深圳迈瑞生物医疗电子股份有限公司预先书面许可,严禁出于任何目的,对此图的全部或部分内容(包括但不限于图中信息、数据、运算结果等)泄露、使用、拷贝或复制。 Classified documents, This set of drawing(s) and all it's intellectual property rights (including copyright) subsisting herein are property of Shenzhen Mindray Bio-medical Electronics Co.,Ltd. No disclosure,use,copies or reproductions should be made of this drawing or any part(s) thereof for whatever purpose nor shall any information, data, calculations, or other contents contained in this drawing be disseminated without prior written permission of Shenzhen Mindray Bio-medical Electronics Co.,Ltd
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
MRSZ/R05N01.291.02(3.0)
A
B
C
D
E
保密密级:机密 CONFIDENTIAL
F
TITLE 保密:此图及其全部知识产权(含著作权)归深圳迈瑞生物医疗电子股份有限公司所有。未经深圳迈瑞生物医疗电子股份有限公司预先书面许可,严禁出于任何目的,对此图的全部或部分内容(包括但不限于图中信息、数据、运算结果等)泄露、使用、拷贝或复制。 Classified documents, This set of drawing(s) and all it's intellectual property rights (including copyright) subsisting herein are property of Shenzhen Mindray Bio-medical Electronics Co.,Ltd. No disclosure,use,copies or reproductions should be made of this drawing or any part(s) thereof for whatever purpose nor shall any information, data, calculations, or other contents contained in this drawing be disseminated without prior written permission of Shenzhen Mindray Bio-medical Electronics Co.,Ltd
7-31
DOC No.
BOM list of 3206 fluidics diagram A1-115-046144-00
3206 P.CODE SHEET 20 OF22
REV. SIZE
9.0
/ A3
Fluidics System 1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
MRSZ/R05N01.291.02(3.0)
A
B
C
D
E
保密密级:机密 CONFIDENTIAL TITLE
F
保密:此图及其全部知识产权(含著作权)归深圳迈瑞生物医疗电子股份有限公司所有。未经深圳迈瑞生物医疗电子股份有限公司预先书面许可,严禁出于任何目的,对此图的全部或部分内容(包括但不限于图中信息、数据、运算结果等)泄露、使用、拷贝或复制。 Classified documents, This set of drawing(s) and all it's intellectual property rights (including copyright) subsisting herein are property of Shenzhen Mindray Bio-medical Electronics Co.,Ltd. No disclosure,use,copies or reproductions should be made of this drawing or any part(s) thereof for whatever purpose nor shall any information, data, calculations, or other contents contained in this drawing be disseminated without prior written permission of Shenzhen Mindray Bio-medical Electronics Co.,Ltd
BOM list of 3206 fluidics diagram
DOC No.
A1-115-046144-00
3206 P.CODE SHEET 21 OF 22
REV.
9.0
SIZE
Change description Compared with last version
EIV012
(service manual. 2.0), this version of fluidic diagram (service manual 3.0) has the
following
change:
added a Y shape connector to WC2
This version fluidic diagram
EIV013
(service manual 4.0) has the following changes: Connector C64 is changed
EIV013
from a I-shape connector to a L-shape connector
7-32
/ A3
Fluidics System
New
tube
is
added
EIV013
PharMed,1/16"IDX3/16"OD
7.13 Check the Particle Flow Stability When necessary, check the particle flow stability by looking into the particle numbers in different test channels, the PU pressure trends, and the HGB global voltage. On the “Table Review” screen, tap to select the desired sample, and tap “Stability” to check the information.
Below information/graphs are provided: The
particle
numbers
counted in
the
Tap “Setup” to configure the variation limit
DIFF/WNB/RBC/PLT test channels 250kPa/160kPa/70kPa/-40kPa trend
/
HGB Global Trend
Tap “Setup” to configure the variation limit
7-33
Fluidics System
7-34
Chapter 8 Hardware System 8.1 Hardware System Overview The hardware system is a support system for the analyzer operation. It is also a parameter sensor drive and signal detection system, and mainly includes the following functions.
The hardware system provides a main control platform for the user end software, fluidics sequence, algorithm operation, which is the main control of the analyzer man-machine interaction and the whole system, and communicate with the PC;
The hardware system provides drive platforms and interfaces to drive the execution components such as motors, valves, pumps, to complete the test preparation of the sample collection, reaction, and delivery, and to monitor each state of the whole device during the execution process;
The hardware system provides drive and signal detection for the impedance bath, HGB sensor, optical system and other parameter sensors, obtains parameter signals then offers them to the algorithm to calculate the clinical parameters;
The hardware system provides the power supply for each module, board, and assembly;
The hardware system provides the wires for interconnection between modules, boards, and assemblies.
8.1.1 Functional block diagrams Temp. control system Heater Fan Temperature sensor
Thermal component drive and detection
Hardware system
System state monitoring
Fluidics system Valve Pump Air pressure sensor
Float sensor Hydraulic Sensor
Fluidic component drive and detection
Reagent detection
Auxiliary control embedded system platform
Signal acquisition digital processing
Dye detection
Main control embedded system platform Direct user input (key switch, touchscreen)
Direct user output (display, sound/light indication)
Data storage
Connection cable
Electromechanical system
Motor Photocoupler Micro-switch
Scanner
Motion mechanism drive and detection
Drive module
Main control module
Software System
Peripheral
Peripheral interface
USB device PC
Sensor Optical System
Optical detection principle
Count bath
Impedance detection principle
Colorimetric bath
Colorimetric detection principle
Power switch
Signal conditioning
Power conversion
Power module
Analog module
Grid power input
Figure 8-1 Functional block diagram of the hardware system
8-1
Grid power
Hardware System
8.1.2 Electrical Connection Block Diagram and the Positions in Analyzer Rotary sca nning motor(M2)
J15 J16
Autoloa der motor exte nsi on cab le 009-006 867-00
J14 Front cover Front cover detection sensor(SEN22) 009-001 198-00 Front cover protective earth wire
Key board*2(K) 051-001 568-00
Hinge bracket
J1
J1 J
LCD display 021-000 084-00 Touchscre en con trol boa rd((S) 051-000 881-00
Touch screen 021-000 005-00 PC
J1
USB pan el 042-002 231-00
J1
Indicato r b oard(G) 051-001 240-00
J1
Optical system earth wire 009-001 248-00
J13
J11
J19
P1
J38 J35/ J37
J20
Indicato r b oard connection ca ble 009-006 773-00
Optical system side co ver
J16 J50 J22 J33 J48
Syringe ea rth wire 009-002 604-00 J32
J1
Fluorescent prea mp lification boa rd(N) 051-002 783-00
Optical system base plate
Main co ntr ol b oard asse mb ly(A) 115-042 843-00
J PD board 1 051-002 814-00 J PD board 1 051-002 814-00
310 7 high an gle PD signal cable 009-002 608-00 Optical PD connection ca ble 200 9-006 809-00 Laser connection cable 310 1-21-685 93
Laser
J6 J1
J4 Optical sig nal boa rd(Q) 051-002 779-00
J4
Optical system signal cable 009-006 806-00
J3
Main co ntr ol b oard and drive boar d conn ection cable 009-006 767-00
J35
Drive b oard(C) 051-002 835-00
Laser control(L) 051-002 849-00
J42
J43 J2 J44
Laser control board connection ca ble 009-006 807-00
J2
J45
J3
J46 J51
Scanne r
Optical system NTC tempe ratu re sen sor OP T NTC temperature sensor connection cable 1 NTC te mp erature se nso r (ana lyzer te mp erature ENV, 009-006789-00 preh eating bath P RE, flow cell CELL) NTC temperature sensor connection cable 2 009-006790-00
Hyd raulic sen sor conne ction cable 009-006 793-00 Floater con nectio n cable 1 009-006 791-00
Floater con nectio n cable 2 009-006 792-00
NTC te mp erature se nso r (RBC ba th inle t diluen t RBC, DIFF b ath, RET ba th) Hyd raulic sen sor LP S Floater(WC1\WC2\LH\LD\LN\DR) Floater(DIL\FCM\N40\90KPa) Pump connection ca ble Waste container floater BNC 310 1-20-685 92
Ana log board power cable 009-006 764-00
J3
Ignition power board (R) J2 051-002 708-00
Power filte r 006-000 394-00 Power cable 002 0-20-125 22
Grounding
Switch M07-000 61S---
J2 J1 Ignition power boa rd 24V isolated inpu t ca ble power boa rd(T1) 009-007 339-00
24V power module 022-000 200-00
24V powe r module input c able 009-006 758-00 24V power module ea rth wire Power supply 009-006 759-00 assemb ly
24V power output cab le 009-006 755-00
J2
J3
Syringe motor and samp ling horizontal motor conn ection cable 009-006 781-00 Syringe motor co nnectio n cabl e 009-006 782-00 Mix assembly motor connection cable 009-006777-00 Mix mechanism sensor connection cable 009-006778-00
J4
Power conversion boa rd(D) 051-002 640-00
J6 J7
Fan co nnectio n cabl e 009-007 341-00
J12
Pump control cab le 009-008 077-00
J1
J5
J7
J8
Valve drive boa rd(F1) 051-002 805-00
J2 J4
Mix assembly cable 009-006 130-00
Syringe ea rth wire (*3) 009-002 604-00
Mix assembly shift moto r (M9), lift moto r (M10), mix motor (M11)
Mix assembly sensor (SEN4\SNE5\SEN6\SEN7\SEN8) Heater (preh eating bath PRE, DIFF b ath, RET ba th) Optical system(OPT)
Optical system earth wire(*3) 009-001 248-00
Fan
Air pump (P1_AIR), hydrau lic pump (P2_VAC, P3_WC)
Valve (14-channe l, V20V33)
Valve connection ca ble 2 009-006 799-00
Valve (18-channe l, V01V18)
J6
Valve connection ca ble 7 009-007 300-00
Valve (12-channe l, V34V45)
J1
J8
Valve connection ca ble 4 009-006 801-00
Valve (6-channe l, V46V51)
J3
Valve drive boa rd(F2) 051-002 805-00
J6
J5 J4 J2
J8
Figure 8-2 Connecting the Hardware System
8-2
Valve connection ca ble 1 009-006 798-00
Valve connection ca ble 3 009-006 800-00 Valve connection ca ble 5 009-006 802-00 Valve connection ca ble 6 009-007 299-00
Sampli ng assembly vertical motor(M7)
Syringe motor (100uL、250uL)
J3
J7
Valve drive board po we r cable 009-006 765-00
J11
Sampli ng motor sensor (SEN2\SEN3)
Sampli ng assembly horizontal mo tor(M8)
J34
J5
J9 J1
Valve drive board control cable 009-006796-00
J31
Ignition power ca ble 009-007 340-00
J1
J1
J3
Valve drive board serial connection cable 009-006 797-00
J11 J4
J28 Drive board analog power cable 009-006761-00
J9
J5
Autoloader board power cable 009-006762-00
HGB signal cable 009-006810-00
J2
Analog board control cable 009-006803-00 Analog board signal cable 009-006804-00
Drive board power digital power cable 009-006760-00
HGB se nsor
Ana log board(B) 051-002 815-00
Main co ntr ol b oard power cable 009-006 763-00
J10
Sampli ng assemb ly cable 009-006 779-00
Sampli ng assembly vertical mo tor connection ca ble009-006 780-00
J7
24V isolated power boa rd i nput cable 009-008 212-00
RBC signal cable 009-006811-00
Syringe motor se nso r(10ML、 100uL、250uL) Horizontal mo tor home position se nso r SEN1
Syringe an d samplin g motor se nsor connection ca ble 009-006 783-00
Heating co nnecti on cab le 009-006 786-00
J9
RBC count bath
Rotary sca nning compressi on mo tor(M1)
Scanne r e xtension cable 009-007 671-00
J8
J1
Micro switch(SW1\SW2)
Syringe motor (10mL)
J5
J2
J1
J8
Optical system control cab le 009-006 805-00
J3 PMT signal cable 009-006 815-00
Compression me cha nism connection cable 009-007 303-00
Liqu id dete ction boa rd Air-pressure detectio n connection ca ble boa rd con nection cable 009-006 794-00 009-006 795-00 DIFF a nd NRBC Dye se nso r conn ection cable J40 J29 Dye de tection se nso r(FD、FN) J18 009-006 784-00 Dye an d b lood sa mp le sen sor conne ction ca ble J19 Dye de tection se nso r(FR) 009-006 785-00
J24
USB cable 009-006 776-00
Autoloa der
sensor(SEN12-SEN20)
Air-pressure Liqu id dete ction boa rd(I) detectio n b oard(G) 051-000 565-00 051-000 507-00 J1 J1
J40
Touchscreen control board connection cable 009-006768-00 Network extension cable 009-002561-00
Sample compartment motor (M4)
J20
J21
Disp lay ba cklight connection ca ble 009-006 770-00
J17
Main co ntr ol b oard and autoloa der board conne ction cable 009-006 766-00
NTC temperature sensor Optical system hea ting membran e Micro-switch Micro switch connection ca ble 310 0-20-490 40
Optical assembly Front optical assemb ly
SSD hard disk signal cable 009-006771-00 Display signal connection cable 009-006769-00
J1
Mini netwo rk boa rd(H) 051-001 122-00
USB device
J14
Loa ding moto r (M5), feeding motor (M6) Unload ing mo tor (M3)
Tube fi xing de tection se nso r(SEN21)
J20
SSD hard disk power cable 009-006772-00
J
J7
J8
J18
Key micro switch connection cable 009-006774-00
J
SSD hard di sk 023-001 356-00
Autoloa der board(E) 051-002 829-00
Front cover se nsor connection ca ble 009-007 320-00
Autoloa der se nso r e xtension cable 009-006 866-00
Autoloa der motor connection ca ble 009-006 869-00 Autoloa der se nso r connection ca ble 009-006 868-00
Valve (7-channe l, V52V58) Valve (10-channe l, V60V69) Valve (10-channe l, V70V79)
Hardware System
Figure 8-3 Position of top boards
Figure 8-4 Position of front and left boards
8-3
Hardware System
Figure 8-5 Position of internal boards
Figure 8-6 Position of optical system boards
8-4
Hardware System
Figure 8-7 Position of front cover boards
Figure 8-8 Power supply assembly
8-5
Hardware System
Table 8-1 Hardware system board ID
Board name
Function
1
115-042843-00
Provides USB, display and other peripheral interfaces;
Main
control
Analog/digital conversion of analog signals (signals of optical,
board and COME
RBC/PLT, HGB, etc., and state monitoring signals of laser power,
substrate
aperture voltage, etc.)
assembly
Detection of optical shielded box micro-switches, cover sensor, other digital switching values, and so on.
2
SSD hard disk
3
051-002805-00
Valve drives
Valve drive board
Control signals come from the drive board
(2) 4
051-002640-00
Converts the 24V power supply to P24V, P12V, D5V, analog +/-
Power conversion
12V, analog +5V and others for each board
board 5
051-002835-00
Drives motors, pumps, heating mechanisms, fans and other
3206 drive board
power components; Detects the temperature, pressure, hydraulic pressure, sensors, floats, etc.
6
051-002990-00
Inputs 24V, then outputs galvanic isolation 24V and provides it to
24V
the ignition power board
isolated
power board 7
051-002708-00 Ignition
Converts the 24V power to AC120V for count bath ignition
power
board 8
9
051-002815-00
Count bath drive and RBC/PLT signal detection, HGB sensor
3206
drive and HGB signal detection;
analog
board
Outputs the optical signal to the main control board
051-002829-00
Drives and detects the autoloader motor and sensor/micro
Autoloader board
switch; Scanner communication;
10
051-000565-00
Detects diluents, lyses and other reagents;
Liquid
Outputs the air pressure detection board signal to the drive board
detection
board 11
12
051-000507-00
Detects 4-channel positive pressure, 2-channel negative
Air
pressure;
pressure
detection board
Outputs the air pressure detection board signal to the drive board
051-001122-00
Transfers the network port, one end provides users with a
8-6
Hardware System
Mini
network
network port, and the other end connects the main control board
board 13
051-002849-00
Constant power drive of the laser;
Laser
Detection of the laser drive current, laser power;
control
board 14
15
051-002783-00
Fluorescence detection sensor (SiPM) drive, preamplification of
Fluorescence
FL signal, SiPM temperature detection;
preamplification
Outputs the fluorescence drive board signal to the optical signal
board
board
051-002779-00
I/V conversion, amplification, and conditioning of the FS signal
Optical
and SS signal;
signal
board
Post-amplification and conditioning of the fluorescence signal; Outputs the optical signal to the main control board
16
17
051-002814-00
Realizes the photoelectric conversion of the FS optical signal
PD
and SS optical signal respectively, and outputs the PD mounting
mounting
board (2)
board signal to the optical signal board
051-000881-00
Detects the resistive touch screen contact position
Touch
screen
control board 18
19
20
051-001568-00
Respectively detects [RUN] key button's on/off and mode switch
Key board (2)
key's on/off
051-001240-00
Provides the analyzer status indication and alarm function,
Indicator board
including the RGB tricolor indicator array and buzzer
022-000200-00
Converts 110/220VAC power to DC 24V output
24V
power
module
8-7
Hardware System
8.2 Main control board and COME substrate assembly (115-042843-00) 8.2.1 Overview The main control board and COME substrate assembly (115-042843-00) mainly include a main control board PCBA (051-002780-00) and a COME assembly (115-047188-00). The latter is inserted into the main control board slot through a board-to-board method, mainly performs the signal acquisition (A/D conversion), data processing, system control, status detection, peripheral connection, and user interaction functions.
8.2.2 Function
Provides sockets including USB port, network port, hard disk socket, display screen socket, touch screen socket, drive board serial interface communication and SPI socket, serial port communication socket of autoloader board, indicator board control socket, etc.;
Provides control sockets including impedance constant current source, ignition, HGB switch, laser switch, PMT voltage regulation, optical digital potentiometer adjustment and so on;
Provides the post-amplification and conditioning of optical signals, analog/digital conversion and digital processing of optical signals, impedance signals, HGB signals, and the pulse identification of optical signals;
Provides the analog-to-digital conversion of state signals (laser current, laser power, blank voltage, aperture voltage, PMT high voltage, PMT temperature, etc.)
Provides the detection of count key, mode switch key, optical shielded box micro-switches, cover 3-wire sensor and other digital switching values.
8-8
Hardware System
COME Module
mSATA socket
Analog board
ADC
Switch control socket
Drive board/ autoloader board
Communication serial port
SSD hard disk
Display screen control socket
LCD display
Touch screen control socket
Touch screen control board
IO socket
Indicator board
Switching value test
Key board(*2)
Touch screen
Mini network board
Main control board
PC
Peripheral socket USB socket*4
USB device Digital sensor
Switching value test
Micro-switch RFID card reader
RFID socket
Figure 8-9 Schematic diagram of the main control board function
8-9
Hardware System
8.2.3 Structure and Test Sockets J11
J8
J31
J
J
J16
J5
J4
J3 J18
J2
J1
J20
J21
J24
J40
Figure 8-10 Main control board socket Table 8-2 Main control board socket definition Position No. J1 J2
Socket function and definition Analog board RBC/HGB signal input socket, also includes aperture voltage signal Optical signal (FS/SS/FL) input socket, connects to the optical assembly internal board The laser control signal socket, provides power to the laser drive board
J3
and controls the laser switch, inputs the laser power signal and laser drive current signal
J4 J5
Optical signal board and fluorescence preamplification board control signal socket, mainly adjusts the signal of signal gains Analog board control signal socket, includes the constant current power switch, HGB LED switch, ignition switch
J8
Drive board socket
J11
Autoloader board socket 8-10
Hardware System
J16
Indicator board socket
J18
Cover sensor socket
J20
Key board socket
J21
Display screen control socket
J24
Touch screen socket
J31
Power socket (P12V/D5V)
J40
Display screen LED backlight socket Table 8-3 Definition of J1 analog board RBC/HGB signal input socket Pin
Signal characteristics RBC signal. The voltage is about 0.3V when measured with a multimeter
J1.3
under the standby condition
J1.7
Aperture voltage HGB signal. HGB voltage (V) displayed on the status screen = Voltage of this pin (V)*1.22*HGB gain.
J1.9
The voltage at this point is about 0.3V when the HGB signal cable is disconnected
J1.11
-5V
J1.12
+5V
J1.2/4/6
GND Table 8-4 Definition of J2 optical signal input socket
Pin J2.1 J2.3 J2.5 J2.9 J2.10 J2.12 J2.2/4/6/8
Signal characteristics FS signal. The voltage is about 83mV when measured with a multimeter under the standby condition SS signal. The voltage is about 83mV when measured with a multimeter under the standby condition FL signal. The voltage is about 83mV when measured with a multimeter under the standby condition FS blank voltage signal The voltage is about 0.1V under the normal condition PMT temperature signal PMT voltage. PMT voltage (V) displayed on the screen = Voltage of this pin (V)*12.66, which is about 1.5~2.4V under the normal condition. GND
8-11
Hardware System
Table 8-5 Definition of J3 laser control signal socket Pin
Signal characteristics Laser power monitoring voltage. The voltage is about 2V when the
J3.1
laser is on (automatically on when entering the voltage and current state screen), and is about 5.3V when the laser is off. Laser drive current monitoring voltage. The voltage is about 2.3V when
J3.2
the laser is on (automatically on when entering the voltage and current state screen), and is about 0V when the laser is off.
J3.3
GND
J3.4
+5V
J3.5
Laser switch control signal. Low level (0V) laser is on Table 8-6 J31 power socket definition
Position No.
Socket function and definition
J31.3
D5V. +4.75~5.25V
J31.4
D12V +11.5~12.5V
J31.1/2
GND
LED indicators Table 8-7 Main control board indicators Indicator position
Meaning
Normal status
D24
D5V power indicator
Green, steady on
D25
D12V power indicator
Green, steady on
D1
FPGA indicator
Green, blinking
Number
Figure 8-11 Main control board FPGA indicator 8-12
Hardware System
8.2.4 Troubleshooting Table 8-8 Troubleshooting of main control board Error
Cause
phenomenon
Troubleshooting
Power indicator
D5V/D12V power
See the "Power Module" section for
is off
supply failure
troubleshooting information.
Suspected crash,
no
response
from
the screen
Logic
error,
logic
or
burning
failed Network cable is
Network error
disconnected,
The FPGA indicator does not flash or is off. Analyzer restarts 1. Reconnect the network cable (including
or
COME module is
the mini network board) 2. Remove
failed Flickering screen,
blurred
screen
COME
module
and
reassemble it
Display cable is
Reconnect the display cable (including the
disconnected
display side)
Display cable is Display color is distorted
disconnected,
or
one of the control wires is broken, or
1. Reconnect the display cable (including the display side) 2. Replace the screen assembly
the screen is failed White screen (no
Display cable is
Reconnect the display cable (including the
content)
disconnected
display side)
1. SSD hard disk is full 2. Software failure
(such
as
time
sequence error) 3. Display Black screen
LED
backlight error, such as backlight wire disconnection ,
or
1. Empty SSD hard disk 2. Analyzer restarts 3. Reconnect the display backlight wire 4. Replace the screen assembly 5. Check the FPGA radiator
screen
failure 4. Overheat caused
by
FPGA radiator shedding 8-13
Hardware System
Flickering screen
The
(short
connection cable
black
key
board
screen) occurred
is
incorrectly
when you press
inserted into the
the count key or
touch
mode switch key
socket J24
screen
1. Touch Failed to control the touch screen
is open" alarm is reported
control cable is
(including the soft cable between the touch
disconnected
screen control board and touch screen)
2. COME module
2. Remove COME module and reassemble it 3. Replace the touch screen
Cover sensor is failed; wires are disconnected; control
The alarm is reported because it is detected that the front cover sensor is not blocked
board error
"Optical system
Micro switch in
shielding box is
the
open" alarm is
assembly
reported
incorrectly
continually
connected
System
time
error
after
startup
connector
1. Reconnect the touch screen control cable
Main
continually
consistent with that on the circuit board
screen
error "The front cover
1. Check whether the cable silk-screen is
optical is
Check the micro-switch connection in the optical assembly. Correctly insert the wire terminal into two separate pins (i.e., the middle pin is not connected). 1. Shut down and restart the analyzer after
Button used up
cell
is
the time calibration to see if the system time changes 2. Replace the button cell.
8-14
Hardware System
8.3 Drive board (051-002835-00) The drive board provides the drive for motors, valves, pumps, heating, fans etc., as well as the detection for the temperature, pressure, reagents, hydraulic pressure, sensor, floater, and micro-switches.
8.3.1 Function
8-channel stepping motor drive;
Nearly 80-channel valve control;
1- channel fan drive
3- channel pump drive
4- channel heating drive
Sensor detection;
Float switch detection;
Fluid switching value detection;
Fluorescent dye detection
Temperature detection
Liquid pressure detection Stepping motor (8channel) Pump (3-channel)
Power component drive
Heating (4-channel) Fan (1-channel)
Digital sensors (11channel) Micro-switch (4channel) Floater (10-channel)
Drive board
Main control board
Switching value test Fluid detection board
Serial port
Photocoupler sensor
Air-pressure detection board Pressure sensor
Reagent (5-channel) Positive pressure (3channel) Vacuum (2-channel)
Analog value test Hydraulic (1-channel) NTC temperature (7channel) Analog sensors (3channel)
SPI
Valve drive board
Valve drive
Valves (48-channel)
Valve drive board
Valve drive
Valves (48-channel)
Figure 8-12 Schematic diagram of the drive board function
8-15
Hardware System
8.3.2 Structure and Test Sockets J8
J9
J11/J12
J
J12 J
J18
J19 J
J20
J45
J44
J22
J50
J43
J42
J28
J51
J29
J12 J35 J40
J34
J32
J33
Figure 8-13 Drive board socket diagram 8-16
Hardware System
Table 8-9 Drive board socket definition Position No.
Socket function and definition
J8
Heating socket
J9
Power supply socket (P24V/P12V/D5V)
J11
System fan socket
J12
Pump socket
J18
Dye sensor socket (FD, FN)
J19
Dye Sensor socket (FR) Temperature sensor socket (optical, preheating bath, flow cell,
J20
analyzer temperature)
J50
Temperature sensor socket (WBC bath, RET bath, RBC diluent)
J22
Plugging detection hydraulic sensor socket
J28
Analog power socket (A+12V, A-12V)
J29
Air-pressure detection board socket
J48
Floater socket (DIL\FCM\N40)
J33
Floater socket (WC1\WC2\LH\LD\LN\DR)
J32
Sensor socket (10ML\100Ul\250uL\SEN1\SEN2\SEN3)
J51
Mix assembly sensor socket (SEN4\SNE5\SEN6\SEN7\SEN8)
J34
Valve drive board socket
J35
Main control board socket
J40
Liquid detection board socket
J42
Motor socket (vertical motor)
J43
Motor socket (horizontal motor/10ml syringe motor)
J44
Motor socket (100ul/250ul syringe motor) Motor socket (mix assembly shift motor (M9)/lift motor (M10)/mix
J45/J46
motor (M11)) Table 8-10 Drive board J9 power supply socket definition
Position No.
Socket function and definition
J9.1/2
P12V. +11.5~12.5V
J9.3
D5V. +4.75~5.25V
J9.4/5
P24V. +22.8~25.2V
J9.6/7/8/9/10
GND
Table 8-11 Drive board J28 analog power socket definition Position No.
Socket function and definition
J28.1
A+12V. +11.5~12.5V
J28.2
GND
J28.3
A-12V. -11.5~12.5V
8-17
Hardware System
LED indicators Table 8-12 Indicators on the drive board Indicator position
Meaning
Normal status
D16
P12V power indicator
Green, steady on
D17
P24V power indicator
Green, steady on
D18
A+12V power indicator
Green, steady on
D19
A-12V power indicator
Green, steady on
D22
A+5V power indicator
Green, steady on
D96
D5V power indicator
Green, steady on
D66
MCU indicator
Green, steady on
D65
MCU indicator
Green, blinking
D94
FPGA indicator
Green, blinking
number
Figure 8-14 Indicators on the drive board
8-18
Hardware System
8.3.3 Troubleshooting Table 8-13 Drive board troubleshooting Error
Cause
phenomenon External power
Troubleshooting
input indicator
(D16/17/18/19/9
External
input
power is in error
See the "Power Module" section for troubleshooting information.
6) off Intra-board conversion
Drive board A+5V
power
power failure
indicator
operation
Logic logic
Temperature out upper
alarm
or
burning
failed 1.
of
error,
limit
cable on the drive board. If the indicator is still off, the drive board is damaged.
(D22) off Abnormal motor
Unplug the signal cables except the power
The FPGA indicator does not flash or is off. Analyzer restarts
Temperature
sensor
cable
is
1. Check
disconnected/brok en 2.
the
connection
cable
and
reconnect it 2. Replace the temperature sensor or
Temperature
drive board
sensor failure
8-19
Hardware System
8.4 Analog board (051-002815-00) 8.4.1 Function The analog board provides the drive and signal detection for the count bath and HGB sensor.
Analog Board Count bath
Main Control Board ADC
Sensor drive Signal amplified conditioning
HGB sensor
Figure 8-15 Schematic diagram of the analog board function
8.4.2 Structure and Test Sockets
Figure 8-16 Analog board socket diagram Table 8-14 Analog board socket definition Position No. J1
Socket function and definition Laser control board power output socket. HGB LED is off when unplugged
8-20
Hardware System
Analog board control signal socket (HGB LED switch, constant current
J2
power switch, ignition switch)
J3
A+12V/A-12V/A+5V analog power input socket
J4
AC120V ignition power input socket
J7
Power output socket of optical signal board
J9
HGB sensor socket
J10
RBC sensor socket (in the shielding box)
J11
RBC/HGB signal output socket, connected to the main control board Table 8-15 Analog board J3-analog power input socket definitions
Position No.
Socket function and definition
J3.1
A+12V. +11.5~12.5V
J3.2
GND
J3.3
A+5V.+4.75~5.25V
J3.4
A-12V. -11.5~12.5V
Table 8-16 Analog board J1-laser control board power output socket definitions Position No.
Socket function and definition
J1.1
A+12V. +11.5~12.5V
J1.2
GND
J1.3
A-12V. -11.5~12.5V
Table 8-17 Analog board J7- optical signal board power output socket definitions Position No.
Socket function and definition
J7.1/5
A+12V. +11.5~12.5V
J7.2/4
A-12V. -11.5~12.5V
J7.3/6
GND
J7.7
A+5V. +4.75~5.25V
J7.8
A-5V. -4.75~5.25V Table 8-18 Analog board J11-RBC/HGB signal output socket definitions
Position No.
Socket function and definition
J11.2
HGB signal. The voltage is about 0.3V when the HGB LED is off
J11.6
RBC signal. The voltage is about 0.3 V in the standby status
J11.11
A-5V. -4.75~5.25V
J11.12
A+5V. +4.75~5.25V
J11.10
GND
8-21
Hardware System
LED indicators Table 8-19 Indicators on the analog board Indicator position
Meaning
Normal status
D8
A+12V power indicator
Green, steady on
D9
A-12V power indicator
Green, steady on
D10
A+5V power indicator
Green, steady on
D11
A-5V power indicator
Green, steady on
Number
Figure 8-17 LED indicators position on an analog board
8.4.3 Troubleshooting Table 8-20 Analog board troubleshooting Error
Cause
phenomenon External power
input indicator
(D8/9/10) off Conversion power
(in
the
board) indicator (D11) off
External
Troubleshooting input
power is in error Analog board A5V power is in error
See the "Power Module" section for troubleshooting information. Remove all the signal cables on the analog board except for the analog power line. If the indicator is still off, the analog board is damaged.
8-22
Hardware System
8.5 Autoloader Board (051-002829-00) The autoloader board completes driving of the related motor and scanner of automatic sampler, and detection of the sensor and micro-switch.
8.5.1 Function
Autoloader Motor drive
Main Control Board
Serial port
Stepping motor (6-channel) Digital photocoupler (10channel)
Digital value test
Micro-switch (2-channel) Analog value test
Autoloader board
Analog sensor (1-channel)
Serial port
Scanner
Figure 8-18 Function diagram of autoloader board
8.5.2 Structure and Test (1) Sockets
8-23
Hardware System
Figure 8-19 Interface diagram of autoloader board Table 8-21 Autoloader board sockets definitions Position No.
Socket function and definition Autoloader sensor and micro-switch sockets (SEN12-SEN21 and
J7/J8
SW1/SW2)
J14/J15/J16
Autoloader motor socket (M2/M3/M4/M5/M6) Autoloader
J17
motor
socket
(rotatory
scanning&compressing
motor(M1)) Serial port communication socket (connected to the main control
J19
board) P24V power input socket (P12V and D5V output sockets are also
J20
reserved)
P1
Scanner socket Table 8-22 Autoloader J20 power socket definitions
Position No.
Socket function and definition
J20.1
P24V. +22.8~25.2V input
J20.2
GND
J20.3
P12V. +11.5~12.5V
J20.5
D5V. +4.75~5.25V
(2) LED indicators
Figure 8-20 LED indicators positions on autoloader board Table 8-23 Autoloader indicators Indicator position
Meaning
Normal status
D5
P24V power indicator
Green, steady on
D8
P12V power indicator
Green, steady on
D9
D5V power indicator
Green, steady on
D20
MCU indicator
Green, blinking
D21
FPGA indicator
Green, blinking
Number
8-24
Hardware System
8.5.3 Troubleshooting Table 8-24 Troubleshooting autoloader board Error
Cause
phenomenon External power
input indicator
(D5) off
External
Troubleshooting input
power is in error
Intra-card conversion
P12V
power
power are in error
indicator
and
D5V
(D8/D9) off
See the "Power Module" section for troubleshooting information. Remove all the signal cables on the board except for the power cord. If the indicator is still off, the autoloader board is damaged.
MCU Autoloader motor operation exception
software/FPGA
The MCU software /FPGA indicator does
logic
not blink or is off.
or
abnormal MCU
software/FPGA
Restart the machine. If the problem can't be solved, replace the autoloader board.
logic burning fails
8-25
Hardware System
8.6 Valve Drive Board (051-002805-00) 8.6.1 Function The valve drive board controls multiple -valves. The 12V power for the drive board is supplied by the motherboard, and the control signals are from drive control board. Two valve drive boards are used in the instrument, which are exactly the same and are exchangeable during service.
Valve drive board (F1) Valve control socket
Control socket
Drive board
Valve Valve drive Valve
Valve drive board(F2) Valve control socket
Valve Valve drive Valve
Figure 8-21 Valve drive boards series connection diagram
8.6.2 Structure Valve connection cable 1 009-006798-00
Valves (14-channel, V20-V33)
J3
J2 J4 J6
Valve connection cable 2 009-006799-00 Valve connection cable 7 009-007300-00
Valves (18-channel, V01-V18) Valves (12-channel, V34-V45)
J1
J8
Valve connection cable 4 009-006801-00
Valves (6-channel, V46-V51)
J7
J6
Valve connection cable 3 009-006800-00 Valve connection cable 5 009-006802-00 Valve connection cable 6 009-007299-00
Valves (7-channel, V52-V58) Valves (10-channel, V60-V69) Valves (10-channel, V70-V79)
J1
J5
J7
J8
Valve drive board (F1) 051-002805-00
Valve drive board(F2) 051-002805-00
J3
J5
J4 J2
Figure 8-22 Valve connection diagram
8-26
Hardware System
8.6.3 Troubleshooting Table 8-25 Troubleshooting for the valve control errors Error
Cause
phenomenon
Troubleshooting 1. Exchange the drive boards for the 2 same valves, and then switch on and off the problem valve to see whether it can be
Control
of
a
single valve fails
The most possible cause is that the valve is damaged
controlled, If yes, then the valve drive board fails; 2. If the valve still cannot be controlled, connect the valve to the other valve control line, and switch it on/off. If the valve still cannot be controlled, the valve is damaged; otherwise, the problem is with the cables. 1. Check whether the failed valves are
The most possible Control
of
cause is that the
consecutive
valve drive board
valves fails
fails or poor cable connection.
connected to the same valve connecting cables. If yes, the valve connecting cables connection may be bad (try to remove the error by unplug and then plug the line again), or the valve drive board fails (replace a valve drive board to confirm if it is the reason) 1. Check whether the valve drive board power
The most possible Control
of
valves fails
all
cause is that the valve drive board fails or poor cable connection.
cord and valve drive board control cable are good; and plug and unplug the cables 2. Connect the valve drive board control cable to the other valve drive board and observe valve control status. If control of some valves is effective, then the original valve drive board fails.
8-27
Hardware System
8.7 Power Supply Module 8.7.1 Overview The power supply module converts the grid voltage to voltages for the board card power supply and for all components. It consists of the 24V power supply module (022-000200-00), power conversion board (051-002640-00), 24V isolated power board (051-002990-00) and the 3206 power board PCBA for burning (051-002708-00). The module outputs various power of P24V, P12V, D12V, D5V, A+12V, A-12V, A+5V, AC120V etc.to the drive boards, main control boards, analog boards, valve drive boards, autoloader boards and other boards. The 24V power supply module supports 100~240V wide power input and outputs DC 24V. The power conversion board realizes the conversion of the main power. The +24V DC input and +24V DC output of the 24V isolated power board are electrically isolated. The 3206 power board PCBA for burning converts the isolated DC 24V output by the isolated power board into AC 120V, and then provides it to the count bath through the analog board for burning. P12V
P24V
Valve drive board
Autoloader Board
P24V P24V
P12V D5V
P12V D12V Power cable AC220V/110V
+24V 24V Power module
Power conversion board
Power supply assembly
Drive board
A+12V A-12V
D5V
D12V
A+12V
D5V
A-12V
A+12V A-12V
A+5V
A+5V
Main control board
Analog Board
AC120V
+24V
DC24V 24V isolated power board
Ignition power board
AC120V
Figure 8-23 Power supply module composition Table 8-26 Working power supplies of the main cards and components Power supply P24V
Supplying board Drive board, autoloader board, isolated
Purpose Motor, heating
power board P12V
Drive board, valve drive board
Valve, pump and fan drive
D12V
Main Control Board
COME module, display screen
D5V
Drive board, main control board
Digital circuit
A+12V
Analog board, drive board
Analog circuit
A-12V
Analog board, drive board
Analog circuit
A5V
Analog board
Analog circuit
AC120V
Analog board
Power supply for burning in the count bath 8-28
Hardware System
8.7.2 Structure and Test Notes: The red connection cords between the boards are the power cord. All the GNDs described in the following content connect to the main unit housing. Therefore, when using a multimeter to measure the voltage, insert the black probe to the housing. Table 8-27 Normal voltage ranges and measurement methods Type of power supply +24V
Normal voltage
Measurement method
range +22.8~25.2V
Use the multimeter DC mode to measure the J1 position of the isolated power board
P24V
+22.8~25.2V
Use the multimeter DC mode to measure the J9
P12V
+11.5~12.5V
position of drive board
D12V
+11.5~12.5V
Use the multimeter DC mode to measure the J31
D5V
+4.75~5.25V
position of main control board
A+12V
+11.5~12.5V
A-12V
-11.5~12.5V
Use the multimeter DC mode to measure the J3
A5V
+4.75~5.25V
position of analog board
DC24V
+22.8~25.2V
Use the multimeter DC mode to measure the pin1 and 3 of J2 on the isolated power board
AC120
+108~132V
Use the multimeter AC mode to measure the two terminals of J4 on the analog board
(1) Measure +24V and isolated DC24V Measure the +24V voltage at the input socket of the 24V isolated power board, where the +24V is directly connected. To measure the isolated DC24V, measure the voltage between pin1 and pin3 of the output socket of isolated power board. Note: Since DC24V and instrument do not share the same ground, when measuring DC 24V, the method of using the black probe of multimeter to measure the housing and the red probe to measure the output socket of isolated power board cannot be used to measure DC24V.
8-29
Hardware System
Figure 8-24 Measure +24V and isolated DC24V on the isolated power board (2) Measure P24V and P12V
Figure 8-25 Measure P24V, P12V, D5V, A+12V and A-12V on the drive board 8-30
Hardware System
(3) Measure D12V and D5V D12V and D5V power the main control board and can be measured at the power input socket J31 of main control board.
Figure 8-26 Measure D12V and D5V on the main control board (4) Measure A+12V, A-12V and A5V Connect A+12V, A-12V and A5V to the analog board. They can be measured conveniently at the analog power input socket J3 of analog board.
8-31
Hardware System
Figure 8-27 performing A+12V\A-12V\A5V measurement on the analog board (5) Measure the AC120V for zapping Use the multimeter AC mode to measure the voltage on AC120V input socket J4 on the analog board. Warning: High voltage! During measurement, DO NOT touch the power connector with your hand!
Figure 8-27 Measure AC120V on the analog board 8-32
Hardware System
(6) Measure the voltages on the power conversion board All the power come from the power conversion board. Therefore you can also measure the voltages on the corresponding sockets of the power conversion board. Read the socket number silkscreen on the board to find the desired sockets.
Figure 8-28 Power output sockets on the power conversion board
Figure 8-29 Definitions of the power sockets on the power conversion board (see the silk screen) 8-33
Hardware System
Note: The white triangular symbol besides the board connector indicates pin 1.
8.7.3 Power Indication The LED indicators on various power supply boards indicate the power on/off status. Note: The LED indicator status only reflects whether there is power or not; they do not show whether the voltages are in their normal ranges. (1) Power conversion board indicators There are six green LED indicators on the power conversion board, indicating the main power supply indicator. Table 8-28 Power conversion board indicators Indicator position
Meaning
Normal status
D1
A5V power indicator
Green, steady on
D3
A-12V power indicator
Green, steady on
D4
A+12V power indicator
Green, steady on
D5
D5V power indicator
Green, steady on
D1~D6
+24V/P24V power indicator
Green, steady on
D7
P12V power indicator
Green, steady on
Number
Figure 8-30 Power conversion board power indicators
8-34
Hardware System
(2) Drive board power indicators Table 8-29 Indicators on the drive board Indicator position
Meaning
Normal status
D16
P12V power indicator
Green, steady on
D17
P24V power indicator
Green, steady on
D18
A+12V power indicator
Green, steady on
D19
A-12V power indicator
Green, steady on
D22
A+5V power indicator
Green, steady on
D96
D5V power indicator
Green, steady on
Number
Note: The A+5V power supply is obtained through power conversion in the drive board.
Figure 8-31 Power indicators on the drive board (3) Main control board power indicators Table 8-30 Indicators on the main control board Indicator position
Meaning
Normal status
D24
D5V power indicator
Green, steady on
D25
D12V power indicator
Green, steady on
Number
8-35
Hardware System
Figure 8-32 Power indicators on the main control board (4) Analog board power indicators Table 8-31 Indicators on the analog board Indicator position
Meaning
Normal status
Number D8
A+12V power indicator
Green, steady on
D9
A-12V power indicator
Green, steady on
D10
A5V power indicator
Green, steady on
D11
A-5V power indicator
Green, steady on
Note: The A-5V power is obtained through power conversion in the analog board.
Figure 8-33 Power indicators on the analog board 8-36
Hardware System
8.7.4 Troubleshooting Power supply faults usually manifest as instrument power down or abnormal output of a certain channel of power causing by short circuit and open circuit. Table 8-32 Troubleshooting of the power supply Error
Cause
phenomenon
Troubleshooting 1. First confirm whether the instrument is powered down. In this case, the screen should blank out and all the boards’ indicators should be off.
Usually caused by
2. Unplug the input power cord to each board
+24V short circuit,
to identify whether they are short circuited.
Instrument
triggering
short
Check the boards one by one until you find
powers down
circuit
protection
the failed one. Since 24V is mainly provided
of the 24V power
to the drive board, autoloader board and
supply module.
isolated power board, check these boards first. 3. After you identified the problem board, check whether the short circuit happens in motor, heater or on the board itself. 1. Phenomenon: This power supply has no voltage and the indicator lights off; the other power supplies are normal. (In particular, if only the P24V or P12V
Single
power
supply
powers
down
Short circuit of this
output is abnormal, the instrument will
single
power
report error (the other supplies are not
supply
causes
short
circuit
protection or open circuit
of
the
monitored).) 2. Use the same method as above to check the power supply status. 3. In particular, if the indicator of this power
corresponding
supply on the power conversion board is on,
power
but the indicators on the other boards are
circuit.
converter
off, it is caused by open circuit. Open circuit may be caused by poor cable connection, broken cable, or fusing of board fuse. If the fuse burns out, then there is also short circuit on the board.
8-37
Hardware System
8.8 Boards in the Optical System 8.8.1 Function The boards in the optical system include the laser control board, PD board, fluorescent front board and optical signal board, which respectively implement constant power driving of laser, and collection, amplification and conditioning of the three channels of optical signals (FS, SS and FL), and then transmit them to the post stage main control board for analog/digital conversion. The power supply is provided from the analog board, including A+/-12V and A+/5V.
Ana log Board
Fluorescence preamplification board
Lateral fluorescence
Optical sig nal board
Main co ntr ol boa rd
PD board (FS)
Forward scatter
PD board (SS)
Lateral sca tter
Laser control board
Laser Optical System
Figure 8-34 Boards in the optical system
8-38
Hardware System
8.9 Indicator Board (051-001240-00) 8.9.1 Function The indicator board uses a tri-color indicator (red/yellow/green) and a buzzer to indicate the main unit working status. When the system is standby, the tri-color indicator is in yellow; when the system is working properly, the tri-color indicator is in green; and when the system is with error, the tri-color indicator is in red. When the system works properly, the buzzer is silent; but when there is any error with the system, the buzzer buzzes. The indicator board is directly connected to and controlled by the main control board.
8.9.2 Troubleshooting Phenomenon: The indicator is off or abnormal and the buzzer sounds abnormally. Possible causes: poor cable connection of the indicator board; the indicator board is damaged; the main control board is damaged.
8-39
Hardware System
8.10 Keyboard (051-001568-00) 8.10.1 Function There are two keyboards, one for the Start key (K1) and the other for the mode switch key. Keypad bo ard (K1) Main co ntr ol b oard
Microswitch
Start key
Switch detectio n
Keypad bo ard (K2) Mode switch key
Microswitch
Figure 8-35 Keyboard function diagram
8.10.2 Troubleshooting Table 8-33 Troubleshooting for keyboard errors Error
Cause
phenomenon
Troubleshooting
When the count key is pressed, the
sample
compartment opens; when the mode switch key is
pressed,
The
keypad
cables for K1 and K2 are reversely
Exchange the cables of the two keyboards.
connected.
sample analysis starts.
8-40
Hardware System
8.11 Mini Network Board (051-001122-00) 8.11.1 Function The mini network board divides the communication channel between the main control board and the PC into 2 segment. It acts as the connecting point of the external network cable and the network cable inside the instrument. And it offers two RJ45 connectors to connect the corresponding ports inside and outside the instrument. See the figure below.
Figure 8-36 Mini network board function diagram
8.11.2 Troubleshooting The fault possibility of the small network board is very low. The network disconnection fault related to it is usually caused by poor connection of the network cable. The fault can be eliminated according to the method in the following table. Table 8-34 Network troubleshooting Error
Cause
phenomenon 1. The PC cannot communicate with series
the
6000
analyzer
main unit.
The
cable
Troubleshooting
network is
not
properly
Check if the network cable connector gets loose.
connected;
If yes, reconnect the cable and see if the
2. The cable is
problem is solved
damaged
or
in
poor contact with the socket.
8-41
Hardware System
8.12 Liquid Position Detecting Board (051-000565-00) 8.12.1 Function The liquid position detection board is used to detect the reagents such as DIL Diluent, LH lyse, LN lyse, LD lyse and DR diluent. The principle is to use a sensor to detect whether there is liquid in the pipe. When there is liquid in the pipe, high light intensity is detected for the light transmission, and a high level is output; when there is no liquid (but only air or bubbles) in the pipe, only weak light is received due to light refraction, and low high level is output. The liquid position detection board output is connected to the drive board.
8.12.2 Structure and Test Each type reagent, there is an LED indicator to indicate reagent volume status. When the indicator is on, there is no liquid in the corresponding reagent pipe.
Figure 8-37 LED indicators on the liquid position detection board Table 8-35 Liquid position detection board indicators Indicator
Meaning
Normal status
position Number D1
DIL Diluent indicator
Yellow, always off. Light on when there is no reagent
D2
Yellow, always off. Light on when
LH lyse indicator
there is no reagent D3
Yellow, always off. Light on when
LN lyse indicator
there is no reagent D4
Yellow, always off. Light on when
LD lyse indicator
there is no reagent D5
DR diluent indicator
Yellow, always off. Light on when there is no reagent
D7
5V power indicator
8-42
Red, steady on
Hardware System
8.12.3 Troubleshooting Table 8-36 Troubleshooting the liquid position detection board Error
Cause
phenomenon
Troubleshooting
Poor cord contact, Power indicator is off
or liquid position
Remove and insert the wire again. If the
level board is in
restarting operation does not work, replace the
fault, or the drive
liquid level board or drive board.
board is in fault 1. Check to confirm if this reagent pipe is filled with fluid and there are no bubbles, but the corresponding
indicator
on
the
liquid
position detection board is on. 2. Take out the transparent object from the corresponding reagent sensor on the liquid
Unavailability of a reported mistake
reagent by
Fluid
detection
board error
position detection board, and check if the indicator
changes
when
blocking/not
blocking the sensor. If the indicator is always on or off without any change, replace the liquid position detection board. (Note: Most liquid position detection board faults are caused by leakage corrosion of the board. Check the board surface for reagent trace.)
8-43
Hardware System
8.13 Air Pressure Detection Board (051-000507-00) 8.13.1 Function The air pressure detection board uses the BC-6800 series analyzers' air pressure detection board to detect the +120 kPa (two channels), +90 kPa, +50 kPa, -30 kPa and -40 kPa air pressures. The air pressure detection board obtains the power supply through the drive board, and its output signal is transmitted to the drive board to implement analog-digital acquisition. Air pressure detection board
ADC Drive board
Figure 8-38 Air pressure detection board connection block diagram
8.13.2 Structure
Power indicator
Figure 8-39 Air pressure detection board layout diagram Table 8-37 Air pressure detection board indicator definitions Indicators
Definition
Function The LED indicator stays on under normal conditions. If this indicator is off, the analog +5V power supply of the air
D1
A+5V power supply
pressure detection board is abnormal. Check whether the
indicator
connection line between the air pressure detection board and drive board is inserted firmly or whether the analog +5V voltage of drive board is normal.
D2
Digital
3.3V
power
supply indicator
The LED indicator stays on under normal conditions. If this indicator is off, the digital 3.3V power supply of the air pressure detection board is abnormal. Check whether the 8-44
Hardware System
connection line between the air pressure detection board and drive board is inserted firmly or whether the digital 3.3V voltage of drive board is normal.
8.13.3 Troubleshooting Error with the air pressure detection board will cause abnormal pressure of the whole device and trigger error alarms. When the analyzer reports error of "abnormal pressure", follow the troubleshooting procedure below. Abnormal pressure of the analyzer
Error of all channels
N
Y
1. Check whether the pipeline is correctly connected
Check faulty channel pipeline
1. Check whether the air pressure detection board analog 5V indicator is on; 2. Check whether the drive control board analog power indicator is normal.
1. Reconnect the cable. If the fault is cleared, the maintenance is over; otherwise, go to step 2; 2. Replace the air pressure detection board. If the fault is cleared, the maintenance is over; otherwise, go to step 3; 3. Replace the drive board. If the fault is cleared, the maintenance is over; otherwise, go to step 4; 4. Replace the cable.
Any crystal or liquid in pipeline?
N
Y Replace air pressure detection board
Check pipeline leakage
Repair pipeline
End
Figure 8-40 Maintenance flows when the analyzer reports pressure errors The major factor of an air pressure detection board fault is failure of the pressure sensor, which occurs because impurities or fluid enters the sensor. Now, the fault cannot be eliminated by wiping the impurities or fluid, and the only way is to replace the board.
8-45
Chapter 9 FRU Replacement and Debugging 9.1 Overview This chapter introduces the FRU replacing procedures, and the corresponding FRU codes. The requirements for FRU replacing and servicing are as follows:
For any service procedure involving electric parts, the power shall be switched off, and measures shall be taken to prevent statical electricity
For any service procedure involving fluidics, pay attention to the fluid inside the fluidic tubes. While servicing any piping with pressure, make sure you turn off the pneumatic unit before plugging/unplugging or replacing piping. Using tissue for protection during the service;
After the service is completed, restart the system and wait for the completion of the startup fluidic initialization. Confirm that the system is in a proper state after startup, and then run several fresh blood samples to make sure the instruments are in good state;
For important service related to performance or parameter result, make sure you re-adjust the gain or re-calibrate the system before putting it into use again. For example, after the service of the optical system, it is needed to re-adjust the optical gain, and re-calibrate the system. For other FRUs such as analog board and aperture, re-calibration is also needed after maintenance.
9-1
FRU Replacement and Debugging
9.2 Removal and Installation of the Panels 9.2.1 Opening the Front Cover Assembly
Purpose:
The fluorescence reagent detection sensor, dosing pumps for fluorescent reagents, front cover open detection sensor, diluent preheating bath, rotatory scanning unit and autoloader control board are located on the front panel rack behind the housing. Sometimes these components need to be maintained.
Tools
/
Removal
1
Power off the instrument, and then remove the power cord of main unit;
2
If the sample compartment is open, close it (skip this step if the sample compartment is closed or when you are dealing with an open-vial sampling model analyzer);
3
Use a hand to pull the right side of front cover to open it, as shown in Figure 9-1.
Figure 9-1 Opening the front cover assembly
9-2
FRU Replacement and Debugging
Installation Install the assembly in the reversed order of the disassembly steps.
Verification
1
Try to pull the front cover assembly to check whether it is firmly closed.
2
Plug the power cord, and start the instrument. Make sure it starts up normally.
9.2.2 Opening the Left Panel, Right Panel and Top Cover
Purpose
To service/replace the circuit boards (including the main control board, analog board, valve drive board and power board PCBA for burning) or their cables, remove the top cover; to service/replace the syringes and valves, remove the left panel; to service/replace the reaction baths and the sample probe assembly, as well as certain valves and the power supply unit, remove the right panel.
Tools
107 Phillips screwdriver (107X75)
Removal
1
Power off the instrument, and then remove the power cord of main unit;
2
Open the front cover. To facilitate operation, the opening angle cannot be smaller than 60°;
3
Use a 107 Phillips screwdriver (107X75) to unscrew the 6 cross round head combination screws fixing the right panel (marked in the red rectangle in below diagram), and take out the left panel;
4
Use a 107 Phillips screwdriver (107X75) to unscrew the 6 cross round head combination screws locked on the left door in the red box of the following diagram, and take out the right door;
5
Use a 107 Phillips screwdriver (107X75) to unscrew the 3 cross round head combination screws fixing the right panel (marked in the red rectangle in below diagram), and take out the top cover.
9-3
FRU Replacement and Debugging
Figure 9-2 Instrument after removing the left panel, the right panel and the top cover
Installation
Install the assembly in the reversed order of the disassembly steps.
Verification
Try to pull the left panel, right panel and top cover to check whether they are closed and locked firmly.
9-4
FRU Replacement and Debugging
9.3 Replacing the Autoloader FRU BC-6000 series analyzers have two types of autoloaders, one for the Open-sampling type, and the other for the closed-sampling model. Both types have the loading assembly, feeding assembly, back supporting board assembly and the unloading assembly. When servicing the loading assembly, feeding assembly and loading assembly, the sample transportation platform must be removed first. See the figure below for the open-sampling type autoloader removing procedure:
See the figure below for the closed-sampling type autoloader removing procedure:
9-5
FRU Replacement and Debugging
9.3.1 Removing and Replacing the Loading Motor and Belt
Tools
107 Phillips screwdriver 1.5 mm small inner hexagon spanner Tension measuring device
Procedures
Removal: 1
Remove the cables connected to the motor;
2
Use a Phillips screwdriver to unscrew the 2 M3x8 screws fixing the belt clamp, and then unscrew the 4 M3x8 screws; then, incline the motor inward in the axis direction, remove the belt directly, and take out the motor together with the large pulley;
3
Use a 1.5 mm small inner hexagon spanner to take out the two lock screws of the large pulley, and separate the large pulley from the motor.
Installation: 1
Install the synchronous belt, adjust the synchronous belt tension to 7±2 N and belt width to 6.4 mm, and then tighten the belt. Use M3x5 inner hexagon screws to fix the motor. The motor wire outlet direction is shown in the figure.
2
Check whether the lock screws on the pulley get loose. If yes, adjust the spacing between 9-6
FRU Replacement and Debugging
the pulley and motor to about 0.5 mm, and then fasten the lock screws on the pulley.
Figure 9-3 Remove motor and belt No.
Name
1
M3x8
cross
head
combination
pan
FRU code
No.
Name
FRU code
M04-
4
Small pulley
BA30-21-
051140---
06582
screw 2
Synchronous
3
belt
M6C-
160MXL025
020003---
Inner hexagon set
M04-
screw with cup point
051102---
5
Motor
024-000863-00
9.3.2 Removing and Replacing the Loading Sensor
Tools
107 cross-head screwdriver Nipper pliers
Procedures
Removal: 1
Remove the cables connected to the sensor;
2
Use a cross-head screwdriver to remove the M4x12 screws fixing the sensor, and remove the sensor
Installation: 1
Install the sensor, and use the cross-head screwdriver to tighten the M4x12 screws.
2
Connect the cables.
9-7
FRU Replacement and Debugging
Figure 9-4 Removing and replacing loading sensor No.
Name
1
M4x12
FRU code cross M04-051152---
No.
Name
FRU code
2
Sensor
011-000021-00
panhead screw
9.3.3 Removing and Replacing the Feeding Motor and Belt
Tools
107 Phillips screwdriver 1.5 mm small inner hexagon spanner Tension measuring device
Procedures
Removal: 1
Remove the cables connected to the motor;
2
Use a Phillips screwdriver to unscrew the 2 M3x8 screws fixing the belt clamp, and then unscrew the 4 M3x8 screws; then, incline the motor inward in the axis direction, remove the belt directly, and take out the motor together with the large pulley;
3
Use a 1.5 mm small inner hexagon spanner to take out the two lock screws of the large 9-8
FRU Replacement and Debugging
pulley, and separate the large pulley from the motor. Installation: 1
Install the synchronous belt, adjust the synchronous belt tension to 7±2 N and belt width to 6.4 mm, and then tighten the belt. Use M3x5 inner hexagon screws to fix the motor. The motor wire outlet direction is shown in the figure.
2
Check whether the lock screws on the pulley get loose. If yes, adjust the spacing between the pulley and motor to about 0.5 mm, and then fasten the lock screws on the pulley.
Figure 9-5 Remove the motor and belt No.
Name
1
M3x8
cross
head
combination
pan
FRU code
No.
Name
FRU code
M04-
4
Small pulley
BA30-21-
051140---
06582
screw 2
Synchronous
belt
160MXL025 3
Inner screw
hex
M6C-
5
020003--lock
M04051102---
9-9
Motor
024-000863-00
FRU Replacement and Debugging
9.3.4 Removing and Replacing the Feeding sensor
Tools
107 cross-head screwdriver Nipper pliers
Procedures
Removal: 1
Remove the cables connected to the sensor;
2
Use a cross-head screwdriver to remove the M4x12 screws fixing the sensor, and remove the sensor
Installation: 1
Install the sensor, and use the cross-head screwdriver to tighten the M4x12 screws.
2
Connect the cables.
Figure 9-6 Remove and replace the loading sensor No.
Name
1
M4x12
cross
FRU code
No.
Name
FRU code
M04-051152---
2
Sensor
011-000021-00
panhead screw
9.3.5 Removing and Replacing the Unloading Motor and Belt
Tools
107 Phillips screwdriver 1.5 mm small inner hexagon spanner Tension measuring device
Procedures
Removal: 9-10
FRU Replacement and Debugging
1
Remove the cables connected to the motor;
2
Use a Phillips screwdriver to unscrew the 2 M3x8 screws fixing the belt clamp, and then unscrew the 4 M3x8 screws; then, incline the motor inward in the axis direction, remove the belt directly, and take out the motor together with the large pulley; Use a 1.5 mm small inner hexagon spanner to take out the two lock screws of the large
3
pulley, and separate the large pulley from the motor. Installation: Install the synchronous belt, adjust the synchronous belt tension to 7±2 N and belt width
1
to 6.4 mm, and then tighten the belt. Use M3x5 inner hexagon screws to fix the motor. The motor wire outlet direction is shown in the figure. Check whether the lock screws on the pulley get loose. If yes, adjust the spacing between
2
the pulley and motor to about 0.5 mm, and then fasten the lock screws on the pulley.
Figure 9-7 Remove motor and belt No.
Name
FRU code
No.
Name
FRU code
1
M3x8 cross pan head
M04-051140---
4
Inner hex lock
M04-051102---
combination screw 2 3
Synchronous
screw belt
M6C-020003--
160MXL025
-
Small pulley
BA30-21-
5
Motor
024-00086300
06582
9-11
FRU Replacement and Debugging
9.3.6 Removing and Replacing the Unloading Sensor
Tools
107 cross-head screwdriver Nipper pliers
Procedures
Removal: 1
Remove the cables connected to the sensor;
2
Use a cross-head screwdriver to remove the M4x12 screws fixing the sensor, and remove the sensor
Installation: 1
Install the sensor, and use the cross-head screwdriver to tighten the M4x12 screws.
2
Connect the cables.
Figure 9-8 Remove and replace the loading sensor No.
Name
1
M4x12
FRU code cross
panhead screw
No.
M04-
Name 2
051152---
Sensor
FRU code 011000021-00
9-12
FRU Replacement and Debugging
9.3.7 Removing and Replacing the Back Supporting Board
Tools
107 cross-head screwdriver Nipper pliers
Procedures
Removal: 1
Remove the cables connected to the sensor;
2
Use a cross-head screwdriver to remove the M4x12 screws fixing the sensor, and remove the sensor
Installation: 1
Install the sensor, and use the cross-head screwdriver to tighten the M4x12 screws.
2
Connect the cables.
Figure 9-9 Remove and replace the loading sensor No.
Name
1
M4x12
cross
FRU code
No.
Name
FRU code
M04-051152---
2
Sensor
011-000021-00
panhead screw When servicing the autoloader, if you remove the sample feeding platform, the front supporting board needs to be re-adjusted. For detailed instruction, see 5.2.1 Autoloader, Figure 5-29 Front -back, left-right position adjustment for front supporting board assembly.
9-13
FRU Replacement and Debugging
9.4 Replacing the Tube Stabilizing Assembly FRU 9.4.1 Removing and Replacing the Compressing Spring Piece and Spring
Tools
Inner hexagon spanner
Procedures
Remove the compressing spring piece: 1
Use an inner hexagon spanner to unscrew the M3x5 screw on the compressing spring piece and the rotary plate, and take down the compressing spring piece and finger pressure block at the same time;
2
Use the inner hexagon spanner to unscrew the M3x5 screw on the compressing spring piece and the finger pressure block, and separate the compressing spring piece from the finger pressure block.
Remove the pinch roller spring: Press the pinch roller spring tightly with a hand so that the spring is detached from the locating pin, and then take out the pinch roller spring. Install the compressing spring piece: 1
Use the inner hexagon spanner and one M3x5 screw to lock the compressing spring piece;
2
Use the inner hexagon spanner and one M3x5 screw to lock the compressing spring piece on the rotary plate;
Install the pinch roller spring: Manually insert one end of the pinch roller spring into the corresponding hole on the roller fixing plate, and press the other end of the spring to insert the spring into the locating pin.
9-14
FRU Replacement and Debugging
Figure 9-10 Remove the compressing spring piece and spring No.
Name
1
Inner
hexagon
FRU code
No.
Name
FRU code
M04-051095---
4
Rotary plate
041-024204-00
033-000675-00
5
Roller fixing plate
041-024203-00
041-026679-00
6
Pinch roller spring
033-000624-00
screw M3x5 2
Compressing spring piece
3
Finger
pressure
block
Validation
1
Check whether the compressing spring piece can act normally;
2
Check whether the pinch roller spring is fixed in the hole and dowel.
9-15
FRU Replacement and Debugging
9.5 Introduction to Rotatory Scanning Component
Figure 9-11 Roller No.
Name
FRU code
No.
1
Motor
009-000446-00
7
Name Support
FRU code bracket
screen) 2
Inner
hexagon
m04-051110
8
Bearing fixing plate
041-005170-00
9
Vertical
screw M3x6 3
Mindray
syringe
coupler 4
Inner
plate
assembly hexagon
m04-051096
10
screw M3x8
Combination screw M3x8
5
Roller
041-023832-00
6
Roller sleeve
049-001272-00
11
9-16
Motor fixing plate-2
(silk 042-020561-00 041-023830-00 042-019147-00 030-000099-00 041-023829-00
FRU Replacement and Debugging
9.5.1 Removing and Replacing the Motor and Roller Sleeve
Tools
Inner hexagon spanner
Procedures
Remove the motor: 1
Remove the cables connected to the motor;
2
Use the inner hexagon spanner to loosen the two M3x8 screws of the self-made syringe coupler, unscrew the four M3x6 screws fixing the motor, and take out the motor;
Remove the roller sleeve: Manually take the roller sleeve from the roller Install the motor: 1
Insert the motor axis into the hole of Mindray syringe coupler, tighten the 4 M3x6 screws fixing the motor, and then tighten the 2 M3x8 screws fixing the Mindray syringe coupler;
2
Connect the motor cable.
Install the roller sleeve: 1
Manually install the roller sleeve into the roller.
Figure 9-12 Remove the motor and roller sleeve No.
Name
FRU code
No.
Name
1
Motor
009-000446-00
4
Inner
9-17
FRU code hexagon
m04-051096
FRU Replacement and Debugging
screw M3x8 2
Inner hexagon screw
m04-051110
5
Roller
M3x6 3
Mindray coupler
041-02383200
syringe
041-00517000
6
Roller sleeve
049-00127200
Validation
1
Make sure the motor works properly.
2
Make sure the roller sleeve is inside the roller.
9-18
FRU Replacement and Debugging
9.6 Introduction to Pincher Roller Assembly
Figure 9-13 Pinch roller assembly No.
Name
FRU code
No.
Name
1
Motor fixing plate-1
042-020562-00
8
Linear guide rail set
(silkscreen) 2
Stepping motor
024-000863-00
9
Guide shaft
3
Small pulley 1
BA30-21-
10
Pinch roller spring
11
Pinch roller drive
06582 4
Synchronous
031-000164-00
toothed belt
plate
FRU code 032-000083-00 041-023825-00 033-000624-00 042-018382-00
5
Synchronous pulley
M6C-010002--
12
Front sensor barrier
042-018383-00
6
Pinch roller
041-023828-00
13
Sensor
011-000021
7
Drive plate
042-018503-00
14
Rear sensor barrier
042-018384-00
9-19
FRU Replacement and Debugging
9.6.1 Removing and Replacing the Motor, Sensors and Pinch Roller Spring
Tools
107 Phillips screwdriver Nipper pliers Inner hexagon spanner Tension measuring device
Procedures
Remove the motor: 1
Remove the cables connected to the motor;
2
Use a Phillips screwdriver to unscrew the 4 M3x8 screws fixing the motor, and incline the motor axis inwards to take out the motor.
Remove the sensor: 1
Remove the cables connected to the sensor;
2
Use a Phillips screwdriver to unscrew the M4x12 screw fixing the sensor.
Remove the pinch roller spring: 1
Use a pair of nipper pliers to remove the split washer;
2
Push the guide shaft to the back of the assembly, and take out the spring.
Install the motor: 1
Insert the motor axis, install the synchronous belt, adjust the synchronous belt tension, and adjust the belt width to 6.4 mm to tighten the belt. Use four M3x8 inner hexagon screws to fix the motor. The wiring direction of the motor is shown in the figure.
2
Connect the motor cable.
Install the sensor: 1
Use the Phillips screwdriver to fix the sensor with one M4x12 screw;
2
Connect the sensor wire.
Install the pinch roller spring: 1
Set the spring into the guide shaft, and push the guide shaft to the front of the assembly;
2
Use the nipper pliers to fix the split washer on the guide shaft.
9-20
FRU Replacement and Debugging
Figure 9-14 Remove the motor, sensors and pinch roller spring No.
Name
FRU code
No.
Name
FRU code
1
Stepping motor
024-000863-00
5
Split washer
m04-021055
2
Combination screw
m04-051140
6
Pinch roller spring
M3x8
033-000624-00
3
Drive plate
042-018503-00
7
Sensor
011-000021
4
Guide shaft
041-023825-00
8
Screw M4x12
m04-051001
Validation
1
Check whether the motor can operate normally;
2
Check whether the spring can operate normally;
3
Check whether the sensors are installed at a proper position.
9-21
FRU Replacement and Debugging
9.7 Introduction
to
Sampling
Assembly
and
Replacement Procedure
Figure 9-15 Sampling assembly No.
Name
FRU code
No.
1
Sensor
011-000021-00
7
Name Probe
FRU code wipe
sampling) 2 2
Motor
position
(closed041-023727-00
2800-21-28878
8
Inner hexagon screw M3x6 M04-051110---
sensor assembly 3
Screw M3x6
M04-002505---
9
Piercing probe
4
Sensor
011-000021-00
10
Sample probe fixing plate
5
Screw M4x12
M04-051152---
11
6
Motor
024-000366-00
Motor
115-033912-00 042-019940-00 024-000366-00
9.7.1 Removing and Replacing Detection Sensor
Tools
107 Phillips screwdriver
Procedures
1
Before removing the sensor 1 and sensor 6, unplug the sensor connector, use a Phillips screwdriver to unscrew screws 2 and 5, replace the sensor, and then connect the sensor connector;
2
Before removing the sensor 3, unplug the sensor connector, use a Phillips screwdriver to unscrew two screws 4, replace the sensor, and then connect the sensor connector;
9-22
FRU Replacement and Debugging
Figure 9-16 Removing and replacing detection sensor No.
Name
1
Sensor
2 3
FRU code
No.
Name
FRU code
011-000021-00
4
Screw M3x6
M04-002505---
Screw M4x12
M04-051152---
5
Screw M4x12
M04-051152---
Motor
2800-21-28878
6
Sensor
011-000021-00
position
sensor assembly
9.7.2 Removing and Replacing Probe Wipe (Closed-Sampling) and Sampling Probe
Tools
Cross-headed screwdriver Inner hexagon spanner
Procedures
1
Before removing the probe wipe (closed-sampling), unplug the rubber hose fixed on the probe wipe (closed-sampling). Use an inner hexagon spanner to unscrew two screws 3, replace the probe wipe (closed-sampling), and then fix the rubber hose onto the probe wipe (closed-sampling); pay attention to the probe wipe (closed-sampling) installation direction.
2
Before removing the sample probe, first remove the probe wipe (closed-sampling) (step 1 in section 4.2.3), move the puncture slider to the top, unscrew the two screws 7 fixing the sample probe fixing plate, take down the sample probe fixing plate, and replace the sample probe; then assemble the parts in the reverse order. Pay attention to the sample probe 9-23
FRU Replacement and Debugging
installation direction when replacing the sample probe.
Figure 9-17 Removing and replacing the sample probe and probe wipe (closedsampling) No.
Name
1
Probe
wipe
FRU code
No.
Name
FRU code
041-023727-00
5
Puncture slider
041-026248-00
041-026247-00
6
Sample
042-019940-00
(closed-sampling) 2 2
Z
direction
support bracket 3
Screw M3x6
fixing plate M04-051110---
7
Combination screw M3x8
4
Piercing probe
probe
115-033912-00
9-24
030-000099-00
FRU Replacement and Debugging
9.7.3 Removing and Replacing Y Direction Motor and Z Direction Motor
Tools
Cross-headed screwdriver Inner hexagon spanner Tension measuring device
Procedures
Removing the Y direction motor Before removing the Y direction motor, use an inner hexagon spanner to unscrew the four M3x8 screws fixing the motor, incline the motor axis inwards to take out the motor together with the synchronous pulley, and then unscrew the two lock screws on the synchronous pulley; Installing the Y direction motor Install the new motor, the synchronous pulley and two lock screws, with one lock screw locked on the motor flat position, insert the motor axis, install the synchronous belt, adjust the synchronous belt tension, and adjust the belt width to 6.4 mm to tighten the belt. Use four M3x8 inner hexagon screws to fix the motor. The wiring direction of the motor is shown in the figure.
Figure 9-18 Removing and Replacing the Y direction motor
9-25
FRU Replacement and Debugging
No. 1
Name Y
direction
FRU code
No.
Name
FRU code
042-019935-00
4
Lock screw M3x5
M04-051102---
024-000366-00
5
Inner
M04-051096---
bracket 2
Motor
hexagon
screw M3x8 3
Small pulley 1
BA30-21-06582
6
Synchronous belt
031-000484-00
Remove the Z direction motor; 1
Loosen the two lock screws (No. 1) at the left end of the guide rail, unscrew the screw (No. 6) at the right end of the guide rail, draw out the guide rail (No. 2), and remove the Z direction support bracket shaft sleeve (No. 5);
2
Unscrew the three screws (No. 4) on the front protective board (silk screen) (No. 3), and take down the front protective board (silk screen) (No. 3); unscrew the two screws (No.12) fixed on the rotation stop block (No. 10);
3
Unscrew the two screws (No. 8) fixing the synchronous belt (No. 7) and synchronous belt clamp (No. 9), and take down the Z direction support bracket (No. 5) and the parts fixed on it;
4
Loosen the two lock screws (No. 15) fixed on the motor axis, unscrew the four screws (No. 13) fixing the motor, and take out the motor (No. 14) to be replaced.
Install the Z direction motor; 1
Insert the new motor into the corresponding hole (No. 11) on lead screw, use four screws (No. 13) to fix the motor, and then use two lock screws (No. 15) to fix the motor axis (one lock screw is installed on the flat position of motor axis); the motor outlet direction is shown in the figure;
2
Insert the guide rail (No. 2) into the Z direction support shaft sleeve (No. 5), use two lock screws (No. 1) to fix the left end of guide rail and use the screw (No. 6) to fix the right end of guide rail;
3
Use two screws (No. 12) to fix the rotation stop block (No. 10) onto the Z direction support bracket (No. 5);
4
Use three screws (No. 4) to fix the front protective board (silk screen) (No. 3);
5
Use two screws (No. 8) to fix the synchronous belt clamp (No. 9) and synchronous belt (No. 7) onto the Z direction support (No. 5).
9-26
FRU Replacement and Debugging
Figure 9-19 Removing and Replacing the Y direction motor No. 1
Name
FRU code
Guide rail front
No.
Name
FRU code 3100-20-40868
041-026246-00
9
Belt clamp
032-000594-00
10
Rotation
fixation block 2
Precision shaft
stop
043-002307-00
block 3
Front
protective
board
(silk
042-019964-00
11
Lead screw
041-007088-00
M04-051140---
12
Self-tapping
M04-000305---
screen) 4
Combination screw M3x8
5
Z
direction
screw PT3x12 041-026247-00
13
support bracket 6
Inner
hexagon
Inner
hexagon
M04-051026---
screw M3x10 M04-051101---
14
Motor
024-000366-00
15
Lock screw M3x5
M04-051102---
screw M4x8 7
Synchronous belt
031-000484-00
8
Inner
M04-051110---
hexagon
screw M3x6
Validation
1
Check whether the motor can operate normally;
2
Check whether the Z direction support operates normally.
9-27
FRU Replacement and Debugging
9.8 Introduction to mix assembly
Figure 9-20 mix assembly diagram No. 1 2
Name
FRU code
Z direction support
042-015965-
bracket
00
No.
Z direction moving
Name
5
Tube pincher
6
Y direction motor
assembly 3 4
FRU code 115-035779-00 024-00015000
Y direction moving
M04-002505-
assembly
--
R direction motor
024-000150-
7
Z direction motor
024-00036600
00
9-28
FRU Replacement and Debugging
9.8.1 Removing and Replacing Detection Sensor
Tools
107 Phillips screwdriver
Procedures
1
When removing sensor 1, 2, 3 and 4, use a Phillips screwdriver to unscrew the corresponding fixing screw (pan head screw M3x5) (No.5), replace the sensor, and then lock the screw;
2
When removing sensor 7, use a Phillips screwdriver to unscrew the corresponding fixing screw (pan head screw M4x12) (No.6), replace the sensor, and then lock the screw;
Figure 9-21 Removing and replacing detection sensor
9-29
FRU Replacement and Debugging
No. 1
Name Motor
FRU code
No.
Motor
2800-21-28878
5
Pan head screw M3x5 M04-051031---
position
2800-21-28878
6
Pan head screw M4x12 M04-051001---
position
2800-21-28878
7
Sensor
position
2800-21-28878
sensor 3
Motor sensor
4
Motor
FRU code
position
sensor 2
Name
011-000021-00
sensor
9.8.2 Removing and Replacing Motor
Tools
Inner hexagon spanner Tension measuring device
Procedures
Removing the Z direction motor Before removing the Z direction motor, use an inner hexagon spanner to unscrew the four M3x8 screws fixing the motor, incline the motor axis inwards to take out the motor together with the synchronous pulley, and then unscrew the two lock screws on the synchronous pulley; Install the Z direction motor: Install the new motor, the synchronous pulley and two lock screws, with one lock screw locked on the motor flat position, insert the motor axis, install the synchronous belt, adjust the synchronous belt tension, and adjust the belt width to 6.4 mm to tighten the belt. Use four M3x8 inner hexagon screws to fix the motor.
Figure 9-22 Remove and replace the Z direction motor 9-30
FRU Replacement and Debugging
No.
Name
1
Z
FRU code direction
042-015965-00
No. 4
support bracket 2
Motor
3
Inner
hexagon
Name
FRU code
Synchronous
031-000451-00
pulley 024-000366-00
5
Lock screw M3x5
M04-051102---
M04-051096---
6
Synchronous belt
031-000452-00
screw M3x8 Removing the Y direction motor Use an inner hexagon spanner to unscrew the four M3x8 screws fixing the motor, incline the motor axis inwards to take out the motor together with the synchronous pulley, and then unscrew the two lock screws on the synchronous pulley; Install the Y direction motor: Install the new motor, the synchronous pulley and two lock screws, with one lock screw locked on the motor flat position, insert the motor axis, install the synchronous belt, adjust the synchronous belt tension, and adjust the belt width to 6.4 mm to tighten the belt. Use four M3x8 inner hexagon screws to fix the motor.
Figure 9-23 Removing and Replacing the Y direction motor
9-31
FRU Replacement and Debugging
No.
Name
FRU code
No.
Name
1
Synchronous belt
BA30-10-06618
4
Inner
FRU code hexagon
M04-051096---
screw M3x8 2
Small pulley 1
BA30-21-06582
5
Motor fixing plate
042-017479-00
3
Lock screw M3x5
M04-051102---
6
Motor
024-000150-00
Removing the R direction motor Use an inner hexagon spanner to unscrew the three M3x8 screws fixing the motor, incline the motor axis inwards to take out the motor together with the synchronous pulley, and then unscrew the two lock screws on the synchronous pulley; Install the R direction motor: Install the new motor, the synchronous pulley and two lock screws, with one lock screw locked on the motor flat position, insert the motor axis, install the synchronous belt, adjust the synchronous belt tension, and adjust the belt width to 6.4 mm to tighten the belt. Use three M3x8 inner hexagon screws to fix the motor.
Figure 9-24 Remove and replace the R direction motor No.
Name
FRU code
No.
Name
1
Synchronous belt
BA30-10-06618
4
Inner
FRU code hexagon
M04-051096---
screw M3x8 2
Small pulley 1
BA30-21-06582
5
Motor fixing plate
042-017479-00
3
Lock screw M3x5
M04-051102---
6
Motor
024-000150-00
9-32
FRU Replacement and Debugging
9.9 Gain Adjustment
Purpose:
To set the gain to make the instrument operate in a specified status. Adjustment method: 1
Use the user service level account and password to log in, tap "Settings" "Gain Settings" in the menu to enter the "Gain Settings" screen shown below.
Figure 9-25 Gain adjustment screen 2
The gain value can be adjusted only when the edit box is activated. If the gain setting is beyond the valid range or is set to be blank, the system will prompt that the input is invalid and restore the set gain value to the result before editing.
3
After setting, tap another button, the software displays the dialog box below. Tap "Yes" to save settings and switch the screen; tap "No" to switch the screen directly without saving the settings.
Figure 9-26 Dialog for confirming saving 9-33
FRU Replacement and Debugging
Note: As shown in the figure, confirm that the WBC bath is filled with reagent, the HGB lamp is on and naked eyes cannot see bubbles on the inner wall of cistern on the light path. If bubbles are found, see "Common Faults and Troubleshooting" to handle the problem. Enter the currently new voltage value on the screen shown in the figure so that the HGB background voltage is in the range of 4.5±0.2V, and then tap "Save".
Figure 9-27 WBC bath and HGB assembly (right side)
9-34
FRU Replacement and Debugging
9.10 Installing and Adjusting Rotary Scanning Device
Purpose
To upgrade the instrument from tube detection to rotary scanning detection. Installation method (for the mechanical structure, see Section 5.2.2 ): 1. Rotary scanning fixing mechanism and rotary scanner installation and wiring
Install
the
rotary scanning fixing mechanism
Install
the
scanner
Figure 9-28
Figure 9-29 Install the rotary scanner and fixing mechanism as shown in Figure 9-30 and Figure 9-31, lead the wire through the inside of the machine and out of the threading hole at the lower part of the 9-35
FRU Replacement and Debugging
autoloader board, and connect it to the motor and sensor of the fixing mechanism (fixing mechanism connection cable 009-007303-00: connect the J17 socket on the autoloader board and the sensor connector on 009-006866-00).
CAN communication cable 1 8130
CAN communication cable 2 8131
J11 Autoloader board power cable 6762
J10 P1
J20
Scanner patching line 7671
Autoloader board 6k2 051-002829-00
J2 Valve board power supply and control extension cable 8127
J19
J6
J9
J7
J8
J17
Compression mechanism Autoloader Autoloader connection photocoupler sensor cable ext ension cable extension cable 7303 8125 6866
J16
J15
J14
Autoloader motor extension cable 6867
Figure 9-30
Samplin g plate
Fixing mechanism sensor connector
Figure 9-31 2. Install the roller mechanism on the autoloader board Place the auto-loading feeding channel assembling fixture (898-000201-00) as shown in the figure, making it closely pressed to the floating blood ring seat.
9-36
FRU Replacement and Debugging
1. Remove the rubber.
3. Push the assembly closely connected to the fixture and then tighten the two screws here.
2. First tighten the two screws here.
Figure 9-32
6. Small cable tie 5. Install the rubber ring 6. Cables connected to motor
6. Small cable clip 4. Loosen these two screws so that the edge of the assembly gets completely pressed to the arc edge of fixture
Figure 9-33 (1) Remove the rubber part of roller on the roller assembly, as shown in Figure 9-32; (2) Use the stainless steel cross pan head screw assembly M4x8 (torsion moment: 4~6 kgf.cm) to fix the roller assembly on the table board; (3) First push the roller assembly to the left, keep the component close to the fixture according to the arrow direction in Figure 9-33, and tighten the M3x8 cross pan head screw on it (torsion moment: 4~6kgf.cm); (4) Loosen the M4x8 screw in 2), push the roller assembly to the left to make the trolley completely pressed to the arc edge of fixture, and then tighten the screw (torsion moment: 4~6 kgf.cm). The screw must be tightened here, as shown in Figure 9-33; (5) Take down the fixture, and install the removed rubber ring; (6) Connect the reserved wire to the motor, and use the small cable clip and small cable tie to 9-37
FRU Replacement and Debugging
fix the cables, as shown in Figure 9-33. 3. Adjusting the rotary scanning fixing mechanism position and confirming its function 1
Tap "Settings" → "System Settings" → Barcode", select the appropriate code system and number of barcode digits used on the customer's site, exit and save the settings;
2
Place the rotary scanning fixing mechanism adjusting fixture (898-000303-00) into the tube rack, and place this tube rack on the autoloader; on the software screen, tap "Service" → "Debug&Self-test" → "Self-test" tap the "Autoloading Assembly" button, and then tap "Loading" → "Feeding" in turn. Move the fixture until it arrives below the compressing module (as shown in Figure 9-34 and Figure 9-35);
Figure 9-34
Figure 9-35 3
Manually pull out the rotary scanning fixing mechanism, and check whether the fixture is in the center of the compressing structure. Also check whether the tube rack moves to the 9-38
FRU Replacement and Debugging
left or right. If yes, feed the tube rack again from the initial position; 4
If there is any position deviation, loosen the screws fixing the rotary scanning assembly, adjust its position in the horizontal position, and fix it till the fixture falls into the center of the compacting structure;
5
Tap "Tube Detect", place a tube rack with five tubes in the loading area, tap "Start", and make sure that the instrument can correctly detect if there is a tube or not.
4. Adjusting the scanner position and confirming functions 1
Place the tube with a barcode on the tube rack, with the barcode facing the opening on the tube rack. Load and feed the tube rack to the scanning position, and tap "Scanner On" to check if the scanner can be turned on normally. Loosen the locking screw of the scanner as shown in Figure 9-35, adjust the scanner position and make sure that the scanner can scan the tube barcode. Tap the "Scanner Off" button. Note: The scanner blinks quickly when it correctly scans the barcode, but it is steady on when no barcode is scanned.
2
Tap the "Auto-Read Barcode" button to read the tube barcode. The barcode content will be displayed in the barcode content column. Make sure that the read barcode content is correct and the recognition rate is 100%.
Scanner locking screw
Figure 9-36
9-39
Chapter 10 Maintenance 10.1 Recommended Maintenance Frequency Daily
Program When the instrument works for 24 hours continuously without shutdown, perform "Probe Cleanser Soak" every day. Before running any samples, run the Controls to ensure reliable results of the analyzer. For the specific quality control analysis operation methods, see Chapter 8 "Quality Control" in the user manual.
Every week
Perform "Probe Cleanser Soak" every week as long as it works.
Half-year
Clean and maintain the count baths, including the scraps and crystals on the shielding box, and crystals on the bath surface, etc. Clean the baths with distilled water; as using other cleaning agent may leave crystals on the baths.
As needed
When the count baths may be contaminated, perform count cleaning procedures (on the software, tap "Menu-Service-Maintenance-Cleaning"; When the analyzer frequently reports that liquid sticks to the volume metering tube, check whether the air filter is covered with dust. If yes, replace the air filter. When the piercing count exceeds 100000, replace the sample probe to ensure accuracy of tests. If the analyzer will be idle for a long time (more than 2 weeks), the packup function needs to be implemented. If any other error is reported, follow the troubleshooting information on the software or in the Operator's Manual to remove it.
10-1
Maintenance
10.2 Active Maintenance 10.2.1 Pre-maintenance Preparations Tools Table 10-1 Tool List No.
Tool Names
Quantity
1
Cross-head screwdriver
1
2
Slot-headed screwdriver
1
3
M2.5 Allen wrench
1
4
Diagonal pliers
1
5
Tweezers
1
6
Blade
1
Notes
Consumables Table 10-2 Consumables List No.
Tool Names
Quantity
Notes
1
Gloves
Several
2
Tissues
1 roll
3
Medium cable tie
4
Cotton swab
1
5
Cleaning cloth
3
6
Lubricating grease
1
7
Probe Cleanser
1
8
5ml syringe
1
9
Low-level QC
1
For verifying instrument performance
10
Normal-level QC
1
For verifying instrument performance
Several
and test repeatability 11
High-level control
1
For verifying instrument performance
12
Calibrator
1
For calibrating the instrument (if needed)
10.2.2 Maintenance Plan and Content Maintenance package [3206 one year maintenance package (FRU)] Material ID 041-006857-00
Material Name Block ring
Instructions For replacement; for details see the maintenance guide.
10-2
Maintenance
115-011660-00
Probe wipe filter
115-011660-00
Waste filter
115-010567-00
Sheath fluid filter
M6G-020011---
Pinch valve tube
0010-10-12408
Diluent filter
For replacement; for details see the maintenance guide. For replacement; for details see the maintenance guide. For replacement; for details see the maintenance guide. For replacement; for details see the maintenance guide. For replacement; for details see the maintenance guide.
10-3
Maintenance
Maintenance plan and content Hospital Name:
Dpt.:
Frequency
Person in charge: Program
Analyzer model: 2 years
3 years
4 years
5 years
6 years
7 years
/60000
/120000
/180000
/240000
/300000
/360000
/420000
samples
samples
samples
samples
samples
samples
samples
Check the buffer bath Check tube pincher Replace the blocking ring (if needed) Check the drive pulley, driven pulley and slide rail Check the tube detection sensor status Verify the sample probe position in the reaction bath
samples maintenance
Telephone:
1 year
Check the waste cistern floater
1 year/60000
Serial number:
Check the HGB and optical reaction bath bubble mixing tube Check tube of reagent cap assembly Clean the crystal on the solenoid valve Clean the crystal on the syringe Maintain the pinch valve tube Clean the piercing probe, probe wipe and probe wipe barrier Replace the diluent filter Check piercing probe abrasion status Clean the HGB bath RBC bath and optical reaction bath Lubricate the moving parts
10-4
Maintenance
Check and replace the wearing parts Perform Probe Cleanser maintenance to the waste cistern Check the instrument status
Check the instrument according to the state checklist.
Confirm the
Confirm that the instrument performance,
general
status and graph are all normal, and
performance of
perform
the instrument
procedures as needed)
Data Backup and Export
debugging
and
calibration
Back up the database and export the sample records
Note: 1) Wear gloves during the cleaning, and wash hands with the cleanser or the disinfectant after the cleaning. 2) Probe cleanser is a kind of strong corrosive detergent. Be careful not to let it spill to your skin or clothes. If it spills to your skin or clothes, clean with plenty of water immediately or it may hurt your skin or damage your clothes. Detailed steps of active maintenance Inspection Item
Maintenance
Note
Tools and
Notes
Consumables Check the waste cistern floater
Check WC1/WC2
the cistern
floaters Check the waste container floater
1) Open the left door of the instrument;
Probe Cleanser
Caution:
2) Check the WC1 and WC2 cistern floaters, and observe if there is much dirt on the floater (no need
Syringe
Shut down the analyzer first before you clean
to clear the dirt at this stage. You will need to clean
floater
the dirt after servicing the waste cistern);
container.
Otherwise
when
instrument
3) If a waste container is used, take out the waste container cap assembly, and check whether there
in the
enters
the
the
waste
standby
are dirt on the waste cistern floater; if yes, soak the
status, waste fluid may
floater with Probe Cleanser for more than 10 minutes
spray out.
10-5
Maintenance
No.
Name
1 2
Inspection Item
FRU code
No.
Name
WC2 cistern floater
3
WC1 cistern floater
Buffer bath
4
Waste container floater
Maintenance
Note
FRU code
Tools and Consumables
Check the buffer bath
Check the crystal and liquid in the buffer bath
1) Open the left door of the instrument; 2) Check the status of buffer bath besides WC2. If there are a lot of crystals or liquid in the buffer bath, If there is much crystal or liquid inside, check if there is liquid flowing back, or if there is any other problem to be dealt with.
10-6
Cross-headed screwdriver
Notes
Maintenance
Check tube pincher
Check tube pincher
Cross-headed
1) Open the front cover of the instrument. 2) Check whether the tube gripper is deformed or
screwdriver
bent; or cannot grip the tube firmly
No.
Name
1
Tube gripper
FRU code
No.
10-7
Name
FRU code
Maintenance
Inspection Item
Maintenance
Note
Tools and
Notes
Consumables Replace
the
blocking
ring (if needed)
Replace the blocking ring (if
[Check whether the blocking ring is scratched or
Cross-headed
needed)
worn. If yes, check the piercing probe for bending.
screwdriver
If yes, correct it in time, and replace the blocking ring. After replacement, push the blocking ring to four limit positions (the four corners) to avoid interference with the piercing probe and blocking ring.]
Check the tube rotatory scanning mechanism (Applicable
Cross-headed screwdriver
the
which compress the tubes and see whether
Tube racks
configured
they can rotate smoothly; if the pulleys are
Lubricating oil
with barcode scanning
rusted by liquid and cannot move, use
assembly only)
lubricating oil to lubricate the inside of driven
instrument
to
Check the drive pulley, driven 1) Open the front cover of the instrument; pulley and slide rail 2) Use hands to rotate the two driven pulleys
pulleys and make sure that they can move easily. After service, clean the lubricating oil on the outer ring of driven pulleys, otherwise the barcode may get soiled; 3) Use a hand to drag forward and backward the support fixing the driven pulley, and feel if the linear slide rail can move smoothly; if you feel obvious friction, the slide rail may be rusted, and you need to use lubricating oil to lubricate
10-8
Limit position
Maintenance
it; 4) Tap
--- to enter the autoloading assembly self-test screen. Tap to load the tube rack to the scanning position. Tap and check if the tube can be steadily rotated; if not, finely tune the drive pulley position to the direction of main unit Check
the
tube
detection sensor status (Applicable
to
instrument
Check the tube detection sensor status
1) Make sure that there are no tube racks on the load tray;
the
2) Tap
not
, select the [Tube Detection
configured
with
a
Sensor] tab. Tap , and observe the
barcode
scanning
blank voltage change rate. If the change rate
assembly only)
is greater than 1.1 or smaller than 0.9, tap , and then tap .
Check
the
tube
detection sensor status (Applicable
to
instrument
the
Check the tube detection sensor status
1) Make sure that there are no tube racks on the load tray
not
2) Tap , select the [Tube Detection
configured
with
a
Sensor] tab. Tap , and observe the
barcode
scanning
blank voltage change rate. If the change rate
assembly only)
is greater than 1.1 or smaller than 0.9, tap , and then tap .
10-9
Maintenance
Inspection Item
Maintenance
Note
Tools and Consumables
Verify the sample probe
Verify
the
sample
probe
position in the reaction
position in the reaction bath
bath
[Procedure: Select "Service" → "Debug&Self-test" → "Adj. Sample Probe Pos. ", and tap WNB bath pos., DIFF bath pos. and RET bath pos. (if configured with the RET module) respectively, and check the probe position in each bath. For the DIFF/RET bath, the probe shall fall in the centre of the bath; but for the WNB bath, the probe should be about 2.5mm from the center of the bath.
Check the HGB and optical
reaction
bubble mixing tube
bath
Check the HGB and optical reaction bath bubble mixing tube
instrument; 2) Take off the HGB bath shield cover;
Check the HGB and optical reaction bath bubble mixing and
1) Open the front cover and right plate of the
liquid
function
discharging
3) Check the bubble mixing tube which is connected to one channel of the 3-way connector under the HGB bath. The interior Teflon tube shall exceed the three-way connector for 4 mm. 4) Perform the measurement, and check if the bubble mixing in the HGB bath works OK, and the waste is discharged smoothly. 5) Follow the same procedure to check the optical reaction bath.
10-10
Cross-headed screwdriver
Notes
Maintenance
No.
Name
1
HGB bath shield
Inspection Item
FRU code
No. 2
Maintenance
Name
FRU code
Three-way pipe
Note
Tools and Consumables
Check tube of reagent
Check tube of reagent cap
cap assembly
assembly
1) Check and make sure the lyse and diluent tubes connected to the back plate of the analyzer are not bent nor leaking air. 2) Organize the tubes, and make sure they are not pressed or bent. 3) Check and make sure the fluorescent reagent tubes are properly connected.
10-11
/
Notes
Maintenance
No.
Name
1
Lyse and diluent connection
FRU code
No. 2
tubes
10-12
Name Dye connection tubes
FRU code
Maintenance
Inspection Item
Maintenance
Note
Tools and
Notes
Consumables Clean the crystal on the
Check for the crystal on the
solenoid valve
electromagnetic valve
1) Open the left and right doors and front cover of the instrument;
Cross-headed
2) Check for the crystal status on the Mindray valves in the fluidic system and clean the
Cleaning cloth
screwdriver
crystal Clean the crystal on the syringe
Clean the crystal on the syringe
1) Open the left and right doors and front cover of the instrument;
Cleaning cloth
Caution: 1) Clean the parts when
2) Check for the crystallization status at the bottom of the plungers of the 10ml syringe,
the crystallization is not
250ul syringe and 100ul syringe; in case of
large amount of crystal,
liquid
directly
leakage,
replace
the
syringe
assembly; if crystal is found, use a clean cloth to wipe it clean; 3) After cleaning, run several samples and check the syringe, making sure there is no liquid leakage.
10-13
serious. When there is
parts.
replace
the
Maintenance
No. 1 2
Name
FRU code
10ml syringe 250ul syringe
10-14
No.
Name
3
100ul syringe
FRU code
Maintenance
Inspection Item
Maintenance
Note
Tools and
Notes
Consumables Maintain the pinch valve
Check and maintain the pinch
1)
Open the left and right doors of the instrument;
Cross-headed
tube
valve tube
2)
Release the pressure of the pressure chamber;
screwdriver
3)
Check the silica gel pinch valve tubes connected to valves PV01-PV07; make sure that the tubes are all OK, with no leakage or damage. If the tubes are all OK, adjust the pinching position as required. (Note the PV05 and PV06 are wearing parts, and need to be replaced regularly)
No.
Name
1
PV01/02/03/04/07
2
PV05
FRU code
10-15
No.
Name
3
PV06
FRU code
Maintenance
Inspection Item
Maintenance
Note
Tools and Consumables
Clean
the
piercing
probe, probe wipe and probe wipe barrier
Clean
the
outer
wall
of
piercing probe Clean the upper and lower end faces of probe wipe Clean the probe wipe barrier
1) Disconnect the diluent and waste tubes to the probe wipe;
Cross-head
2) Unscrew the screw on the upper surface of the probe wipe and take down the probe wipe;
Tweezers
3) Drop some drops of Probe Cleanser on the
Probe Cleanser
bloodstain at the upper and lower end faces of probe wipe, and soak the bloodstain for about 3 minutes; 4) Use clean water to clean the probe wipe; 5) Use a piece of cleaning cloth dipped with Probe Cleanser to wipe the exterior wall of the sample probe. Soak the exterior wall of the sample probe for about 3 minutes, then clean the sample probe exterior wall with clean water. 6) Put the probe wipe back on the rack and connect the tube; 7) Dip a cotton swab into Probe Cleanser, and use the cotton swab to wipe the upper and lower end faces and inner ring of probe wipe barrier, Soak the probe wipe barrier for about 3 minutes, and then clean it wall with clean water. Note There are probe wipe barriers at both autoloading piercing position and at the closed-sampling piercing position (for closed-sampling type analyzers/open-sampling position (for the opensampling type analyzers)
10-16
screwdriver Cleaning cloth Cotton swab
Notes
Maintenance
8) After
the
above
cleaning
operation,
run
background tests for 3 to 5 times, and make sure that the probe cleanser attached to the probe wipe and sampling probe is cleaned;
10-17
Maintenance
No.
Name
FRU code
No.
Name
FRU code
1
Diluent tube
3001-10-07069
4
Probe wipe
041-023727-00
2
Waste tube
M90-100071---
5
Piercing probe
115-033912-00
3
Screw
6
Probe wipe barrier
Inspection Item
Maintenance
Note
Tools and
Notes
Consumables Replace the diluent filter
Replace the diluent filter
[Steps: 1. Remove the old filter (be careful when
/
handling the residue liquid in the tube, and make sure it is not sprayed to other positions). 2. Install a new filter (pay attention to the installation direction: the filter
Flow direction
has the Filter mark on it, and the liquid is supposed to flow in the direction from letter "F" to letter "r")] Check piercing probe
Check for the piercing probe
Power off the instrument, use a hand to push the
abrasion status
abrasion status
piercing probe out of the probe wipe, and check the wear condition of the outer wall of piercing probe; if the wear condition is found severe, replace the piercing probe
Clean the covers of the
Clean the crystals and dust on
HGB bath, RBC bath
the covers of the HGB bath,
and optical reaction bath
RBC bath and optical reaction bath
1) 2)
Use a cross-head screwdriver to open the right
Cross-head
door of the instrument;
screwdriver
Use a cotton swab dipped with water or alcohol
Cotton swab
to wipe the HGB bath cover, RBC bath cover and upper part of optical reaction bath
10-18
Maintenance
No.
Name
1
HGB bath cover
2
Optical reaction bath
Inspection Item
FRU code
Maintenance
No.
Name
3
RBC bath cover
Note
FRU code
Tools and Consumables
Lubricate parts
the moving
Check and lubricate the moving
1)
parts
Check the movements of the loading unit,
Cross-headed
feeding unit and unloading unit during sample
screwdriver
autoloading process. Use a small amount of
Lubricating
grease to lubricate guide rail and wheel shaft. 2)
Check movements of the sample compartment assembly and the piercing assembly, and take 10-19
grease
Notes
Maintenance
a small amount of grease to lubricate the guide rail and wheel shaft. 3)
Check for the motion of syringe assembly and lubricate linear motor lead screw.
Check and replace the
Check and replace the wearing
Check and replace the wearing parts by referring to
wearing parts
parts
the content in the replacement list of wearing parts. For details, see below table.
Table 10-3 List of wearing parts No. 1 2
Name Piercing probe and probe wipe Pinch valve tubes to PV05 and PV06 (pharmed pinch valve tubes)
FRU code
Position In the sample probe assembly on the middle baffle
Service Life 100,000 times
Left side of the instrument, on the back plate
60,000 times/1 year
3
Probe wipe filter
Left side of the instrument, on the back plate
60,000 times/1 year
4
Waste filter
Left side of the instrument, on the back plate
60,000 times/1 year
5
Sheath fluid filter
On the upper part of the left plate of the analyzer
45,000 times/1 year
6
Air pump
On the right plate of the analyzer
2000H
10-20
Notes Piercing times
Maintenance
No.
Name
1 2
No.
Name
Waste filter
3
Sheath fluid filter
Probe wipe filter
4
Air pump
Inspection Item
FRU code
Maintenance
Note
FRU code
Tools and Consumables
Perform Probe Cleanser
Perform
maintenance
maintenance to WC1 and WC2.
to
the
Probe
Cleanser
1)
Log in with a service account, and tap "Service"-"Maintenance"-"Fluidics"-"WC
waste cistern
Cistern Time-based Maintenance".
Follow
the software instruction and pour a whole bottle of Probe Cleanser into WC2. 2)
Add diluent to the WC2 cistern till the cistern is full;
3)
Remove a pipe connected to the WC1 cistern cover, and add diluent to the cistern till the
10-21
Syringe Probe Cleanser Tweezers
Notes
Maintenance
cistern is full; 4)
Leave the instrument alone for 40 minutes. The
instrument
cleaning.
10-22
automatically
performs
Maintenance
10.2.3 Check the Instrument Status Check the overall instrument status. Conduct the check according to the following table in every visit. Inspection Item
Description
Reference
Result
Notes
120KPa
110~125 kPa
□Pass
□Fail
/
90KPa
90±5 kPa
□Pass
□Fail
/
Analyzer pressure
50KPa
500±5 kPa
□Pass
□Fail
/
status
-30KPa
-30±5 kPa
□Pass
□Fail
/
-40kPa
-40±5 kPa
□Pass
□Fail
/
Fluid pressure
50~120 kPa
□Pass
□Fail
/
Optical system
31~38 °C
□Pass
□Fail
/
SPMT
31~38 °C
□Pass
□Fail
/
40~43 °C
□Pass
□Fail
/
RET reaction bath
40~43 °C
□Pass
□Fail
/
Preheating bath
29~34 °C
□Pass
□Fail
/
RBC diluent
12~36 °C
□Pass
□Fail
/
Instrument
12~36 °C
□Pass
□Fail
/
CPU temperature
0~100 °C
□Pass
□Fail
/
HGB blank
3.20~4.80V
□Pass
□Fail
Adjustable
2.10~2.60V
□Pass
□Fail
Adjustable
Whether they are
Not bent or
□Pass
□Fail
/
bent, damaged or
damaged, free
□Pass
□Fail
/
□Pass
□Fail
/
□Pass
□Fail
/
temperature WBC reaction bath
Analyzer temperature
temperature HGB blank voltage
voltage value Sensor Level
Fluorescent
Settings
reagent detect sensor
Power network
cord, cable,
reagent tubes
having
of bubbles
inside No
Waste tube
bubbles
crystal
and
No crystal and
blockage in the
blockage
tube Air whether
leakage, the
No air leakage, the
diluent floater
diluent
sensor
sensor
Reagent container
floater
moves
moves
tube cap assembly
smoothly,
and
smoothly, and
whether
the
the
Barcode scanner
sensor
sensor connectors
connectors do
get loose
not get loose
Whether
the
The scanning is
scanning
is
normal and the 10-23
Maintenance
normal
and the
operation
is
operation
is
standard
standard
10.2.4 Confirm the General Performance of the Instrument Run the controls of high, normal and low values on the instrument, and check if the QC results are in control. If not, calibrate the instrument. Do the background and repeatability tests to confirm that the instrument performance, status and graph are all normal. If not, perform necessary debugging and calibration (if needed) Inspection Item
Description
Reference
WBC
≤ 0.1 10 / L
□Pass
□Fail
WBC-D
9
≤ 0.2 10 / L
□Pass
□Fail
12
□Pass
□Fail
12
Background and
RBC
blank counting requirements-
test requirements-
≤ 0.02 10 / L
Result
RBC-O
≤ 0.02 10 / L
□Pass
□Fail
HGB
≤ 1 g/L
□Pass
□Fail
PLT
≤ 5 10 /L
□Pass
□Fail
PLT-O
≤ 5 10 /L
□Pass
□Fail
9
≤ 0.001 10 /L
□Pass
□Fail
≤ 0.003 10 /L
□Pass
□Fail
1000 ~ 6000
□Pass
□Fail
□Pass
□Fail
□Pass
□Fail
blood
Background/blank
Value
9
9 9
WBC-BF/ TC-BF RBC-BF
12
body fluid Standard particle
Total
number
of
particles WNB FS center of gravity DIFF FS center of gravity
480.0~615.0 480.0~615.0
WNB FS CV
≤ 2.5%
□Pass
□Fail
DIFF FS CV
≤ 3.2%
□Pass
□Fail
□Pass
□Fail
DIFF SS center of gravity
998.0~1350.0
DIFF SS CV
≤ 19.0%
□Pass
□Fail
WNB SS CV
≤ 19.0%
□Pass
□Fail
/
□Pass
□Fail
/
□Pass
□Fail
/
□Pass
□Fail
□Pass
□Fail
WNB channel
Graph are normal and in proper position
Fresh blood
DIFF Channel
Graph are
samples
normal and in
scattergram
proper position RET Channel
Graph are normal and in proper position
Repeatability -
WBC
≤ 2.5%
10-24
Notes
Maintenance
whole blood
RBC
≤ 1.5%
□Pass
□Fail
HGB
≤ 1.0% very
□Pass
□Fail
poor ≤ 3
Repeatability -
MCV
≤ 1.0%
□Pass
□Fail
HCT
≤ 1.5%
□Pass
□Fail
PLT
≤ 4.0%
□Pass
□Fail
□Pass
□Fail
□Pass
□Fail
WBC-BF/ TC-BF
≤ 30%
body fluid RBC-BF
≤ 40% or range ≤ 7000/μL
10.2.5 Data Backup and Export
Be sure to export the client sample size data after active maintenance is completed. Requirements:
Export one-year's data to the maintenance date.
Upload the exported sample statistics to the CRM system.
You can use the following methods to export data:
Use a USB drive to export data:
Note to insert the USB drive first. 1
Enter the "Status" - "Statistics" screen. Tap the "Summary" button.
2
Tap “Export”.
Scan the 2D QR code to export data
It is recommended to use the QR Reader+ APP (For the iOS system, search and download the APP in the Apple Store; for the Android system, search and download it using the web browser) to your mobile phone for QR code scan. 1
Enter the "Status" - "Statistics" screen. Tap the "QR code" button.
10-25
Maintenance
The software generates a QR code. 2
Open the QR Reader+ APP and scan the QR code.
The following information displays.
10-26
Maintenance
a b
MATMSG
The email must be sent to: [email protected]; you cannont
To
change the email address
SUB
The subject of the email message, in the format of XXXXXXXXX-YYYYMM-DD (XXXXXXXXX indicating the analyzer serial number, YYYY-MM-DD indicating the export date.
c
Body
Main body of the message; manually enter the Country, City, Hospital information
d 3
Body
The coded data
Tap “Send email” on the APP to enter the “send email message” interface.
10-27
Maintenance
4
Enter necessary information such as “Country”, “City” and “Hospital”, and send the message to [email protected].
The encrypted message can be decrypted by ConvertDataTool. When using other QR code scan apps other than QR Reader+ APP, you may need to open your own mailbox, create a new message, manually copy the encrypted information to the message, and send it to [email protected].
10-28
Maintenance
10.3 Standard Operation Procedures of QC and Calibration 10.3.1 Quality Control Quality Control (QC) consists of strategies and procedures that measure the precision and stability of the analyzer. The results imply the reliability of the sample results. QC involves measuring materials with known, stable characteristics at frequent intervals. Analysis of the results with statistical methods allows the inference that sample results are reliable. Mindray recommends you run the QC program daily with normal level controls. A new lot of controls should be analyzed in parallel with the current lot prior to their expiration dates. This may be accomplished by running the new lot of controls for five days using any empty QC files. The QC files Calculate the mean, standard deviation and coefficient of variation for each selected parameter. The instrument calculated means of these ten runs should be within the expected ranges published by the manufacturer. For the quality control requirements and methods, see the Chapter "Using the QC Program" in the Operator's Manual.
10.3.2 Calibration Calibration is a procedure to standardize the analyzer by determining its deviation under certain specified conditions. In order to get accurate sample analysis results, calibrate the analyzer when necessary. For the calibration requirements and methods, refer to "Calibrating Your Analyzer" in the Operator's Manual.
10.3.3 Mixing Methods of Mindray Self-made Quality Controls and Calibrator Storage requirements The controls and calibrators should be stored in a refrigerator at about 2~8°C. Before use 1
Always check for the validity of the reagents before use. Never use a reagent that is beyond its expiry date. After taking the reagent out from the refrigerator, keep it still for at least 15 minutes at room temperature before mixing.
2
Record the open-vial date on the vial label for every newly opened vial of control/calibrator, so you can track whether the reagent has passed its open-vial validity.
Mixing method After keep the control/calibrator for 15 minutes at room temperature, follow below instruction to 10-29
Maintenance
mix it. Follow the time requirements in each step when mixing the reagent. And for each single vial of reagent, the whole mixing procedure should last for at least 5 minutes. 1
Keep the vial cap upward, and use two hands to rub it slowly and repeatedly for 1.5 to 2 minutes.
Figure 10-1 Keep the vial cap upward 2
Keep the vial cap downward, and use two hands to rub slowly and repeatedly for 1.5 to 2 minutes.
Figure 10-2 Keep the vial cap downward 3
Place the vial flat (parallel to the ground) between your hands, and rub slowly and repeatedly for 1.5~2 minutes.
Figure 10-3 Vial parallel to the ground 4
Keep the reagent vial upside down after mixing and check the vial bottom. It should meet the requirements shown in Figure 10-4. If not, continue to mix it, till it reaches the standard.
10-30
Maintenance
Poor mixing: the bottom of the vial is still covered by reagent residue, and there is no obvious transparent ring belt.
Good mixing: there should be no large and opaque black residues at the bottom of the vial; and there is a transparent reagentfree residue belt.
Figure 10-4 Comparison of good and poor mixing effects 5
Each time after running the control/calibrator, cap the vial as soon as possible to reduce the contact between the reagent and the air. Otherwise the reagent will get volatilized and resulting in inaccurate results.
6
When the mixing procedure is completely, before each test cycle, shake the vial gently.
7
If during or after a set of tests (including calibration tests and repeatability tests), the reagent has been kept for still for more than 5 minutes, if you are use it again, follow the instruction in step 4 to check for its status. Use it only when it meets the requirements. Otherwise mix it again.
Note Always place the controls and calibrators back to the refrigerator after work (either at noon, afternoon, or night). Before next use, the reagent should be kept in the refrigerator for at least 1 hour. During tests, never leave the reagent uncapped when it is not used. Otherwise the reagent will get volatilized and resulting in concentration change and inaccurate results. After the mixing procedure, do not mix the vials violently during tests. Excessive mixing also may result in inaccurate test results. Gently shake the control/calibrator for each test cycle. The open-vial validity for controls is 14 days at 2~8°C in a refrigerator, and the open-vial validity for calibrators is 7 days at 2~8°C in a refrigerator. Do not use the controls/calibrators which pass the validity period.
10-31
Chapter 11 Troubleshooting Information 11.1 Introduction At present, the fault prompt in the 6000 series instruments is mainly found in two places, as shown in Figure 11-1: the Message prompt area on the right of the screen, including the WBC Message, RBC Message and PLT Message; the fault alarm area at the lower part of the screen, which aims to distinguish the sample problems and instrument faults.
Message area
Error area
Figure 11-1 Fault display areas The Message area displays three types of messages: insufficient suction, plugging and HGB channel exception. The insufficient suction message is displayed in the WBC Message area, and the plugging and HGB channel exception messages are displayed in the RBC Message area. There are two main faults sources in the Message area: the test results identified by the algorithm are abnormal, the user needs to be prompted, and the warning message will be given in the Message area; an exception is found through signal detection, e.g., the sample suction pressure curve is found faulty during sample suction, and possibly a clot in the blood sample blocks the sample suction needle, which is not a fault of the instrument, so it is displayed in the Message area. The fault area is used to display the fault of the instrument such as the pressure, temperature fault and reagent depletion, which requires the user to perform some operations or the service personnel to provide on-site repair service. The fault area displays the alarm faults. When you tap the fault area, the fault code, fault summary and fault details (fault details can only be viewed 11-1
Troubleshooting Information
by the operator with the user service permission or above) will be displayed. The fault can be handled or repair can be conducted accordingly so long as the fault generation conditions and possible causes are clear. The fault display mode in the fault area is shown in Figure 11-2.
Error code Error summary
Error details
Figure 11-2 Fault codes and detailed breakdown information
11-2
Troubleshooting Information
11.2 Message Area Codes 11.2.1 Reagent Type Detection principle The reagent detection principle is the same for lyse and diluent. As shown in Figure 11-3, when the reagent flows in the detection tube, the sensor detects whether there is reagent in the detection tube by optical signals. When there is no reagent or bubbles pass through the detection tube, the detection sensor will detect the change of signal and send an alarm. The availability detection principle of fluorescent dye liquor detection is similar to that of lyse. The difference is that no lyse tube is used in fluorescent dye liquor detection, and the detection sensor detects the dye liquor pipe directly. Detection sensor
Tubing
Detection tube
Reagent container
Figure 11-3 Principle of reagent detection Errors for reagents consist of no reagent error, reagent insufficient error, and reagents need to be replaced or primed after being reloaded, and reagents expired error. Error codes and error report mechanism
No reagent alarm Table 11-1 No reagent error messages Error ID
Error message
0x32060010
No DS reagent
0x32060011
No LD Lyse
0x32060012
No LH Lyse
0x32060013
No LN Lyse
0x32060014
No DR Diluent
0x32060015
No FN Dye
Error report mechanism
Reagent detection board detects bubbles or no reagent in DS diluent detection tube.
The sensor of the corresponding channel cannot
11-3
Troubleshooting Information
0x32060016
No FD Dye
detect dye liquor in the pipe or detects that bubbles
0x32060017
No FR reagent
flow through the pipe.
When the instrument reports no reagent error, check the corresponding reagent container or bag and see if there is really no reagent. When there is still reagent (the very little reagent left at the bottom of the container/bag which cannot be aspirated does not count), directly tap "Remove Error". If there is no reagent, install a new reagent container/bag, and reload the reagent by scanning the barcode information. If the error cannot be removed, possible causes include: the corresponding reagent tube leaks (air leakage will lead to air bubbles in the tube), the reagent tube connector is broken, the detection tube is not connected properly to the reagent detection, cables to the reagent detection board is not connected reliably, and the reagent detection board is damaged. The difference between the "no reagent" error and the "insufficient reagent" is, when a no reagent error is reported, the software-calculated reagent volume is usually not deducted to zero. Therefore when no reagent errors are reported, directly tap "Remove Error" to remove the errors (no need to reload the reagent by scanning barcode information).
Reagent expired errors Table 11-2 Reagent expired error messages Error ID
Error message
0x32060020
DS Diluent expired
0x32060021
LD Lyse expired
0x32060022
LH Lyse expired
0x32060023
LN Lyse expired
0x32060024
DR Diluent expired
0x32060025
FN Dye expired
0x32060026
FD Dye expired
0x32060027
FR Dye expired
Error report mechanism
The reagent validity countdown starts at user registering the reagent information to the analyzer by scanning the reagent barcode. The analyzer reports error when a reagent passes its open-vial validity period or the expiry date.
When the analyzer reports the reagent expired errors, even the reagent is not actually used up, to remove the error, new barcode information needs to be registered, of a reagent that is the same type and is never used on the instrument.
Insufficient reagent Table 11-3 Insufficient reagent errors Error ID
Error message
Error report mechanism
0x32060030
DS Diluent low volume
When a reagent is newly registered, the
0x32060031
LD Lyse low volume
software refreshes the reagent initial volume,
0x32060032
LH Lyse low volume
and each time a sequence is run, the software
0x32060033
LN Lyse low volume
reducts the corresponding consumption. When
0x32060034
DR Diluent low volume
the total consumption reaches the threshold, 11-4
Troubleshooting Information
0x32060035
FN Dye low volume
0x32060036
FD Dye low volume
0x32060037
FR Dye low volume
the analyzer reports error.
Insufficient reagent errors are reported when the software calculated reagent residue volume is deducted to zero. To remove the error, new barcode information needs to be registered, of a reagent that is the same type and is never used on the instrument.
Reagent has not been replaced error Table 11-4 Reagent has not been replaced error messages Error ID 0x32060040
Error message
Error report mechanism
DS Diluent has not been replaced
0x32060041
LD Lyse has not been replaced
0x32060042
LH Lyse has not been replaced
0x32060043
LN Lyse has not been replaced
0x32060044
DR Diluent has not been replaced
0x32060045
FN Dye has not
The error is reported when the customer registers a new and valid reagent on the software. Tap "Remove Error" and the analyzer will automatically replace the reagents in the instrument and removes the error.
been replaced 0x32060046
FD Dye has not been replaced
0x32060047
FR Dye has not been replaced
The error is reported when the customer registers a new and valid reagent on the software. Tap "Remove Error" and the analyzer will automatically replace the reagents in the instrument and removes the error.
Reagent not primed errors Table 11-5 Reagent not primed error messages Error ID 0x32060050
Error message DS
reagent
not
primed 0x32060051
LD LH primed
The error is reported when a certain reagent passes its expiry date, and the customer registers
Lyse
not
primed 0x32060052
Error report mechanism
a new and valid reagent on the software.
Tap
"Remove Error" and the analyzer will automatically Lyse
not
prime the instrument with the reagent and removes the error. 11-5
Troubleshooting Information
0x32060053
LN
Lyse
not
Diluent
not
primed 0x32060054
DR
primed 0x32060055
FN Dye not primed
0x32060056
FD Dye not primed
0x32060057
FR Dye not primed
The error is reported when a certain reagent passes its expiry date, and the customer registers a new and valid reagent on the software.
Tap "Remove Error" and the analyzer will
automatically prime the instrument with the reagent and removes the error. Different between reagent priming and reagent replacing: when priming the instrument with the reagents, the expired reagent in the cisterns and tubes will be completely discharged first, and then the new reagent will be absorbed from the new reagent container/bag; while when replacing the reagent, the old reagent in the cisterns and tubes will not be discharged; the instrument directly absorbs the reagent from the reagent container/bag to fill the cisterns or tubes.
11.2.2 Waste-Related Errors Detection principle The waste error is detected by the floater sensor. When the floater ball is at the lower position, the sensor is at "on" position; and when the floater ball is at the upper position, the sensor is at "off" position. The system thus determines the liquid level in the waste container by the sensor status.
Floater rod
Floater ball
Waste container
Figure 11-4 Waste liquid level detection principle
11-6
Troubleshooting Information
Error codes and error report mechanism Table 11-6 Waste container full error Error ID
Error message
Error report mechanism When the waste in the waste container has
0x32060001
Waste
container
full
reached a certain level, the floater ball floater upward, and the sensor status changes and triggers error report.
To remove the waste container error, empty the waste container first, and then tap "Remove Error" on the software. To avoid false report of this error, install the waste container in a carton box, and use a supporting board to lock the mouth of the container and prevent the container from collapsing (when the container collapses, the analyzer will report the error even when the waste is not half the container). When the waste container full error cannot be removed, check for the following possible causes: the floater ball or rod get stuck; the BNC connector at the back of the instrument are not properly connected; and the floater is damaged. When the instrument is set to direct discharge of waste, the error will not be reported. Select Menu Settings Auxiliary Settings Other Settings, and check if the "Enable waste direct discharge" is enabled. When the customer is using waste containers, make sure the option is not checked. Otherwise even if the BNC connector is properly connected, the analyzer will not monitor waste level, or give any alarm...
Figure 11-5 Enable direct discharge of waste 11-7
Troubleshooting Information
11.2.3 Floater-Related Errors Detection principle Floater sensors are also used in the reagent cisterns, waste cisterns and air cell. The working principle is the same as for the waste cistern. Error codes and error report mechanism Table 11-7 Float error messages Error ID 0x32060070 0x32060071
Error message DIL
floater
Error report mechanism
status
abnormal FCM
floater
status
At the time points that the time sequence
abnormal
judges a certain cistern is about to full, the
0x32060072
LD floater status abnormal
system inquiries if the floater ball in that
0x32060073
LH floater status abnormal
cistern is at the upper position. If not, the
0x32060074
LN floater status abnormal
analyzer reports error.
0x32060076 0x32060076
0x32060077
0x32060078
DR
floater
status
abnormal WC1
floater
status
abnormal WC2
At the time points that the time sequence judges WC1/WC2 has been emptied, the
floater
status
abnormal
system inquiries if the floater ball in that cistern is at the lower position. If not, the analyzer reports error.
-40kPa air cell floater
Theoretically, the floater balls in -40kPa and
status abnormal
90kPa air cells should always be at their lower position. The software inquires the air cell floater status every second. When it detects the floater ball are not the lower
0x32060079
90kPa
air
cell
status abnormal
floater
position for 5 consecutive times, the analyzer reports error. When the floater in an air cells is not at lower position, it indicates there is liquid flowing back to the chambers.
Usually the reagent cistern floater errors can be removed by tapping "Remove Error". If the error cannot be removed, check whether there is reagent in the corresponding reagent container, whether the reagent tube is pressed or folded; or if the outlet tube of cistern leaks liquid. When all the above factors are excluded, check whether the floater sensor is damaged. Usually the WC1/WC2 floater errors can be removed by tapping "Remove Error". If the error cannot be removed, check whether the waste discharge tube get clogged, whether a tube is pressed or folded; or whether the floater ball and the rod are stuck together. When all the above 11-8
Troubleshooting Information
factors are excluded, check whether the floater sensor is damaged. For the -40kPa and 90kPa air cell floater errors, check whether there is any liquid in the air cell. If there is liquid, manually clear the liquid, and then tap "remove Error". If there is no liquid in the air cell but the error cannot be removed, check whether the air cell floater sensor line is connected reliably to the floater connector (if the floater is not connected to sensor, the instrument will report the floater status abnormal of the air cell). When all the above factors are excluded, check whether the floater sensor is damaged. Select "Menu" "Status" "Floater Status" to check the floater status in each baths, waste cisterns and waste container and that in the air cells. While "Empty" means that the floater ball is at the lower position, and "Full" means that the floating ball is at the upper position. Tap on the screen to test all floaters except for the floaters of the -40kPa air cell, 90 kPa air cell and the waste container. Use this function when it is absolutely necessary, as the procedure will consume reagents, and will take approximately 30 minutes.
Figure 11-6 Floater status screen
11.2.4 Syringe Type Detection principle There are 3 types of syringes, namely ASP syringe (100uL), SP syringe (250uL) and DIL syringe (10mL). Each syringe consists of one motor and one home position sensor. The system determines whether the syringe operates normally by monitoring the syringe aspiration amount, discharge amount, action time as well as the sensor status. Every time a syringe resets, the software starts to record and accumulate the aspiration amount 11-9
Troubleshooting Information
and from which, it deducts the dispensed liquid amount. For example, if the syringe performs three aspiration actions (aspirated amount being a1, a2 and a3 respectively), and two dispensed actions (dispensed amount being b1 and b2 respectively). Then, the amount of residual liquid in the syringe is v = a1+a2+a3-b1-b2. Firstly, v cannot be a negative value; otherwise the software will report "xx syringe dispensed volume too high", meaning that the total dispensed volume has exceeded the total aspirated volume, which is not acceptable. Secondly, v cannot exceed the maximum capacity of syringe; otherwise the software will report "xx syringe aspirated volume too high". Error codes and error report mechanism As long as the instrument has undergone the normal startup procedure (startup initialization is not skipped), the errors of "Conflicting XX syringe action", "XX syringe dispensed volume too high", "XX syringe aspirated volume too high" or "XX syringe action time out" are rarely reported. When any of these errors are reported, it often indicates time sequence errors or bugs. Syringe errors usually can be removed by tapping the "Remove Error" button. If the errors cannot be removed or after you remove the errors, they still frequently occur, check the following items: 1)
Check whether the cables connecting the motor and sensor of the corresponding syringe assembly are reliably connected; and whether there are liquid splashing or corrosion;
2)
Check whether the wiring to the motor and sensor is broken;
3)
Check whether the motor drive chip on the drive board is damaged;
4)
Check whether the rotating screw and the motor shaft gets slipping;
5)
Check whether the syringe plunger is bent and deformed.
ASP syringe (100 uL) errors
For users at administrator or common user level, all the following errors are displayed in the form of "ASP syringe action abnormal". Table 11-8 ASP syringe (100 uL) error messages Error ID
Error message
Error report mechanism This alarm will be triggered when the
0x32060131
Conflicting
ASP
syringe
actions
syringe is not initialized or is in the process of an action, while a new command is received.
0x32060132
0x32060133
0x32060134
Error
occurs
when
ASP
syringe leaves sensor area ASP syringe failed to return to home position ASP
The motor cannot drive the sensor blade to leave the sensor area home position during syringe initialization The motor cannot drive the sensor blade to the sensor area home position during syringe initialization
aspiration/dispensation
action failure 1
After
the
syringe
aspiration/dispensation
performs action,
the sensor
blade still blocks the home position sensor 11-10
Troubleshooting Information
while it should have already left the sensor detection area home position. After 0x32060135
ASP
aspiration/dispensation
action failure 2
the
syringe
aspiration/dispensation
performs action,
the sensor
blade dose not block the sensor while it should have returned to the sensor detection area. Before
ASP 0x32060136
syringe
aspiration/dispensation action not allowed 1
syringe
aspiration/dispensation
performs action,
system
detects that the sensor is blocked, but based on the system recorded syringe motor steps, the sensor should not be blocked. Before
ASP 0x32060137
syringe
syringe
aspiration/dispensation
performs action,
system
aspiration/dispensation action
detects that the sensor is not blocked, but
not allowed 2
based on the system recorded syringe motor steps, the sensor should be blocked. Before the syringe action, the software detects the total residue liquid volume after
0x32060138
ASP syringe aspirated volume too high
the
aspiration
action
exceeds
the
maximum capacity set for the syringe. This fault should not occur at the client site. If it occurs, it is the most likely a time sequence design problem. The actual action time used by the syringe is greater than the set time of time
0x32060139
ASP syringe action time out
sequence. This fault should not occur at the client. If it occurs, it is the most likely a time sequence design problem. Before the syringe action, the software detects the total residue liquid volume after
0x32060140
ASP syringe aspirated volume
the aspiration action is a negative value.
too high
This fault should not occur at the client site. If it occurs, it is the most likely a time sequence design problem.
SP syringe (250uL) alarm
For users at administrator or common user level, all the following errors are displayed in the form of "SP syringe action abnormal".
11-11
Troubleshooting Information
Table 11-9 SP syringe (250uL) error messages Error ID
Error message
Error report mechanism This alarm will be triggered when the
0x32060151
syringe is not initialized or is in the process
SP syringe action conflict
of an action, while a new command is received.
0x32060152
0x32060153
SP syringe failed to leave the initial position
The motor cannot drive the sensor blade to leave the sensor area home position during syringe initialization
SP syringe failed to return to the initial position
The motor cannot drive the sensor blade to the sensor area home position during syringe initialization After
0x32060154
SP syringe suction action failure 1
the
syringe
aspiration/dispensation
performs action,
the sensor
blade still blocks the home position sensor while it should have already left the sensor detection area home position. After
0x32060155
SP syringe suction action failure 2
the
syringe
aspiration/dispensation
performs action,
the sensor
blade dose not block the sensor while it should have returned to the sensor detection area. Before
SP 0x32060156
syringe
aspiration/dispensation action not allowed (1)
syringe
aspiration/dispensation
performs action,
system
detects that the sensor is blocked, but based on the system recorded syringe motor steps, the sensor should not be blocked. Before
SP 0x32060157
syringe
syringe
aspiration/dispensation
performs action,
system
aspiration/dispensation action
detects that the sensor is not blocked, but
not allowed (2)
based on the system recorded syringe motor steps, the sensor should be blocked. Before the syringe action, the software detects the total residue liquid volume after
0x32060158
SP syringe aspirated volume too high
the
aspiration
action
exceeds
the
maximum capacity set for the syringe. This fault should not occur at the client site. If it occurs, it is the most likely a time sequence design problem. The actual action time used by the syringe
0x32060159
SP syringe action time out
is greater than the set time of time sequence. This fault should not occur at the 11-12
Troubleshooting Information
client. If it occurs, it is the most likely a time sequence design problem. Before the syringe action, the software detects the total residue liquid volume after 0x32060160
SP syringe dispensed volume
the aspiration action is a negative value.
too high
This fault should not occur at the client site. If it occurs, it is the most likely a time sequence design problem.
DIL syringe (10 mL) alarm
For users at administrator or common user level, all the following errors are displayed in the form of "DIL syringe action abnormal". Table 11-10 DIL syringe (10 mL) error messages Error ID
Error message
Error report mechanism This alarm will be triggered when the
0x32060111
syringe is not initialized or is in the process
DIL syringe action conflict
of an action, while a new command is received. The motor cannot drive the sensor blade to
0x32060112
Conflicting DIL syringe actions
leave the sensor area home position during syringe initialization
0x32060113
DIL syringe failed to return to the initial position
The motor cannot drive the sensor blade to the sensor area home position during syringe initialization After
0x32060114
DIL
aspiration/dispensation
action failure 1
the
syringe
aspiration/dispensation
performs action,
the sensor
blade still blocks the home position sensor while it should have already left the sensor detection area home position. After
0x32060115
DIL
aspiration/dispensation
action failure 2
the
syringe
aspiration/dispensation
performs action,
the sensor
blade dose not block the sensor while it should have returned to the sensor detection area. Before
DIL 0x32060116
syringe
aspiration/dispensation action not allowed 1
syringe
aspiration/dispensation
performs action,
system
detects that the sensor is blocked, but based on the system recorded syringe motor steps, the sensor should not be blocked.
0x32060117
DIL
syringe
aspiration/dispensation action 11-13
Before
syringe
aspiration/dispensation
performs action,
system
Troubleshooting Information
not allowed 2
detects that the sensor is not blocked, but based on the system recorded syringe motor steps, the sensor should be blocked. Before the syringe action, the software detects the total residue liquid volume after
0x32060118
DIL syringe aspirated volume too high
the
aspiration
action
exceeds
the
maximum capacity set for the syringe. This fault should not occur at the client site. If it occurs, it is the most likely a time sequence design problem. The actual action time used by the syringe is greater than the set time of time
0x32060119
DIL syringe action time out
sequence. This fault should not occur at the client. If it occurs, it is the most likely a time sequence design problem. Before the syringe action, the software detects the total residue liquid volume after
0x32060120
DIL syringe dispensed volume
the aspiration action is a negative value.
too high
This fault should not occur at the client site. If it occurs, it is the most likely a time sequence design problem.
11.2.5 Sampling Assembly-related Errors Detection principle The sampling assembly enables the sample probe to move in both horizontal and vertical directions. The sampling assembly has a motor and a home position sensor in the vertical direction (Z-axis direction), and a motor, a home position sensor and a position verification sensor in the horizontal direction (Y-axis direction). The system determines whether the action is normal by the sampling assembly location, moving distance and sensor status. Error codes and error report mechanism As long as the instrument has undergone the normal startup procedure (startup initialization is not skipped), the errors of "Conflicting command to sampling assembly", "XX syringe dispensed volume too high", "Sampling assembly actions in horizontal direction time out" or "Sampling assembly actions in vertical direction time out" are rarely reported. When any of these errors are reported, it often indicates time sequence errors or bugs If the system reports "Sampling assembly failed to return to home position in vertical direction", "Sampling assembly failed to leave home position in vertical direction", "Sampling assembly failed to leave home position in horizontal direction" or "Sampling assembly failed to return to home position in horizontal direction", note to check whether the corresponding motor (in vertical or horizontal directions) makes a sound of being blocked. If not, check as follows: 1) Check whether the connectors of the motor cable and the patching cords are reliably 11-14
Troubleshooting Information
connected, and if the connector and transfer line connector are connected reliably, and if liquid splashing or corrosion at the connectors; 2) Check whether the motor cables are broken or damaged; 3) Check whether the drive on the drive board is damaged If the corresponding vertical motor or horizontal motor makes a sound of being blocked, in addition to the above procedures, also follow below instructions: 1) Find the position where the mechanism gets stuck, e.g., whether the screw gets loose and is too long, and if it hooks on or hits the rubber hose; 2) Check whether the connectors of the home position sensor and the patching cords are reliably connected, and if the connector and transfer line connector are connected reliably, and if liquid splashing or corrosion at the connectors; 3) Check whether the corresponding home position sensor cable is broken or damaged. When the system reports "Sampling assembly confirmation sensors in horizontal direction abnormally blocked" or "Sampling assembly notch count jumps in horizontal direction abnormal", check the following: 1) Whether the sample probe hooks on or hits the rubber hose during horizontal movement. 2) Whether the top and bottom surfaces of the sampling assembly horizontal position verification sensor are too close to the notched sheet metal; 3) Whether the connectors of the sensor and the patching cords are reliably connected, and if the sensor connector and transfer line connector are connected reliably, and if liquid splashing or corrosion at the connectors; 4) Whether the sensor cable is broken or damaged. If the system reports "Sample probe pierce action loses steps", check whether the probe tip making a small hole on the floating blood barrier at the piercing position of the autoloader. If not, the lock screw between the vertical motor rotation shaft and lead screw of sampling assembly gets loose; if there is a small hole on the blood barrier, operate as follows: 1) Check whether the bottom plate of autoloader is closely attached to the bottom plate of main unit; 2) Check whether the sample probe is bent; if yes, replace the sample probe first; 3) Remove the old floating blood barrier, tap -- to enter the sample probe adjustment screen. Select . Tap "Horizontal Pos." and then "Vertical Pos." under the "Position Observe" area, and check the sample probe position. When the sample probe is not aligned with the center of the tube position in the horizontal direction, tap "To Adjusted Pos." to adjust the sample probe position. 4) Install a new floating blood barrier, adjust the blocking plate of the floating blood barrier to the top position, and then adjust the floating blood barrier to the most front position and most back position respectively, tap on the sample probe adjustment screen AL aspiration position, and observe whether the probe tip will pierce the floating blood barrier.
11-15
Troubleshooting Information
For users at administrator or common user level, all the following errors are displayed in the form of "Sampling assembly action abnormal". Table 11-11 Sampling assembly error messages Error ID 0x32060201
Error message
Error report mechanism
Sampling assembly failed to
The motor in the vertical direction cannot
return to home position in
drive the sensor blade to the sensor area
vertical direction
home position.
Sampling assembly failed to 0x32060202
return to home position in vertical direction
0x32060203
0x32060204
drive the sensor blade to leave the sensor area
home
during
sampling
assembly initialization The motor in the horizontal direction cannot
return to home position in
drive the sensor blade to the sensor area
horizontal direction
home position in horizontal direction.
Sampling assembly failed to
The motor in the horizontal direction cannot
return to home position in
drive the sensor blade to leave the sensor
horizontal direction
area home position in horizontal direction. assembly
confirmation
sensors
horizontal
in
direction
abnormally blocked
After the
horizontal motor
completed,
Sampling count
assembly
the
sampling
action
is
assembly
confirmation sensor in horizontal direction is not at the gap position or not blocked. After the
0x32060206
position
Sampling assembly failed to
Sampling 0x32060205
The motor in the vertical direction cannot
horizontal motor
action
is
notch
completed, the number of notches detected
jumps in horizontal
by the sampling assembly confirmation
direction abnormal
sensor
in
horizontal
direction
is
inconsistent with expectation. When the vertical motor is returning to the 0x32060207
Sample probe pierce action loses steps
upper position, the system detects that the sensor barrier triggers the home position sensor in the vertical direction at an earlier time than expected. When the vertical motor is returning to the upper position, the system detects that the sensor barrier triggers the home position sensor in the vertical direction at a later time than expected
0x32060208
Sample probe lifting action loses steps
Usually the error won't be reported at the client site. If it is reported, possible causes include: ① The sample probe pierces in the not-forpuncturing area (e.g., the plastic area) of 11-16
Troubleshooting Information
tube, causing the sample probe becoming bent. ② the lock screw between the vertical motor rotation shaft and lead screw of sampling assembly gets loose. This alarm will be triggered when the 0x32060209
Conflicting
command
to
sampling assembly
sampling assembly is not initialized or is in the process of an action, while a new command is received. The actually consumed time of sampling assembly horizontal movement is greater
0x32060210
Sampling assembly horizontal
than the set time of time sequence. This
action time out
fault should not occur at the client site. If it occurs more frequently, it is the most likely a time sequence design problem. The actually consumed time of sampling assembly vertical movement is greater
0x32060211
Sampling assembly vertical
than the set time of time sequence. This
action time out
fault should not occur at the client site. If it occurs more frequently, it is the most likely a time sequence design problem. Before
horizontal
movement
of
the
sampling assembly, the system detects that the home position sensor in the vertical Vertical home position sensor 0x32060212
not blocked before sampling assembly
horizontal
movement
direction is not blocked. An alarm is reported as this may lead to bending of the sample probe. Usually the client does not report this fault. If it is reported, check if the connector of vertical home position sensor is connected, leaks liquid or gets corroded, and if the sensor wire is broken or damaged.
11.2.6 Mix Assembly-Related Type Detection principle The mix assembly mixes the samples upside down. The sampling assembly has a motor and a home position sensor in the vertical direction (Z-axis direction), and a motor, 2 sensors in the horizontal direction (Y-axis direction), and a motor and a sensor in the rotatory direction (R direction). The system determines whether the action is normal by the mix assembly location, moving distance and sensor status. For the Y direction sensor, the one close to the back plate of instrument is the home position sensor (or front sensor), and the end position sensor (or rear sensor) is near the front cover. 11-17
Troubleshooting Information
The lower position sensor is Z direction is the home position sensor and the upper position sensor is the end position sensor. Error codes and error report mechanism The most possible causes for mix assembly errors:
The tube gripper position in front-to-back or left-to-right directions become offset
A possible cause of this is that the autoloader is not installed closed to the main unit during installation, or the tube gripper position is not adjusted after the mix assembly is replaced, which makes the tube drops easily or causes the mix assembly to report error.
Liquid corrosion
As the mix assembly is located near the sampling assembly and the flow cell is right above it, once there is a damaged tube, or any tubes are not properly inserted, leaked liquid easily enters the mix assembly. If fluid infiltrates into the motor rotation shaft, it will inevitably cause the motor rotation shaft to rust. If the liquid enters the motor or the sensor cable connector, it will cause short circuit or corrosion of the connector; if the liquid enters the Y direction home position or end position sensor, the sensor will be damaged, and need to be replaced. If the liquid is sprinkled on the sensor detection surface, crystal will be formed on the sensor detection surface, and the sensor detection capability will be affected. In this case, use a cotton swab dipped in alcohol to clean the sensor detection surface.
Interference
When other objects (such as tubes) interfere with the mix assembly in its movement area, the system often will report error. When the cable tie of the sampling assembly faces the right of the instrument, the sampling assembly easily interferes with the mix assembly too.
Cable or core wires get damaged
Although the wire harness in the mix assembly uses swing resisting design, but if the harness is not bound or fixed correctly, the harness or the core wires may get broken. For users at administrator or common user level, all the following errors are displayed in the form of "Mix assembly action abnormal". Table 11-12 Mix assembly error messages Error ID
Error message
Error report mechanism This alarm will be triggered when the mix
0x32060221
Mixing mechanism is busy
assembly is not initialized or is in the mixing action while a new command is received.
When 0x32060280
the
tube
gripper
When the mix assembly is initialized or the
returns, the Y direction home
Y motor is reset, the system detects that
position sensor is mistakenly
the Y direction home position sensor
11-18
Troubleshooting Information
triggered
generates a wrong jump signal. The Y-direction motor cannot drive the
0x32060281
Tube gripper failed to leave
sensor blade to leave the sensor area
the Y direction home position
home
position
during
mix
assembly
initialization 0x32060282
0x32060283
0x32060284
the tube gripper failed to
The Y-direction motor cannot drive the
return to the Y direction
sensor blade to the sensor area home
home position
position during mix assembly initialization
Tube gripper Y direction home
The Y direction home position sensor is still
position
blocked after the gripper is stretched out in
sensor
status
abnormal
the process of mixing action.
Tube gripper Y direction end
The Y direction end position sensor is still
position
blocked after the gripper is retracted in the
sensor
status
abnormal
process of mixing action.
Tube gripper Y direction end 0x32060285
position sensor is mistakenly triggered
The system detects that the Y direction end position sensor generates a wrong jump signal when the tube gripper is stretched out. The Y direction end position sensor is not
0x32060286
Tube gripper failed to stretch
triggered when the tube gripper is stretched
out in Y direction
out. It indicates that the gripper may fail to clamp the tube, so the alarm is sent. The Y direction home position sensor is not
0x32060287
tube gripper failed to retract in
triggered
when
the
tube
gripper
is
Y direction
retracted. It indicates that the gripper may fail to let go tube, so the alarm is sent.
When 0x32060290
the
tube
gripper
The system detects that the Z direction end
returns, the Z direction home
position sensor generates a wrong jump
position sensor is mistakenly
signal when the tube gripper lowers down
triggered
during the mixing action. The Z-direction motor cannot drive the
0x32060291
Tube gripper failed to leave
sensor blade to leave the sensor area
the Z direction home position
home
position
during
mix
assembly
initialization 0x32060292
0x32060293
0x32060294 0x32060295
tube gripper failed to return to the Z direction home position
The Z-direction motor cannot drive the sensor blade to the sensor area home position during mix assembly initialization
Tube gripper Z direction home
The Y direction home position sensor is still
position
blocked after the gripper lifts up in the
sensor
status
abnormal
process of mixing action.
Tube gripper Z direction end
The Y direction end position sensor is still
position
blocked after the gripper lowers down in the
sensor
status
abnormal
process of mixing action.
Tube gripper Z direction end
The system detects that the Z direction end
11-19
Troubleshooting Information
position sensor is mistakenly
position sensor generates a wrong jump
triggered
signal when the tube gripper lifts up during the mixing action.
0x32060296
0x32060297
The tube gripper fails to lift up
The Z direction end position sensor cannot
in the Z direction
be triggered when the tube gripper rises.
tube gripper fails to drop in the Z direction When
0x32060298
0x32060299
cannot be triggered when the tube gripper lowers down.
the
tube
gripper
When the mix assembly is initialized, the
returns, the Z direction home
system detects that the home position
position sensor is mistakenly
sensor in Z direction generates a wrong
triggered
jump signal.
Tube gripper Z direction end
The Z direction end position sensor is still
position
blocked after the gripper lowers down in the
sensor
status
abnormal When 0x32060300
The Z direction home position sensor
mix assembly initialization process. gripper
When the mix assembly is initialized or the
returns, the R direction home
the
tube
mixing action is performed, the system
position sensor is mistakenly
detects that the home position sensor in R
triggered
direction generates a wrong jump signal. The R-direction motor cannot drive the
0x32060301
Tube gripper failed to leave
sensor blade to leave the sensor area
the R direction home position
home
position
during
mix
assembly
initialization. 0x32060302
Tube gripper failed to return to the R direction home position Tube gripper R direction end
0x32060303
position
sensor
status
abnormal
The R-direction motor cannot drive the sensor blade to the sensor area home position during mix assembly initialization The R direction home position sensor is still blocked when the tube gripper shakes the tube, and the tube mouth is obliquely downward in the process of mixing action. The alarm is sent out when during the mixing action, when the tube gripper is
0x32060304
Tube gripper Z direction end
shaking the tube, the Z direction end
position
position
sensor
status
abnormal during mixing
sensor
suddenly
enters
the
unblocked status. It indicates the tube gripper drops down. Continuing mixing may damage the tube gripper. The R direction home position sensor is not
0x32060305
Tube gripper failed to go to the
triggered when the gripper shakes the tube
R direction home position
to the vertical direction in the process of mixing action.
Select Menu Service Debug&Self-test Self-check Mixing Mechanism to enter the mix assembly self-check screen. 11-20
Troubleshooting Information
Figure 11-7 Mix assembly self-test screen
11.2.7 Autoloader-Related Errors Detection principle The autoloader assembly is composed of the loading assembly, feeding assembly, unloading assembly, sample compartment assembly (for closed-sampling type instrument only), tube barcode rotatory scanning assembly, tube rack movement detection assembly, and tube detection assembly. Where: The loading assembly consists of one motor, one loading home position sensor, one loading end position sensor and one loading in-position micro-switch. The feeding assembly consists of one motor and one feed home position sensor. The unloading assembly consists of one motor and one unloading home position sensor. The sample compartment assembly consists of one motor and one sample compartment home position sensor. The rotatory scanning assembly consists of one tube fixing motor, one rotatory motor and one tube fixing detection sensor. The tube rack movement detection assembly consists of two sensors (one right counter sensor and one left counter sensor). The system determines whether the action is normal by the positions of the autoloader assemblies, moving distance and sensor status.
11-21
Troubleshooting Information
Error codes and error report mechanism
Loading component alarms Table 11-13 Loading assembly error messages Error ID
Error message
Error report mechanism
Loading mechanism fails to 0x32060230
leave
sensor
area
in
initialization
The loading motor cannot take the sensor light barrier from the sensor detection area of home position when the automatic sampler is initialized. The loading motor cannot bring the sensor
0x32060231
Loading mechanism failed to
light barrier in the sensor detection area of
return to the home position
home position when the automatic sampler is initialized or loading is reset. When loading ends, the sensor at the
0x32060232
loading end position is not blocked and the
Loading stagnated
loading in-position detection switch is not triggered.
Abnormal status of the home 0x32060233
position sensor of loading mechanism Loading
0x32060234
position
mechanism sensor
After the autoloader is initialized or the
status
loading mechanism resets, the loading end position sensor is still blocked
returns, the home position sensor is mistakenly triggered
0x32060236
mechanism
end
position sensor is mistakenly triggered
the loading home position sensor is still
end
When the loading mechanism
Loading
blocked in the process of loading the tube, blocked.
abnormal
0x32060235
After the loading end position sensor is
When the loading mechanism claw returns to the home position, the system detects that the loading home position sensor generates a wrong jump signal. During the tube rack loading process, the system detects that the loading end position sensor generates a wrong jump signal.
Feeding mechanism alarms Table 11-14 Feeding mechanism error messages Error ID
Error message
Error report mechanism The feed motor cannot take the sensor light
Failed to break away from 0x32060250
sensor
during
feed
mechanism initialization
barrier from the sensor detection area of home position when the automatic sampler is initialized. The biggest possibility is that the sensor is damaged, e.g., the connector leaks.
11-22
Troubleshooting Information
The feed motor cannot bring the sensor 0x32060251
Feed mechanism failed to
light barrier into the sensor detection area
return to the home position
of home position when the automatic sampler is initialized.
0x32060253
0x32060254
Feed mechanism failed to move to the home position Feed mechanism failed to
The feed home position sensor is still
leave the home position
blocked when feeding ends.
the home position sensor to trigger the alarm by mistake Sensor mistakenly triggered
0x32060256
during feeding motor moving to home position
light barrier into the sensor detection area of home position when feeding is reset.
Feed mechanism returns to 0x32060255
The feed motor cannot bring the sensor
When the automatic sampler is initialized, the system detects that the feed home position sensor generates a wrong jump signal. During feeding mechanism resetting, the system detects that the feed mechanism home position sensor generates a wrong jump signal.
Tube rack movement detection errors
Every time the tube rack moves one step, the left/right pinch roller will undergo the following process: stopping at the tube rack groove stopping at the tube rack step stopping at the tube rack groove; the left/right counter will change status accordingly: blocked not blocked blocked, and the sensor output signal will have the level change process of ABA, i.e., a square signal is generated. When the left/right pinch roller stops at the tube groove or at the tube rack step, but the left/right counter sensor status are not consistent with expectation, the system sends out alarm. The system monitors the left/right counter sensor status based on the tube rack position and if the tube racks are continuously fed. Table 11-15 Feeding mechanism error messages Error ID
Error message
Error report mechanism During the tube rack feeding process, when the pinch roller should be at the groove, the
0x32060310
Counter sensor status error
left/right counter sensor is not blocked; or when the pinch roller should be at the step, the left/right counter sensor is blocked. When the tube rack is fed forward for one
0x32060311
Wrong counter count jump times
position, the left/right counter sensor does not generate the complete ABA square signal or has generated more than 1 square signal.
0x32060312
Manually move of tube rack
11-23
When the tube rack is not being fed (e.g., when the system is aspirating/mixing
Troubleshooting Information
sample or is waiting to aspirate/mix sample), the system monitors the ABA square signal generated by the left or right counter. In such cases, the system judges someone has manually move the tube rack, and reports error.
Unloading mechanism errors Table 11-16 Unloading mechanism error messages Error ID
Error message
Error report mechanism The unloading motor cannot drive the sensor blade to leave the sensor area
0x32060240
Unloading mechanism failed
home
position
during
autoloader
to leave home position
initialization. The biggest possibility is that the sensor is damaged, for example, by the leaked liquid at the connection position. The autoloader cannot drive the sensor blade to leave the sensor area home
0x32060241
Unloading mechanism failed
position during autoloader initialization.
to return to the home position
The biggest possibility is that the sensor is damaged, for example, by the leaked liquid at the connection position. The alarm is sent when the If the error cannot be removed, check whether there
0x32060242
are any foreign objects (e.g., screws) near
Unloading tray is full
the reflective sensor, and confirm whether the
reflective
sensor
connector
is
connected reliably. When the autoloader is initialized or 0x32060243
Sensor mistakenly triggered
unloading mechanism is reset, the system
during unloading mechanism
detects that the unloading mechanism
returning to home position
home position sensor generates a wrong jump signal. The unloading home position sensor is still blocked when the unloading action ends.
0x32060244
Unloading
mechanism
protruding failed
Check whether the sensor connector is connected reliably, if it is corroded by splashing liquid, and if the sensor cable skin is broken.
Rotatory scanning assembly errors
The tube fixing detection sensor in the rotatory scanning mechanism moves with the 11-24
Troubleshooting Information
mechanism, so the leading wire of sensor becomes a moving wire. If it is not fixed as required, the sensor wire skin may be broken or the inner core may be fractured. In this situation, the system may report any faults in Table 11-17 (except for "Scanner communication abnormal"), and the faults are accidental faults. Besides, the tube fixing mechanism in the rotatory scanning mechanism is just below the preheating bath. When servicing the preheating bath, avoid sprinkling reagent on the tube fixing mechanism; otherwise, the slide rail of tube fixing mechanism easily gets rusty or the motor or the sensor connector is easily corroded by the splashing liquid, causing a secondary fault. The following alarms will appear only on the instrument configured with the rotatory scanning mechanism. For users at administrator or common user level, all the following errors are displayed in the form of "Rotary scanning mechanism action error" except for "Scanner communication abnormal". Table 11-17 Rotatory scanning assembly error messages Error ID
Error message
Error report mechanism When executing the tube fixing command, the system detects that the tube fixing detection sensor has never left the rear
0x32060261
Tube fixing mechanism fixing
sensor barrier. Check whether the motor
tube error
and sensor connectors are connected reliably or get corroded by splashing liquid, and whether the sensor lead wire is broken or the internal core is fractured. After rotatory scanning, and during the whole processing of tube fixing mechanism returning to home position, and until the motor stops movements, the tube fixing
0x32060262
Tube
fixing
mechanism
releasing tube error
detection mechanism is always blocked by the rear sensor barrier. Check whether the motor
and
sensor
connectors
are
connected reliably or get corroded by splashing liquid, and whether the sensor lead wire is broken or the internal core is fractured. The tube fixing detection sensor cannot leave the sensor barrier when the rotatory scanning component is initialized. Check 0x32060263
Tube fixing mechanism failed
whether the motor and sensor connectors
to leave the home position
are connected reliably or get corroded by splashing liquid, and whether the sensor lead wire is broken or the internal core is fractured.
0x32060264
Tube fixing mechanism failed 11-25
The tube fixing detection sensor cannot
Troubleshooting Information
to return to home position
return to the sensor barrier position when the
rotatory
scanning
component
is
initialized. Check whether the motor and sensor connectors are connected reliably or get corroded by splashing liquid, and whether the sensor lead wire is broken or the internal core is fractured. The system detects wrong jump of the tube fixing detection sensor signal when the Sensor mistakenly triggered 0x32060265
during tube fixing mechanism returning to home position
rotatory scanning assembly is initialized or reset. Check whether the motor and sensor connectors are connected reliably or get corroded by splashing liquid, and whether the sensor lead wire is broken or the internal core is fractured. When autoloading is started, the system will check its communication with the scanner. The alarm will be triggered if communication cannot be established with the scanner.
0x32060266
Scanner
communication
abnormal
When this error occurs, check whether the scanner is connected to the autoloader board reliably (including connection of the scanner transfer line connector). If the connection is proper but the error cannot be
removed,
the
scanner
may
be
damaged. During the autoloading process, the system detects that the tube fixing detection sensor is triggered earlier than expected, which may happen because the tube fixing mechanism slide rail of getting rusted and cannot move due to splashing liquid.
0x32060267
Tube fixing mechanism slide
Usually this error can be removed by
rail is stuck
tapping "Remove Error" button. However, it will re-appear in the next autoloading process. When this error takes place, first check whether the slide rail of tube fixing mechanism gets rusted (when sliding the rail, the resistance is large). In this case, use lubricating oil to clean and lubricate the slide rail and make sure that the slide rail 11-26
Troubleshooting Information
can slide easily. Replace the whole tube fixing mechanism when necessary. If the slide rail does not get rusted, the greatest possibility is that the sensor lead wire is broken or the outer skin is damaged.
Tube detection errors
The following alarms will appear only on the instrument not configured with the rotatory scanning mechanism. Table 11-18 Tube detection sensor error messages Error ID
Error message
Error report mechanism When autoloading is started, the system will check for the tube detection sensor. The alarm will be triggered if it detects the sensor is blocked. This error may occur when after an abnormal shutdown, the tube racks in the analysis area are not taken away. If the error still cannot be removed when all the tube racks in the analysis area are taken away, tap . Tap and observe whether the turn-on voltage and turn-off voltage are in the acceptable ranges. If not, check whether the connector of tube detection sensor is connected reliably or gets corroded by leaking liquid. Replace the sensor with a new one when necessary. If the turn-on voltage and turn-off voltage are still not in the acceptable ranges, tap the button to observe the change rate of the current blank voltage from the blank voltage of last calibration. If the change rate exceeds 1.3 times, tap the
sensor.
11-27
button to
recalibrate the
Troubleshooting Information
Figure 11-8 Tube detection sensor debugging screen
11.2.8 Sample Compartment Assembly Errors Detection principle The sample compartment assembly (for closed-sampling type analyzers) contains one motor and one home position sensor. The system judges whether its action is normal by detecting the compartment close/open status and its home position blocked/unblocked status. The sample compartment error will occur on the closed-sampling type analyzers. Error codes and error report mechanism For users at administrator or common user level, all the following errors are displayed in the form of "Sample compartment action abnormal". Table 11-19 Sample compartment assembly error messages Error ID
Error message
Error report mechanism This alarm is triggered when the system
0x32060314
Sample compartment status
receives a command of opening/closing
error
sample compartment before the sample compartment completes initialization. The sample compartment motor cannot
0x32060270
Sample compartment failed to
drive the sensor blade to leave the sensor
leave home position
area
home
position
during
sample
compartment initialization 0x32060271
Sample compartment failed to
The sample compartment motor cannot
return to home position
drive the sensor blade to the sensor area 11-28
Troubleshooting Information
home position during sample compartment initialization The system performs the opening sample 0x32060272
Sample compartment failed to
compartment
action,
but
detects the
open
sample compartment home position sensor is still blocked. When
0x32060273
the
sample
compartment
is
Sensor mistakenly triggered
initialized or closed, the system detects that
during sample compartment
the home position sensor of the sample
returning to home position
compartment generates a wrong jump signal. The alarm is triggered when the system detects that the sample compartment home position sensor is blocked before the sample compartment is closed.
Sample compartment home 0x32060274
position
sensor
status
abnormal
If the error is not caused because someone has
manually
closed
the
sample
compartment, check whether the sample compartment home position sensor is connected reliably, or if the sensor is damaged. Select Menu Service Debug & Self-Test Self-Test Other Components Sample Compartment to enter the sample compartment assembly self-check screen.
Figure 11-9 Sample compartment self-check screen
11-29
Troubleshooting Information
11.2.9 Temperature Type Errors Detection principle The system monitors the temperature of the following: WBC reaction bath temperature, RET reaction bath temperature, preheating bath temperature, optical system, instrument internal temperature, PMT temperature and RBC diluent temperature. Here, the WBC reaction bath, RET reaction bath, preheating bath, and optical system are modules with the heating function. After the instrument is powered on, the system will dynamically set the target temperature values for the WBC reaction bath, RET reaction bath and preheating bath according to the instrument internal temperature. And it controls the temperatures in WBC reaction bath, RET reaction bath and preheating bath in a relatively stable range through a closed loop control system composed of the heater and temperature sensor. The instrument internal temperature, PMT temperature and RBC diluent temperature are monitored, but the corresponding channels cannot be heated. The system has two thresholds for temperature, one for reporting alarm, the other for limiting analysis. When the temperature of one or more channels exceeds the alarm thresholds, but does not exceed the limiting analysis thresholds, the instrument prompts alarm but does not shield the results, and the measurement is not stopped; when the temperature of a certain or several channels exceeds the limiting analysis thresholds, the instrument prompts an alarm, shields the results, and stops the subsequent measurement. Error codes and error report mechanism When abnormal temperatures are reported, first judge if it is a positive or false alarm. For example, when the system reports "WBC reaction bath temperature out of the upper limit for counting", first put your hand near the WNB/DIFF reaction bath to feel if the reaction bath temperature is really high. If the reaction bath is cool, it is a false alarm. Another example, if the system reports "Temperature inside the analyzer out of the lower limit for counting", but the room temperature is 25°C, obviously it is a false alarm. Causes of the false alarm: The temperature sensor connector is not connected reliably or gets corroded by leaking liquid, or the temperature sensor is damaged (e.g., the welding of built-in chip is poor). Causes of the real alarm: The heater/temperature protection switch connectors are not connected reliably (which will lead to a low temperature fault), drive board closed loop temperature control fails, the power supply power is insufficient, etc. Table 11-20 Temperature error messages Error ID
Error message WBC
0x32061000
reaction
Error report mechanism bath
temperature out of the upper limit for counting
0x32061001
RET
reaction
The WBC reaction bath temperature is higher than the target temperature by +5℃. The alarm will shield the results and end autoloading analysis in advance.
bath
The RET reaction bath temperature is
temperature out of the upper
higher than the target temperature by +5℃.
11-30
Troubleshooting Information
limit for counting.
The alarm will shield the results and end autoloading analysis in advance.
0x32061002
0x32061003
Preheating bath temperature
The preheating bath temperature is higher
out of the upper limit for
than 45℃. The alarm will shield the results
counting.
and end autoloading analysis in advance.
Optical system temperature
The optical system temperature is higher
out of the upper limit for
than 45℃. The alarm will shield the results
counting.
and end autoloading analysis in advance.
Temperature 0x32061004
0x32061005
0x32061006
the
Temperature inside the analyzer is higher
analyzer out of the upper limit
than 45℃. The alarm will shield the results
for counting
and end autoloading analysis in advance.
PMT temperature out of the upper limit for counting.
of the upper limit for counting. reaction
bath
temperature out of the lower limit for counting RET
0x32061011
reaction
bath
temperature out of the lower
out of the lower limit for counting
0x32061015
0x32061016
end autoloading analysis in advance. The WBC reaction bath temperature is smaller than the target temperature by 5℃. The alarm will shield the results and The RET reaction bath temperature is lower than the target temperature by -5℃. The alarm will shield the results and end The preheating bath temperature is lower than the target temperature by -5℃. The alarm will shield the results and end
Optical system temperature
The optical system temperature is lower
out of the lower limit for
than 28℃. The alarm will shield the results
counting
and end autoloading analysis in advance. the
Temperature inside the analyzer is lower
analyzer out of the lower limit
than 3℃. The alarm will shield the results
for counting
and end autoloading analysis in advance.
inside
PMT temperature out of the lower limit for counting
of the lower limit for counting reaction
The PMT temperature is lower than 27℃. The alarm will shield the results and end autoloading analysis in advance.
RBC diluent temperature out
WBC 0x32061020
45℃. The alarm will shield the results and
autoloading analysis in advance.
Temperature 0x32061014
The RBC diluent temperature is higher than
autoloading analysis in advance.
Preheating bath temperature
0x32061013
The alarm will shield the results and end
end autoloading analysis in advance.
limit for counting
0x32061012
The PMT temperature is higher than 45℃. autoloading analysis in advance.
RBC diluent temperature out
WBC 0x32061010
inside
The RBC diluent temperature is lower than 3℃. The alarm will shield the results and end autoloading analysis in advance.
bath
The WBC reaction bath temperature is
temperature out of the upper
higher than the target temperature by +3℃
limit for alarm
but not higher than the target temperature 11-31
Troubleshooting Information
by +5 ℃ . The alarm is just a prompt message; the results are not shielded and measurement is not stopped. RET 0x32061021
reaction
bath
temperature out of the upper limit for alarm
The RET reaction bath temperature is higher than 38 ℃ . The alarm is just a prompt message; the results are not shielded and measurement is not stopped. The preheating bath temperature is higher
0x32061022
Preheating bath temperature out of the upper limit for alarm
than the target temperature by 3℃ but not higher than 45 ℃ . The alarm is just a prompt message; the results are not shielded and measurement is not stopped. The optical system temperature is higher
0x32061023
Optical system temperature out of the upper limit for alarm
than 38℃ but not higher than 45℃. The alarm is just a prompt message; the results are not shielded and measurement is not stopped. The internal ambient temperature is higher
0x32061024
Internal ambient temperature out of the upper limit for alarm
than 36℃ but not higher than 45℃. The alarm is just a prompt message; the results are not shielded and measurement is not stopped. The PMT temperature is higher than 38℃
0x32061025
PMT temperature out of the
but not higher than 45℃. The alarm is just
upper limit for alarm
a prompt message; the results are not shielded and measurement is not stopped. The RBC diluent temperature is higher than
0x32061026
RBC diluent temperature out of the upper limit for alarm
36℃ but not higher than 45℃. The alarm is just a prompt message; the results are not shielded and measurement is not stopped. The WBC reaction bath temperature is
WBC 0x32061030
reaction
bath
temperature out of the lower limit for alarm
smaller than the target temperature by -3℃ but not smaller than the target temperature by -5 ℃ . The alarm is just a prompt message; the results are not shielded and measurement is not stopped. The RET reaction bath temperature is
RET 0x32061031
reaction
bath
temperature out of the lower limit for alarm
smaller than the target temperature by -3℃ but not smaller than the target temperature by -5 ℃ . The alarm is just a prompt message; the results are not shielded and measurement is not stopped.
0x32061032
Preheating bath temperature 11-32
The preheating bath temperature is lower
Troubleshooting Information
out of the lower limit for alarm
than the target temperature by -3℃ but not lower than target temperature -5℃. The alarm is just a prompt message; the results are not shielded and measurement is not stopped. The optical system temperature is lower
0x32061033
Optical system temperature out of the lower limit for alarm
than 30℃ but not lower than 28℃. The alarm is just a prompt message; the results are not shielded and measurement is not stopped. The internal ambient temperature is lower
0x32061034
Internal ambient temperature out of the lower limit for alarm
than 12 ℃ but not lower than 3 ℃ . The alarm is just a prompt message; the results are not shielded and measurement is not stopped. The PMT temperature is lower than 29℃
0x32061035
PMT temperature out of the
but not lower than 27℃. The alarm is just a
lower limit for alarm
prompt message; the results are not shielded and measurement is not stopped. The RBC diluent temperature is lower than
0x32061036
RBC diluent temperature out
12℃ but not lower than 3℃. The alarm is
of the lower limit for alarm
just a prompt message; the results are not shielded and measurement is not stopped.
0x32061040
0x32061041
0x32061042
WBC reaction bath does not
At the end of the specified startup
achieve target temperature
completed
after startup procedure
temperature of the assembly (with heating
RET reaction bath does not
module)
achieve target temperature
temprature. Generally the fault occurs
after startup procedure
because the assembly is not heated or the
Preheating bath does not
heating power is not enough. Check the
achieve target temperature
follows:
after startup procedure Optical 0x32061043
system
does
not
achieve target temperature after startup procedure
0x32061044
time cannot
point, reach
the the
target target
① If the 24V power supply works normal; ② If the heating rod connector and the
PMT does not achieve target
temperature protection switch connector of
temperature
the corresponding channel are connected
after
startup
reliably.
procedure
Select Menu Status Temperature & Pressure to view the temperature value of each channel. When the temperature sensor and the circuit are normal, the temperature value displayed is close to the real temperature.
11-33
Troubleshooting Information
Figure 11-10 Temperature status screen
11.2.10 Pressure Errors Detection principle The system uses one pressure pump and three air tanks to build three positive pressures; and one vacuum pump and two air tanks to build two negative pressures. One pressure sensor is set for the 120 kPa and -40 kPa pressure channels respectively to control the pressure balance. When the pressure reaches the set range, the pressure pump or the vacuum pump stops working. When there is a problem in the pump control or the sealing property of the air tank is poor, then abnormal 120 kPa/-40 kPa pressure will be reported. While 90 kPa and 50 kPa are split from 120 kPa, with valves installed on both the splitting channels. When the 90 kPa/50 kPa pressure is lower than the set range, the valve is opened, and the high pressure air enters the 90 kPa/50 kPa air cell from the 120 kPa air tank to increase the 90 kPa/50 kPa air cell pressure; when the 90 kPa/50 kPa pressure is higher than the set range, the value is closed. When the valve on/off control does not work well, or the sealing of the 90kPa/50kPa air cell is poor, the system will report the abnormal 90 kPa/50 kPa pressure. The -30 kPa pressure is splitted from the -40 kPa, with a valve installed on the splitting channel. The principle is similar to that of the 90 kPa and 50 kPa channels. Error codes and error report mechanism Table 11-21 Pressure error messages Error ID
Error message
Error report mechanism The system detects that any one of three
0x32060401
Auto pressure building out of
pressure or the two vacuums fails to reach
time
the set pressure range in sequencedefined time. 11-34
Troubleshooting Information
At the sequence-defined time point, the 90 0x32060500
120kPa pressure out of range
kPa pressure build-up sensor detects a pressure exceeding the defined range. At the sequence-defined time point, the 90
0x32060501
90 kPa pressure out of range
kPa pressure build-up sensor detects a pressure exceeding the defined range. At the sequence-defined time point, the 90
0x32060502
50 kPa pressure out of range
kPa pressure build-up sensor detects a pressure exceeding the defined range. At the sequence-defined time point, the 90
0x32060503
-40 kPa pressure out of range
kPa pressure build-up sensor detects a pressure exceeding the defined range. At the sequence-defined time point, the 90
0x32060504
-30 kPa pressure out of range
kPa pressure build-up sensor detects a pressure exceeding the defined range. The 120 kPa pressure build-up sensor
0x32060505
120kPa pressure is higher
detects a pressure higher than 170 kPa. If
than upper limit
this situation is allowed to continue, there is a risk of tube damage. The hydraulic sensor detects the liquid pressure in the sampling tube exceeds the
0x32060410
Liquid pressure out of range
normal range. Possible causes include that the tube is broken, the probe is blocked, or the hydraulic sensor is damaged. The system detected that the blank voltage
Blank voltage of the liquid 0x32060414
pressure sensor is out of range
of the hydraulic sensor exceeds the normal range when there is no fluid pressure in the tube. Possible causes include that the tube is broken, the probe is blocked, or the hydraulic sensor is damaged.
Select Menu Status Temp & Pressure to view the pressure value of each channel. When the pressure sensor and the circuit are normal, the pressure values displayed are close to the real pressure. By tapping the and buttons on the screen, one can roughly judge the sealing property of the air tank/air cell and whether the valves on the splitting channels operate normally.
11-35
Troubleshooting Information
Figure 11-11 Pressure status screen
11.2.11 Voltage/Current Errors Detection principle / Error codes and error report mechanism Table 11-22 Voltage/current error messages Error ID
Error message
0x32061050
12V voltage abnormal
0x32061051
24V voltage abnormal
0x32061052
PMT voltage abnormal
Error report mechanism 12V is out of the [11.5V, 12.5V] range Power 24V is out of the [22.8V, 25.25V] range PMT is out of the [22V, 33V] range The actual PMT voltage exceeds the PMT
0x32061059
PMT gain abnormal
voltage alarm range in either the DIFF, WNB and RET channels. The HGB blank voltage exceeds the [3.2V, 4.8V] range. Possible causes include:
0x32061056
HGB blank voltage abnormal
(1) There are bubbles in the diluent in the HGB reaction bath; (2) Liquid leaks from the HGB reaction bath
11-36
Troubleshooting Information
and flows to the HGB lamp; (3) The light intensity of HGB lamp has been weakened or enhanced, and the HGB gain needs to be calibrated again. The laser power exceeds the [9.5 mW, 10.5
0x32061057
Laser power abnormal
0x32061058
Laser drive current abnormal
0x32061060 0x32061061 0x32061062
DIFF
channel
FS
mW] range.
blank
voltage abnormal WNB
channel
The laser driven current exceeds the allowable range. DIFF channel FS blank voltage exceeds the set threshold.
FS
blank
WNB channel FS blank voltage exceeds
voltage abnormal
the set threshold.
RET channel FS blank voltage
RET channel FS blank voltage exceeds the
abnormal
set threshold.
Select Menu Status Voltage & Current to view the voltage/current value.
Figure 11-12 Voltage and current status screen
11.2.12 Fan Type Detection principle The cooling fan has a built-in sensor. When the fan runs, the fan output end will generate a square wave signal. When the fan stops, there is no square wave signal. The system judges if the fan is stalled by checking whether there is square wave signals from the fan output end.
11-37
Troubleshooting Information
Error codes and error report mechanism Table 11-23 Fan error messages Error ID 0x32061070
Error message
Error report mechanism
Radiator fan in the analyzer is
The system detects that the fan at the back
blocked
of main unit stops.
Select Menu Service Debug & Self-test Self-test Other Components Fan to test the fan.
Figure 11-13 Fan self-check screen
11.2.13 Signal type Detection principle The system checks the DC offset voltages of the FS, SS, FL and HGB channels at the specific time sequence nodes during the analyzer startup process, and reports error when any of the offset voltages exceed the allowable range. Error codes and error report mechanism Possible causes of reporting the abnormal FS, SS and FL baseline: The optical signal board in optical system is damaged; The main control board circuit is damaged; The signal line connection between the optical system signal board and the main control board is not reliable.
11-38
Troubleshooting Information
Possible causes of reporting abnormal HGB baseline: The analog board is damaged; The main control board circuit is damaged; The signal line connection between the analog board and the main control board is not reliable. Table 11-24 Signal error messages Error ID
Error message
Error report mechanism During analyzer startup, the system detects
0x32060090
FS baseline abnormal
that the FS channel baseline exceeds the allowable range. During analyzer startup, the system detects
0x32060091
SS baseline abnormal
that the SS channel baseline exceeds the allowable range. During analyzer startup, the system detects
0x32060092
FL baseline abnormal
that the FL channel baseline exceeds the allowable range. During analyzer startup, the system detects
0x32060093
HGB baseline abnormal
that the HGB channel baseline exceeds the allowable range.
11.2.14 Communication Type Detection principle When the main control board sends a command to the drive board or autoloader board, but receives no reply, the system reports the communication timeout error Error codes and error report mechanism The possible cause for the communication time out fault is that the communication line connection between the main control board and the drive board/autoloader board is not reliable. Table 11-25 Signal error messages Error ID 0x32060404
0x32060405
Error message Autoloader
Error report mechanism board
communication out of time
The main control board sends a command to the autoloader board, but receives a reply within the specified time.
Drive board communication out of time
The main control board sends a command to the drive board, but receives no reply within the specified time.
11-39
Troubleshooting Information
11.2.15 System Errors Detection principle The instrument judges whether there is any problem by checking the signals or results. Error codes and error report mechanism Table 11-26 System error messages Error ID
Error message
Error report mechanism The alarm is triggered when the startup process is interrupted. Solve the problem
0x32060402
Startup
initiation
not
performed
that interrupts the startup process, and this error can be removed. Tap the "Remove Error" button to remove the error, and the instrument will automatically perform the startup process. The background results tested during the
0x32060407
Background abnormal
startup process are out of specification range During the measurement, the average voltage of the aperture exceeds the set range. Possible causes include (1) The aperture is really clogged. Tap
0x32060409
Clogging
"Remove Error" to solve the problem. If the error still exists, try to perform Probe Cleanser maintenance procedure to the aperture. (2) The electrical conductivity drops after the diluent is frozen and rewarmed. This alarm will be triggered when the process of exiting shallow standby status is
0x32060411
Exiting shallow standby status failed
interrupted.
Solve
the
problem
that
interrupts the process, and this error can be removed. Tap the "Remove Error" button to remove the error. And the instrument will automatically perform the process again. This alarm will be triggered when the process of exiting deep standby status is
0x32060412
Exiting deep standby status
interrupted.
Solve
the
problem
that
failed
interrupts the process, and this error can be removed. Tap the "Remove Error" button to remove the error. And the instrument will
11-40
Troubleshooting Information
automatically perform the process again. This alarm will be triggered when the process of auto startup is interrupted. Solve the problem that interrupts the process, 0x32060413
Auto startup failed
and this error can be removed. Tap the "Remove Error" button to remove the error. And the instrument will automatically perform the process again. When the FCM bath sequence is being executed, the FCM bath floater does not
0x32060406
FCM priming out of time
float up as required at the sequencedefined time point (i.e. the FCM bath is not primed full)
0x32060415
FCM bath priming failed!
0x32061071
Front cover is open
0x32061072
The DIL syringe fails to respond to the FCM bath priming command. The front cover detection sensor is in the non-blocked status.
Optical system shielding box is open
The system detects that the optical system shielding box detection switch is not pressed down. The error only occurs when the main control board battery runs out of power. To
0x32061073
System time error
remove the error, replace the battery, and reset the date and time. Then tap "Remove Error".
11.2.16 Additional Warning Messages in the “Message” Area (Since EIV012) When “PLT analysis abnormal” displayed in the Message area, it means the PLT-I channel may have electrical interference. The PLT-related parameter results (PLT, MPV, PCT, PDW, P-LCR, P-LCC, PDW-SD) are flagged with the “R” flag or displayed as ****. When “PLT-O analysis abnormal” displayed in the Message area, it means the second time background test in the PLT-O channel sees unexpected/excessive particles. may have electrical interference. The PLT-related parameter results (PLT, MPV, PCT, PDW, P-LCR, PLCC, PDW-SD) are flagged with the “R” flag or displayed as ****.
11-41
A
List of Wearing Parts Frequency of replacement
Piercer
PN
115-033912-00
Probe wipe
PWD
041-023727-00
Liquid filter
LF1
115-011660-00
Liquid filter
LF2
115-011660-00
Liquid filter
LF4
115-010567-00
Pinch valve tube Air pump
PV05/PV06 pinch valve tube P1
M6G-020011--082-002562-00
A-1
Piercer Piercing probe wipe Waste filter
100000 times of piercing 100000 times of piercing 60000 times of working / one year
Probe wipe
60000 times of working /
filter
one year
Sheath fluid
45000 times of working /
filter
one year
Pinch valve
60000 times of working /
tube (yellow)
one year
Air pump
2000H
B
New/Changed Functions Lists with each ECR
This section records new or changed functions with each ECR. ECR
New/changed functions
Description
EIV012
Software debug: correct
Before EIV012, when tapping “Horizontal Pos.”
the sample probe position
observe button at the “Adj, Sample Probe
at WNB bath after tapping
Pos.”-“WNB bath pos.” screen,
“Horizontal
probe moves to a position about 2.5mm from
Observe”
button
the sample
the centre of the WNB bath. EIV012 corrects the design. After tapping “Horizontal Pos.”, the sample probe moves horizontally and stays at a position above the target position (around the centre of its working position in the Y direction). See 4.6.1 Adjust. Sample Probe Positions
EIV013
New optical assembly goes
6.3.5
Replacing
Optical
Assembly
after
on-line
Analyzer Upgrading with the New Optical Assembly and New Optical Signal Board (After EIV013)
When the operator goes to
4.7 Status
the sensor status screen, moments placed on certain motors will be released Software
supports
the
7.13 Check the Particle Flow Stability
Stability Graph labXpert
supports
Logging in labXpert with your service level
“importing” re-tests results
account, and click “import” on the tool bar. The
at service level
software now supports importing re-tests information (including sample imformation, blood sample tests analysis information, rules application results, parameter results and flag messages)
EIV014
The “Debug Data Export”
4.9.2 Debug Data Export
function supports export LIS logs. The
blank
adjustment
photovoltage screen
/
is
removed Software adjusts the layout
The sample compartment self-test and the fan
of the self-test screen.
self-test are placed under one tab. B-1
Troubleshooting Information
Correction:
Hardware diagram: remove the RFID board from the diagram 7.8.7, error correction, LF1 is for waste fitler, and LF2 is for wipe filter. 6.3.3-6.3.4, update the instruction for laser diode current adjustment and the replacement of optical system. Main changes include:
Add instruction that service should always check diode current on the software after optical system debugging/maintenance;
When replacing the optical system, no need to replace the diode drive board.
B-2
P/N:046-011141-00(5.0)